HITACHI CPX10WN - Video projector

CPX10WN - Video projector HITACHI - Free user manual and instructions

Find the device manual for free CPX10WN HITACHI in PDF.

📄 242 pages English EN Download 💬 AI Question 10 questions ⚙️ Specs
Notice HITACHI CPX10WN - page 1
Pick your language and provide your email: we'll send you a specifically translated version.
Product Type Video Projector
Brand Hitachi
Model CPX10WN
Display Technology 3LCD
Resolution XGA (1024 x 768)
Brightness 2600 ANSI Lumens
Contrast Ratio 500:1
Lamp Type UHP
Lamp Life 3000 hours (Normal), 4000 hours (Eco)
Projection Size 40 – 300 inches
Throw Ratio 1.5 – 1.8:1
Keystone Correction Vertical +/- 30°
Input Connectivity HDMI, VGA, Composite, S-Video, Audio
Speaker 1 x 7W Mono
Power Consumption 275W (Normal), 0.5W (Standby)
Weight 3.6 kg / 7.9 lbs
Dimensions (W x D x H) 317 x 252 x 98 mm / 12.5 x 9.9 x 3.9 in
Noise Level 29 dB (Eco mode)
Projection Lens Manual zoom and focus
Remote Control Included (IR)
Safety Features Kensington lock, password protection
Repair Policy Spare parts available for 7 years after end of production

Frequently Asked Questions - CPX10WN HITACHI

How do I change the lamp in my Hitachi CPX10WN projector?
Turn off the projector and unplug it. Wait 30 minutes for the lamp to cool. Remove the lamp cover on the bottom, unscrew the lamp module, and replace with a Hitachi approved lamp. Do not touch the glass.
What is the maximum projection size of this projector?
The CPX10WN can project images from 40 to 300 inches diagonally, depending on the throw distance.
How do I clean the air filter?
Turn off and unplug the projector. Open the filter cover on the side, remove the foam filter, and gently clean it with a vacuum cleaner or wash with water and dry completely before reinserting.
What does the 'Lamp' indicator flashing mean?
A flashing lamp indicator usually means the lamp has reached its end of life (over 3000 hours) or has failed. Replace the lamp module. If it persists, contact Hitachi support.
Can I connect my laptop via HDMI?
Yes, the projector has an HDMI port for connecting laptops, streaming devices, or gaming consoles.
How do I adjust the keystone correction?
Press the 'Keystone' button on the remote control or the control panel. Use the arrow keys to adjust the vertical keystone between -30 and +30 degrees.
Why is the image blurry?
Turn the focus ring on the lens until the image becomes sharp. If it's still blurry, check the projection distance and use the zoom ring to adjust the image size.
What are the power requirements?
The projector operates on 100-240V AC, 50/60Hz. Power consumption is 275W in normal mode and less than 1W in standby.
How do I reset the lamp timer?
After replacing the lamp, go to the Menu > Setup > Lamp Time > Reset. Confirm to reset the counter. Failure to reset may cause the projector to shut down prematurely.
Does the projector come with a carry case?
A soft carry case is often included with the CPX10WN, but check your package contents. If not, you can purchase a third-party case compatible with projectors of this size.

User questions about CPX10WN HITACHI

0 question about this device. Answer the ones you know or ask your own.

Ask a new question about this device

The email remains private: it is only used to notify you if someone responds to your question.

No questions yet. Be the first to ask one.

Download the instructions for your Video projector in PDF format for free! Find your manual CPX10WN - HITACHI and take your electronic device back in hand. On this page are published all the documents necessary for the use of your device. CPX10WN by HITACHI.

USER MANUAL CPX10WN HITACHI

User's Manual (detailed) Operating Guide

HITACHI CPX10WN - User's Manual (detailed) Operating Guide - 1

natural_image Line drawing of a projector with ventilation grilles and a circular lens (no text or symbols)

Thank you for purchasing this projector.

⚠ WARNING ▶ Before using this product, please read all manuals for this product. Be sure to read Safety Guide first. After reading them, store them in a safe place for future reference.

About this manual

Various symbols are used in this manual. The meanings of these symbols are described below.

⚠ WARNING This symbol indicates information that, if ignored, could possibly result in personal injury or even death due to incorrect handling.

⚠️ CAUTION This symbol indicates information that, if ignored, could possibly result in personal injury or physical damage due to incorrect handling.

NOTICE This entry notices of fear of causing trouble.

Please refer to the pages written following this symbol.

NOTE • The information in this manual is subject to change without notice.

- The illustrations in this manual are for illustrative purposes. They may differ slightly from your projector.

- The manufacturer assumes no responsibility for any errors that may appear in this manual.

- The reproduction, transfer or copy of all or any part of this document is not permitted without express written consent.

Trademark acknowledgment

  • Mac® is a registered trademark of Apple Inc.
  • Windows ^ , DirectDraw ^ and Direct3D ^ are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the U.S. and/or other countries.
    • VESA and DDC are trademarks of the Video Electronics Standard Association.
  • HDMI, the HDMI logo, and High-Definition Multimedia Interface are trademarks or registered trademarks of HDMI Licensing LLC in the United States and other countries.
  • Blu-ray Disc ^TM and Blu-ray ^TM are trademarks of Blu-ray Disc Association.

All other trademarks are the properties of their respective owners.

Projector

User's Manual - Safety Guide

Thank you for purchasing this projector.

HITACHI CPX10WN - User's Manual - Safety Guide - 1

WARNING • Before using, read these user's manuals of this projector to ensure correct usage through understanding. After reading, store them in a safe place for re reference. Incorrect handling of this product could possibly result in personal injury physical damage. The manufacturer assumes no responsibility for any damage caused mishandling that is beyond normal usage defined in these manuals of this projector.

NOTE • The information in this manual is subject to change without notice.

  • The manufacturer assumes no responsibility for any errors that may appear in this manual.
  • The reproduction, transmission or use of this document or contents is not permitted without express written authority.

About The Symbols

Various symbols are used in this manual, the user's manual and on the product itself to ensure correct usage, to prevent danger to the user and others, and to prevent property damage. The meanings of these symbols are described below. It is important that you read these descriptions thoroughly and fully understand the contents.

HITACHI CPX10WN - About The Symbols - 1WARNINGThis symbol indicates information that, if ignored, could possibly result in personal injury or even death due to incorrect handling.
HITACHI CPX10WN - About The Symbols - 2CAUTIONThis symbol indicates information that, if ignored, could result possibly in personal injury or physical damage due to incorrect handling.

Typical Symbols

HITACHI CPX10WN - Typical Symbols - 1

This symbol indicates an additional warning (including cautions). An illustration is provided to clarify the contents.

HITACHI CPX10WN - Typical Symbols - 2

This symbol indicates a prohibited action. The contents will be clearly indicated in an illustration or nearby (the symbol to the left indicates that disassembly is prohibited).

HITACHI CPX10WN - Typical Symbols - 3

This symbol indicates a compulsory action. The contents will be clearly indicated in an illustration or nearby (the symbol to the left indicates that the power plug should be disconnected from the power outlet).

Safety Precautions

HITACHI CPX10WN - Safety Precautions - 1

WARNING

Never use the projector if a problem should occur.

Abnormal operations such as smoke, strange odor, no image, no sound, excessive sound, damaged casing or elements or cables, penetration of liquids or foreign matter, etc. can cause a fire or electrical shock.

In such case, immediately turn off the power switch and then disconnect the power plug from the power outlet. After making sure that the smoke or odor has stopped, contact your dealer. Never attempt to make repairs yourself because this could be dangerous.

- The power outlet should be close to the projector and easily accessible.

Use special caution for children and pets.

Incorrect handling could result in fire, electrical shock, injury, burn or vision problem.

Use special caution in households where children and pets are present.

Do not insert liquids or foreign object.

Penetration of liquids or foreign objects could result in fire or electrical shock.

Use special caution in households where children are present.

If liquids or foreign object should enter the projector, immediately turn off the power switch, disconnect the power plug from the power outlet and contact your dealer.

- Do not place the projector near water (ex. a bathroom, a beach, etc.).

- Do not expose the projector to rain or moisture. Do not place the projector outdoors.

- Do not place flower vases, pots, cups, cosmetics, liquids such as water, etc on or around the projector.

- Do not place metals, combustibles, etc on or around the projector.

- To avoid penetration of foreign objects, do not put the projector into a case or bag together with any thing except the accessories of the projector, signal cables and connectors.

Never disassemble and modify.

The projector contains high voltage components. Modification and/or disassembly of the projector or accessories could result in fire or electrical shock.

- Never open the cabinet.

- Ask your dealer to repair and clean insider.

Do not give the projector any shock or impact.

If the projector should be shocked and/or broken, it could result in an injury, and continued use could result in fire or electrical shock.

If the projector is shocked, immediately turn off the power switch, disconnect the power plug from the power outlet and contact your dealer.

Do not place the projector on an unstable surface.

If the projector should be dropped and/or broken, it could result in an injury, and continued use could result in fire or electrical shock.

- Do not place the projector on an unstable, slant or vibrant surface such as a wobbly or inclined stand.

- Use the caster brakes placing the projector on a stand with casters.

- Do not place the projector in the side up position, the lens up position or the lens down position.

- In the case of a ceiling installation or the like, contact your dealer before installation.

HITACHI CPX10WN - Do not place the projector on an unstable surface. - 1
Disconnect the plug from the power outlet.

HITACHI CPX10WN - Do not place the projector on an unstable surface. - 2

HITACHI CPX10WN - Do not place the projector on an unstable surface. - 3

HITACHI CPX10WN - Do not place the projector on an unstable surface. - 4
Do not disassemble.

HITACHI CPX10WN - Do not place the projector on an unstable surface. - 5

HITACHI CPX10WN - Do not place the projector on an unstable surface. - 6

Safety Precautions (continued)

HITACHI CPX10WN - Safety Precautions (continued) - 1

WARNING

Be cautious of High temperatures of the projector.

High temperatures are generated when the lamp is lit. It could result in fire or burn. Use special caution in households where children are present.

Do not touch about the lens, air fans and ventilation openings during use or immediately after use, to prevent a burn. Take care of ventilation.

  • Keep a space of 30 cm or more between the sides and other objects such as walls.
  • Do not place the projector on a metallic table or anything weak in heat.
  • Do not place anything about the lens, air fans and ventilation openings of the projector.
  • Never block the air fan and ventilation openings.
  • Do not cover the projector with a tablecloth, etc.
  • Do not place the projector on a carpet or bedding.

Never look through the lens or openings when the lamp is on.

The powerful light could adversely affect vision.

Use special caution in households where children are present.

Use only the correct power cord and the correct power outlet.

Incorrect power supply could result in fire or electrical shock.

- Use only the correct power outlet depending on the indication on the projector and the safety standard.

- The enclosed power cord must be used depending on the power outlet to be used.

Be cautious of the power cord connection.

Incorrect connection of the power cord could result in fire or electrical shock.

- Do not touch the power cord with a wet hand.

- Check that the connecting portion of the power cord is clean (with no dust), before using. Use a soft and dry cloth to clean the power plug.

- Insert the power plug into a power outlet firmly. Avoid using a loose, unsound outlet or contact failure.

Be sure to connect with ground wire.

Connect the ground terminal of AC inlet of this unit with the ground terminal provided at the building using the correct power cord; otherwise, fire or electric shock can result.

- Don't take the core of power cord away.

HITACHI CPX10WN - Be sure to connect with ground wire. - 1

HITACHI CPX10WN - Be sure to connect with ground wire. - 2

HITACHI CPX10WN - Be sure to connect with ground wire. - 3

HITACHI CPX10WN - Be sure to connect with ground wire. - 4

HITACHI CPX10WN - Be sure to connect with ground wire. - 5

Surely connect the ground wire.

Safety Precautions (continued)

HITACHI CPX10WN - Safety Precautions (continued) - 1

WARNING

Be careful in handling the light source lamp.

The projector uses a high-pressure mercury glass lamp made of glass. The lamp can break with a loud bang, or burn out. When the bulb bursts, it is possible for shards of glass to fly into the lamp housing, and for gas containing mercury to escape from the projector's vent holes.

Please carefully read the section "Lamp".

Be careful in handling the power cord and external connection cables.

If you keep using a damaged the power cord or cables, it can cause a fire or electrical shock. Do not apply too much heat, pressure or tension to the power cord and cables.

If the power cord or cables is damaged (exposed or broken core wires, etc.), contact your dealer.

  • Do not place the projector or heavy objects on the power cord and cables. Also, do not place a spread, cover, etc, over them because this could result in the inadvertent placing of heavy objects on the concealed power cord or cables.
  • Do not pull the power cord and cables. When connecting and disconnecting the power cord or cables, do it with your hand holding the plug or connector.
  • Do not place the cord near the heater.
  • Avoid bending the power cord sharply.
  • Do not attempt to work on the power cord.

Be careful in handling the battery of the remote control.

Incorrect handling of the battery could result in fire or personal injury. The battery may explode if not handled properly.

  • Keep the battery away from children and pets. If swallowed consult a physician immediately for emergency treatment.
  • Do not allow the battery in a fire or water.
  • Avoid fire or high-temperature environment.
  • Do not hold the battery with the metallic tweezers.
  • Keep the battery in a dark, cool and dry play.
  • Do not short circuit the battery.
  • Do not recharge, disassemble or solder the battery.
  • Do not give the battery a physical impact.
  • Use only the battery specified in the other manual of this projector.
  • Make sure the plus and minus terminals are correctly aligned when loading the battery.
  • If you observe a leakage of the battery, wipe out the flower and then replace the battery. If the flower adheres your body or clothes, rinse well with water.
  • Obey the local laws on disposing the battery.

HITACHI CPX10WN - Be careful in handling the battery of the remote control. - 1

HITACHI CPX10WN - Be careful in handling the battery of the remote control. - 2

HITACHI CPX10WN - Be careful in handling the battery of the remote control. - 3

Safety Precautions (continued)

HITACHI CPX10WN - Safety Precautions (continued) - 1

CAUTION

Be careful in moving the projector.

Neglect could result in an injury or damage.

  • Do not move the projector during use. Before moving, disconnect the power cord and all external connections, and close the slide lens door or attach the lens cap.
  • Avoid any impact or shock to the projector.
  • Do not drag the projector.
  • For moving the projector, use the enclosed case or bag if provided.

Do not put anything on top of the projector.

Placing anything on the projector could result in loss of balance or falling, and cause an injury or damage. Use special caution in households where children are present.

Do not attach anything other than specified things to the projector.

Neglect could result in an injury or damage.

- Some projector has a screw thread in a lens part. Do not attach anything other than specified options (such as conversion lens) to the screw thread.

Avoid a smoky, humid or dusty place.

Placing the projector in a smoke, a highly humid, dusty place, oily soot or corrosive gas could result in fire or electrical shock.

  • Do not place the projector near a smoky, humid or dusty place (ex. a smoking space, a kitchen, a beach, etc.). Do not place the projector outdoors.
  • Do not use a humidifier near the projector.

Take care of the air filter to normal ventilate.

The air filter should be cleaned periodically. If the air filter becomes clogged by dust or the like, internal temperature rises and could cause malfunction. The projector may display the message such as “CHECK THE AIR FLOW” or turn off the projector, to prevent the internal heat level rising.

  • When the indicators or a message prompts you to clean the air filter, clean the air filter as soon as possible.
  • If the soiling will not come off the air filter, or it becomes damaged, replace the air filter.
  • Use the air filter of the specified type only. Please order the air filter specified in the other manual of this projector to your dealer.
  • When you replace the lamp, replace also the air filter. The air filter may be attached when you buy a replacement lamp for this projector.
  • Do not turn on the projector without air filter.

Avoid a high temperature environment.

The heat could have adverse influence on the cabinet of the projector and other parts. Do not place the projector, the remote control and other parts in direct sunlight or near a hot object such as heater, etc.

Avoid Magnetism.

Manufacture strongly recommends to avoid any magnetic contact that is not shielded or protected on or near the projector itself. (ie., Magnetic Security Devices, or other projector accessory that contains magnetic material that has not been provided by the manufacture etc.) Magnetic objects may cause interruption of the projector's internal mechanical performance which may interfere with cooling fans speed or stopping, and may cause the projector to completely shut down.

HITACHI CPX10WN - Avoid Magnetism. - 1

HITACHI CPX10WN - Avoid Magnetism. - 2

HITACHI CPX10WN - Avoid Magnetism. - 3

HITACHI CPX10WN - Avoid Magnetism. - 4

HITACHI CPX10WN - Avoid Magnetism. - 5

HITACHI CPX10WN - Avoid Magnetism. - 6

HITACHI CPX10WN - Avoid Magnetism. - 7

Safety Precautions (continued)

HITACHI CPX10WN - Safety Precautions (continued) - 1

CAUTION

Remove the power cord for complete separation.

  • For safety purposes, disconnect the power cord if the projector is not to be used for prolonged periods of time.
  • Before cleaning, turn off and unplug the projector. Neglect could result in fire or electrical shock.

Ask your dealer to cleaning inside of the projector about every year.

Accumulations of dust inside the projector cause result in fire or malfunction. Cleaning inside is more effective if performed before every humid periods such as rainy season.

- Do not clean inside yourself because it is dangerous.

HITACHI CPX10WN - Ask your dealer to cleaning inside of the projector about every year. - 1
Disconnect the plug from the power outlet.

HITACHI CPX10WN - Ask your dealer to cleaning inside of the projector about every year. - 2

NOTE

Do not give the remote control any physical impact.

A physical impact could cause damage or malfunction of the remote control.

• Take care not to drop the remote control.
- Do not place the projector or heavy objects on the remote control.

Take care of the lens.

  • Close the slide lens door or attach the lens cap to prevent the lens surface being scratched when the projector is not used.
  • Do not touch the lens to prevent fog or dirt of the lens that cause deterioration of display quality.
  • Use commercially available lens tissue to clean the lens (used to clean cameras, eyeglasses, etc.). Be careful not to scratch the lens with hard objects.

Take care of the cabinet and the remote control.

Incorrect care could have adverse influence such as discoloration, peeling paint, etc.

  • Use a soft cloth to clean the cabinet and control panel of the projector and the remote control. When excessively soiled dilute a neutral detergent in water, wet and wring out the soft cloth and afterward wipe with a dry soft cloth. Do not use undiluted detergent directly.
  • Do not use an aerosol sprays, solvents, volatile substances or abrasive cleaner.
  • Before using chemical wipes, be sure to read and observe the instructions.
  • Do not allow long-term close contact with rubber or vinyl.

About bright spots or dark spots.

Although bright spots or dark spots may appear on the screen, this is a unique characteristic of liquid crystal displays, and such do not constitute or imply a machine defect.

Be careful of printing of the LCD panel.

If the projector continues projecting a still image, inactive images or 16:9 aspect images in case of 4:3 panel, etc., for long time, the LCD panel might possibly be printed.

Safety Precautions (continued)

NOTE

About consumables.

Lamp, LCD panels, polarizers and other optical components, and air filter and cooling fans have a different lifetime in each. These parts may need to be replaced after a long usage time.

  • This product isn't designed for continuous use of long time. In the case of continuous use for 6 hours or more, or use for 6 hours or more every day (even if it isn't continuous), or repetitious use, the lifetime may be shortened, and these parts may need to be replaced even if one year has not passed since the beginning of using.
  • Any inclining use beyond the adjustment range explained in these user's manuals may shorten the lifetimes of the consumables.

Before turning on the power, make the projector cool down adequately.

After turning the projector off, pushing the restart switch or interrupting of the power supply, make the projector cool down adequately. Operation in a high temperature state of the projector causes a damage of the electrode and un-lighting of the lamp.

Avoid strong rays.

Any strong ray (such as direct rays of the sun or room lighting) onto the remote control sensors could invalidate the remote control.

Avoid radio interference.

Any interfering radiation could cause disordered image or noises.

- Avoid radio generator such as a mobile telephone, transceiver, etc. around the projector.

About displaying characteristic.

The display condition of the projector (such as color, contrast, etc.) depends on characteristic of the screen, because the projector uses a liquid crystal display panel. The display condition can differ from the display of CRT.

- Do not use a polarized screen. It can cause red image.

Turn the power on/off in right order.

To prevent any trouble, turn on/off the projector in right order mentioned below unless specifying.

  • Power on the projector before the computer or video tape recorder.
  • Power off the projector after the computer or video tape recorder.

Take care not to fatigue your eyes.

Rest the eyes periodically.

Set the sound volume at a suitable level to avoid bothering other people.

- It is better to keep the volume level low and close the windows at night to protect the neighborhood environment.

Connecting with notebook computer

When connecting with notebook computer, set to valid the RGB external image output (setting CRT display or simultaneous display of LCD and CRT).

Please read instruction manual of the notebook for more information.

Lamp

HITACHI CPX10WN - Lamp - 1

WARNING

HITACHI CPX10WN - WARNING - 1

HIGH VOLTAGE

HITACHI CPX10WN - WARNING - 2

HIGH TEMPERATURE

HITACHI CPX10WN - WARNING - 3

HIGH PRESSURE

The projector uses a high-pressure mercury glass lamp. The lamp can break with a loud bang, or burn out, if jolted or scratched, handled while hot, or worn over time. Note that each lamp has a different lifetime, and some may burst or burn out soon after you start using them. In addition, when the bulb bursts, it is possible for shards of glass to fly into the lamp housing, and for gas containing mercury to escape from the projector's vent holes.

About disposal of a lamp • This product contains a mercury lamp; do not put in trash. Dispose of in accord with environmental laws. For lamp recycling, go to www.lamprecycle.org. (in USA) For product disposal, contact your local government agency or www.eiae.org (in the US) or www.epsc.ca (in Canada). For more information, call your dealer.

HITACHI CPX10WN - WARNING - 4

Disconnect the plug from the power outlet

- If the lamp should break (it will make a loud bang when it does), unplug the power cord from the outlet, and make sure to request a replacement lamp from your local dealer. Note that shards of glass could damage the projector's internals, or cause injury during handling, so please do not try to clean the projector or replace the lamp yourself. - If the lamp should break (it will make a loud bang when it does), ventilate the room well, and make sure not to breathe the gas that comes out of the projector vents, or get it in your eyes or mouth. - Before replacing the lamp, make sure the power switch is off and the power cable is not plugged in, then wait at least 45 minutes for the lamp to cool sufficiently. Handling the lamp while hot can cause burns, as well as damaging the lamp.

HITACHI CPX10WN - WARNING - 5

- Do not open the lamp cover while the projector is suspended from above. This is dangerous, since if the lamp's bulb has broken, the shards will fall out when the cover is opened. In addition, working in high places is dangerous, so ask your local dealer to have the lamp replaced even if the bulb is not broken. - Do not use the projector with the lamp cover removed. At the lamp replacing, make sure that the screws are screwed in firmly. Loose screws could result in damage or injury.

HITACHI CPX10WN - WARNING - 6

- Use the lamp of the specified type only. - If the lamp breaks soon after the first time it is used, it is possible that there are electrical problems elsewhere besides the lamp. If this happens, contact your local dealer or a service representative. - Handle with care: jolting or scratching could cause the lamp bulb to burst during use. - Using the lamp for long periods of time, could cause it dark, not to light up or to burst. When the pictures appear dark, or when the color tone is poor, please replace the lamp as soon as possible. Do not use old (used) lamps; this is a cause of breakage.

Regulatory Notices

FCC Statement Warning

This device complies with part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.

WARNING: This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device, pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference in a residential installation. This equipment generates, uses, and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instructions, may cause harmful interference to radio communications. However, there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular installation. If this equipment does cause harmful interference to radio or television reception, which can be determined by turning the equipment off and on, the user is encouraged to try to correct the interference by one or more of the following measures:

  • Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.
  • Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver.
  • Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different from that to which the receiver is connected.
  • Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/TV technician for help.

INSTRUCTIONS TO USERS: This equipment complies with the requirements of FCC (Federal Communication Commission) equipment provided that the following conditions are met. Some cables have to be used with the core set. Use the accessory cable or a designated-type cable for the connection. For cables that have a core only at one end, connect the core to the projector.

CAUTION: Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user's authority to operate the equipment.

For the Customers in CANADA

NOTICE: This Class B digital apparatus complies with Canadian ICES-003.

Warranty And After-Service

Unless seen any abnormal operations (mentioned with the first paragraph of WARNING in this manual), when a problem occurs with the equipment, first refer to the “Troubleshooting” section of the “Operating Guide”, and run through the suggested checks. If this does not resolve the problem contact your dealer or service company. They will tell you what warranty condition is applied.

Contents

HITACHI CPX10WN - Contents - 1

HITACHI CPX10WN - Contents - 2

Introduction 3

Features ....
Checking the contents of package... 3
Part names ....

Setting up 7

Arrangement 7
Connecting with your devices ..... 10
Connecting to a power supply ..... 15
Fastening the adapter cover ..... 16
Using the security bar and slot . . . . 16

Remote control ..... 1 7

Installing the batteries ..... 17
About the remote control signal ... 17
Using as a simple PC mouse & keyboard . . 18

Power on/off 19

Turning on the power ..... 19
Turning off the power ..... 20

Operating 21

Adjusting the volume ..... 21
Temporarily muting the sound ..... 21
Selecting an input signal ..... 22
Searching an input signal ..... 2 3
Selecting an aspect ratio ..... 2 3

Adjusting the projector's elevator . . 24

Adjusting the zoom and focus ..... 24

Using the automatic adjustment feature. . . 25

Adjusting the position ..... 25

Correcting the keystone distortions. . 26

Using the magnify feature ..... 27

Temporarily freezing the screen . . . 28

Temporarily blanking the screen .. 28

Using the menu function .....29

EASY MENU....31

ASPECT, AUTO KEYSTONE, KEystone,
PICTURE MODE, ECO MODE, INSTALLATION,
RESET, FILTER TIME, LANGUAGE,
ADVANCED MENU, EXIT

PICTURE menu ..... 33

BRIGHTNESS, CONTRAST, GAMMA, COLOR TEMP, COLOR, TINT, SHARPNESS, MY MEMORY

IMAGE menu ....36

ASPECT, OVER SCAN, V POSITION, H POSITION, H PHASE, H SIZE, AUTO ADJUST EXECUTE

INPUT menu 39

PROGRESSIVE, VIDEO NR, COLOR SPACE, VIDEO FORMAT, HDMI FORMAT, HDMI RANGE, COMPUTER IN, FRAME LOCK, RESOLUTION

SETUP menu 43

. .AUTO KEYSTONE, KEystone, AUTO ECO MODE,
Eco mode, INSTALLATION, STANDBY MODE,
MONITOR OUT

AUDIO menu 46

VOLUME, SPEAKER, AUDIO SOURCE, HDMI AUDIO

SCREEN menu. 47

LANGUAGE, MENU POSITION, BLANK, STARTUP, MyScreen, MyScreen Lock, MESSAGE, SOURCE NAME, TEMPLATE, C.C.

OPTION menu ....53

AUTO SEARCH, AUTO KEYSTONE, DIRECT POWER ON, AUTO POWER OFF, USB TYPE B, LAMP TIME, FILTER TIME, MY BUTTON, MY SOURCE, SERVICE

NETWORK menu 63

WIRELESS SETUP, WIRELESS INFORMATION, WIRED SETUP, WIRED INFORMATION, PROJECTOR NAME, MY IMAGE, AMX D.D., PRESENTATION, SERVICE

SECURITY menu ..... 7 4

SECURITY PASSWORD CHANGE, MYSCREEN PASSWORD, PIN LOCK, TRANSITION DETECTOR, MY TEXT PASSWORD, MY TEXT DISPLAY, MY TEXT WRITING

Presentation tools ..... 8 0

PC-LESS Presentation ..... 80

Thumbnail Mode, Full Screen Mode, Slideshow Mode, Playlist

USB Display....89

Starting USB Display, Right-Click menu, Floating menu, Options window

Maintenance 93

Replacing the lamp 93
Cleaning and replacing the air filter . . 95
Other care 97

Troubleshooting 98

Related messages 98
Regarding the indicator lamps ... 100
Resetting all settings ..... 102
Phenomena that may be easy to be mistaken for machine defects. 102

Specifications ..... 10 7

Introduction

Features

The projector provides you with the broad use by the following features.

√ This projector has a variety of I/O ports that supposedly cover for any business scene. The HDMI port can support various image equipment which have digital interface to get clearer pictures on a screen.
√ If you insert a USB storage device, such as a USB memory, into the USB TYPE A port and select the port as the input source, you can view images stored in the device.
√ This projector can be controlled and monitored via LAN connection. Furthermore, you can use the designated USB wireless adapter (optional) to establish wireless LAN connection.
√ This compact, lightweight projector uses a front exhaust system that keeps the user comfortable by directing hot air away from the user.

Checking the contents of package

Please see the Contents of package section in the User's Manual (concise) which is a book. Your projector should come with the items shown there. Require of your dealer immediately if any items are missing.

⚠ WARNING ▶ Keep small parts away from children and pets. Take care not to put in the mouth. If swallowed, consult a physician immediately for emergency treatment.

NOTE • Keep the original packing materials, for future reshipment. Be sure to use the original packing materials when moving the projector. Use special caution for the lens. • The projector may make a rattling sound when tilted, moved or shaken, since a flap to control the air flow inside of the projector has moved. Be aware that this is not a failure or malfunction.

Part names

(1) Lamp cover (93) The lamp unit is inside.
(2) FOCUS ring (24)
(3) ZOOM ring (24)
(4) Control panel (5)
(5) Elevator buttons (x 2) (24)
(6) Elevator feet (x 2) (24)
(7) Remote sensor (17)
(8) Lens (97)
(9) Intake vents
(10) Filter cover 📄95) The air filter and intake vent are inside.
(11) Speaker (46)
(12) Exhaust vent
(13) AC IN (AC inlet) (15)
(14) Rear panel (5)
(15) Security bar (16)
(16) Security slot (16)

HOT! (1) (2) (3) (4) (6) (8) (7) (6) (11) (9) (15) (10) (5) (6) HOT! (12)

HITACHI CPX10WN - Part names - 2

(13) (16) (14) (9) (5)

⚠ WARNING ▶ Do not open or remove any portion of the product, unless the manuals direct it.

▶ Do not subject the projector to unstable conditions.
▶ Do not apply a shock or pressure to this product.
▶ Do not look into the lens and the openings on the projector while the lamp is on.
⚠️ CAUTION ▶ Do not touch around the lamp cover and the exhaust vents during use or just after use, since it is too hot.
▶ Do not attach anything onto the lens except the lens cover of this projector because it could damage the lens, such as melting the lens.

HITACHI CPX10WN - Part names - 4

(continued on next page)

Part names (continued)

Control panel

(1) STANDBY/ON button (19)
(2) INPUT button (22, 29)
(3) MENU button (29) It consists of four cursor buttons.

(4) ECO button (56, 57)

(5) POWER indicator (19, 100)

(6) TEMP indicator (100)

(7) LAMP indicator (100)

HITACHI CPX10WN - Control panel - 1

HITACHI CPX10WN - Control panel - 2

flowchart
graph LR
    A["STANDBY/ON"] --> B["INPUT"]
    B --> C["MENU"]
    C --> D["OUTPUT"]
    style A fill:#f9f,stroke:#333
    style B fill:#ccf,stroke:#333
    style C fill:#cfc,stroke:#333
    style D fill:#fcc,stroke:#333

Rear panel (11\~14)

(1) LAN port
(2) USB TYPE A port
(3) HDMI port
(4) USB TYPE B port
(5) VIDEO port
(6) S-VIDEO port
(7) AUDIO IN1 port

(8) AUDIO IN2 port
(9) COMPUTER IN1 port
(10) COMPUTER IN2 port
(11) AUDIO OUT port
(12) MONITOR OUT port
(13) CONTROL port

(1) (2) (7) (3) (4) (5) (6) (8) (9) (10) HDMI USB TYPE A DC5V 0.5A USB TYPE B COMPUTER IN1 COMPUTER IN2 S-VIDEO VIDEO AUDIO IN1 AUDIO IN1 LAN AC IN CONTROLMONITOR OUTAUDIO OUT (11) (13)(12)

(continued on next page)

Part names (continued)

Remote control

(1) VIDEO button (22)
(2) COMPUTER button (22)
(3) SEARCH button (23)
(4) STANDBY/ON button (19)
(5) ASPECT button (23)
(6) AUTO button (25)
(7) BLANK button (28)
(8) MAGNIFY - ON button (27)
(9) MAGNIFY - OFF button (27)
(10) MY SOURCE/DOC.CAMERA button (22, 57)
(11) VOLUME - button (21)
(12) PAGE UP button (18)
(13) PAGE DOWN button (18)
(14) VOLUME + button (21)
(15) MUTE button (21)
(16) FREEZE button (28)
(17) MY BUTTON - 1 button (56, 57)
(18) MY BUTTON - 2 button (56, 57)
(19) KEYSTONE button (26)
(20) POSITION button (25, 29)
(21) MENU button (29)
(22) ▲/▼/◄/► cursor buttons (29)
(23) ENTER button (29)
(24) ESC button (29)
(25) RESET button (29)
(26) Battery cover (17)

(2) (1) (6) (5) (16) (8) (9) (19) (17) (20) (22) (24) VIDEO COMPUTER V-SC, RGB AC/DC/DC AUTO ON OFF KEY/ONE S/N BUTTON KON/OFF EXCEL ESC RESET (10) (4) (3) (7) (12) (14) (11) (13) (15) (18) (21) (23) (25)

Back of the remote control
(26)

Setting up

Install the projector according to the environment and manner the projector will be used in.

For the case of installation in a special state such as ceiling mount, the specified mounting accessories (Specifications in the User's Manual (concise)) and service may be required. Before installing the projector, consult your dealer about your installation.

HITACHI CPX10WN - Setting up - 1

natural_image Diagram of a room layout with a printer, washing machine, and chair (no text or symbols)

Arrangement

Refer to tables T-1 and T-2 at the back of User's Manual (concise) as well as the following to determine the screen size and projection distance.

The values shown in the table are calculated for a full size screen.

a Screen size (diagonal)
(b) Projection distance (±10%, from the projector's end)
c1, c2 Screen height (±10%)

- If the projector is used at an altitude of about 1600 m (5250 feet) or higher, set ALTITUDE of the SERVICE item in the OPTION menu to HIGH (57). Otherwise, set it to NORMAL. If the projector is used with a wrong setting, it may cause damage to the projector itself or the parts inside.

(continued on next page)

Arrangement (continued)

⚠ WARNING ▶ Install the projector where you can access the power outlet easily. If an abnormality should occur, unplug the projector urgently. Otherwise it could cause a fire or electric shock.

▶ Do not subject the projector to unstable conditions. If the projector falls or topples over, it could result in injury or damage to the projector and the surrounding things. Using a damaged projector could result in a fire and an electric shock.

  • Do not place the projector in unstable places, such as an inclined surface, places subject to vibration, on top of a wobbly table or cart, or a surface that is smaller than the projector.
  • Do not put the projector on its side, front or rear position.
  • Do not attach nor place anything on the projector unless otherwise specified in the manual.
  • Do not use any mounting accessories except the accessories specified by the manufacturer. Read and keep the manuals of the accessories used.
  • For special installation such as ceiling mounting, be sure to consult your dealer beforehand.

▶ Do not install the projector near thermally conductive or flammable things. Such things when heated by the projector could result in a fire and burns.

  • Do not place the projector on a metal stand.
    ▶ Do not place the projector where any oils, such as cooking or machine oil, are used. Oil may harm the product, resulting in malfunction, or falling from the mounted position.
    ▶ Do not place the projector in a place where it may get wet. Getting the projector wet or inserting liquid into the projector could cause a fire and an electric shock, and damage the projector.

- Do not place the projector near water, such as in a bathroom, kitchen, or poolside.

- Do not place the projector outdoors or by the window.

- Do not place anything containing liquid near the projector.

(continued on next page)

Arrangement (continued)

⚠️ CAUTION ▶ Place the projector in a cool place with sufficient

ventilation. The projector may shutdown automatically or may malfunction if its internal temperature is too high.

Using a damaged projector could result in a fire and an electric shock.

  • Do not place the projector in direct sunlight or near hot objects such as heaters.
  • Do not place the projector where the air from an air conditioner or similar unit will blow on it directly.
  • Keep a space of 30 cm or more between a side of the projector and other objects such as walls.
  • Do not place the projector on carpet, cushions or bedding.
  • Do not stop up, block nor cover the projector's vent holes. Do not place anything around the projector that could be sucked in or stuck to the projector's intake vents.
  • Do not place the projector at places that are exposed to magnetic fields, doing so can cause the cooling fans inside the projector to malfunction.

▶ Avoid placing the projector in smoky, humid or dusty place. Placing the projector in such places could cause a fire, an electric shock and malfunction of the projector.

- Do not place the projector near humidifiers. Especially for an ultrasonic humidifier, chlorine and minerals contained in tap water are atomized and could be deposited in the projector causing image degradation or other problems.

NOTICE • Do not place the projector in a smoking area, kitchen, passageway or by the window.

  • Position the projector to prevent light from directly hitting the projector's remote sensor.
  • Do not place the product in a place where radio interference may be caused.
  • Check and correct the setting for ALTITUDE of SERVICE in the OPTION menu according to the usage environment (57). If the projector is used with a wrong setting, it may cause damage to the projector itself or the parts inside.
  • Keep heat-sensitive things away from the projector. Otherwise, they may be damaged by the heat from the projector.

Connecting with your devices

Before connecting the projector to a device, consult the manual of the device to confirm that the device is suitable for connecting with this projector and prepare the required accessories, such as a cable in accord with the signal of the device. Consult your dealer when the required accessory did not come with the product or the accessory is damaged.

After making sure that the projector and the devices are turned off, perform the connection, according to the following instructions. Refer to the figures in subsequent pages.

Before connecting the projector to a network system, be sure to read Network Guide too.

⚠ WARNING ▶ Use only the appropriate accessories. Otherwise it could cause a fire or damage the projector and devices.

  • Use only the accessories specified or recommended by the projector's manufacturer. It may be regulated under some standard.
  • Neither disassemble nor modify the projector and the accessories.
  • Do not use the damaged accessory. Be careful not to damage the accessories. Route a cable so that it is neither stepped on nor pinched out.

⚠️ CAUTION ▶ For a cable with a core at only one end, connect the end with the core to the projector. That may be required by EMI regulations.

NOTE • Do not turn on or off the projector while connected to a device in operation, unless that is directed in the manual of the device. Otherwise it may cause malfunction in the device or projector.

  • The function of some input ports can be selected according to your usage requirements. Check the reference page indicated beside each port in the following illustration.
  • Be careful not to mistakenly connect a connector to a wrong port. Otherwise it may cause malfunction in the device or projector.
  • When connecting a connector to a port, make sure that the shape of the connector fits the port.
  • Tighten the screws to connect a connector equipped with screws to a port.
  • Use the cables with straight plugs, not L-shaped ones, as the input ports of the projector are recessed.

About Plug-and-Play capability

  • Plug-and-Play is a system composed of a computer, its operating system and peripheral equipment (i.e. display devices). This projector is VESA DDC 2B compatible. Plug-and-Play can be used by connecting this projector to a computer that is VESA DDC (display data channel) compatible.
  • Take advantage of this feature by connecting a computer cable to the COMPUTER IN1 port (DDC 2B compatible). Plug-and-Play may not work properly if any other type of connection is attempted.
  • Please use the standard drivers in your computer as this projector is a Plug-and-Play monitor.

Connecting with your devices (continued)

Computer AUDIO OUT HDMI USB TYPE A RGB OUT HDMI USB TYPE A DC5V 0.5A USB TYPE B COMPUTER IN1 COMPUTER IN2 S-VIDEO VIDEO AUDIO IN1 CONTROLMONITOR OUTAUDIO OUT

NOTE • Before connecting the projector to a computer, consult the computer's manual and check the compatibility of the signal level, the synchronization methods and the display resolution output to the projector.

  • Some signal may need an adapter to input this projector.
  • Some computers have multiple screen display modes that may include some signals which are not supported by this projector.
  • Although the projector can display signals with resolution up to UXGA (1600x1200), the signal will be converted to the projector's panel resolution before being displayed. The best display performance will be achieved if the resolutions of the input signal and the projector panel are identical.

- If you connect this projector and a notebook computer, you need output the display to an external monitor, or output simultaneously to the internal display and an external monitor. Consult the computer's manual for the setting.

- Depending on the input signal, the automatic adjustment function of this projector may take some time and not function correctly.

- Note that a composite sync signal or sync-on-green signal may confuse the automatic adjustment function of this projector (41).

- If the automatic adjustment function does not work correctly, you may not see the dialog to set the display resolution. In such a case, use an external display device. You may be able to see the dialog and set an appropriate display resolution.

(continued on next page)

Connecting with your devices (continued)

HITACHI CPX10WN - Connecting with your devices (continued) - 1

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Computer External device"] --> B["Access point"]
    B --> C["USB wireless adapter (optional)"]
    B --> D["USB storage device"]
    C --> E["LAN"]
    C --> F["USB TYPE A"]
    C --> G["RS-232C"]
    C --> H["RS-232C"]
    D --> I["LAN AC IN"]
    D --> J["HDMI USB TYPE A DC5V 0.5A"]
    D --> K["USB TYPE B"]
    D --> L["COMPUTER IN1 COMPUTER IN2 S-VIDEO VIDEO AUDIO IN1"]
    D --> M["CONTROLMONITOR OUTAUDIO OUT"]

⚠️ CAUTION ▶ Before connecting the projector to a network system be sure to obtain the consent of the administrator of the network.

▶ Do not connect the LAN port to any network that might have the excessive voltage.
The designated USB wireless adapter that is sold as an option is required to use the wireless network function of this projector.
▶ Before removing the USB storage device from the port of the projector, be sure to use the REMOVE USB function on the thumbnail screen to secure your data (83).
▶ Do not use any extension cable or device when connecting the adapter to the projector. Before you insert or pull out the USB wireless adapter from the projector, turn off the power of the projector and pull out the power cord's plug from the outlet. Do not touch the USB wireless adapter while the projector is receiving AC power.
To connect both the LAN cable and USB device to the projector, use a LAN cable that is flat on the side where the plug's wire is visible. Otherwise, both of them cannot be connected correctly, or the wire may break (malfunction).

NOTE • If an oversized USB storage device blocks the LAN port, use a USB extension cable to connect the USB storage device.

(continued on next page)

Connecting with your devices (continued)

LAN AC IN HDMI USB TYPE A DC5V 0.5A USB TYPE B COM R IN1 COMPUTER IN2 S-VIDEO VIDEO AUDIO IN1 AUDIO IN2 CONTROLMONITOR OUTAUDIO OUT HDMI S-VIDEO OUT L R AUDIO OUT VIDEO OUT L R AUDIO OUT L R AUDIO OUT Y CEPS CEPR COMPONENT VIDEO OUT

VCR/DVD/Blu-ray Disc™ player

NOTE • The HDMI port of this model is compatible with HDCP (High-bandwidth Digital Content Protection) and therefore capable of displaying a video signal from HDCP compatible DVD players or the like.

- The HDMI supports the following signals.

Video signal : 480i@60, 480p@60, 576i@50, 576p@50, 720p@50/60, 1080i@50/60, 1080p@50/60

Audio signal : Format Linear PCM Sampling frequency 48kHz / 44.1kHz / 32kHz

  • This projector can be connected with another equipment that has HDMI™ connector, but with some equipment the projector may not work properly, something like no video.
  • Be sure to use an HDMI™ cable that has the HDMI™ logo.
  • Use a Category 2-certified HDMI™ cable to input 1080p@50/60 signal to the projector.
  • When the projector is connected with a device having DVI connector, use a DVI to HDMI™ cable to connect with the HDMI input.

(continued on next page)

Connecting with your devices (continued)

Speakers (with an amplifier) L R Monitor RGB IN HDMI USB TYPE A DC5V 0. USB TYPE B COMPUTER IN1 COMPUTER IN2 S-VIDEO VIDEO AUDIO IN1 AUDIO IN2 LAN AC IN CONTROLMONITOR OUTAUDIO OUT

Connecting to a power supply

  1. Put the connector of the power cord into the AC IN (AC inlet) of the projector.
  2. Firmly plug the power cord's plug into the outlet. In a couple of seconds after the power supply connection, the POWER indicator will light up in steady orange.

Please remember that when the DIRECT POWER ON function activated (53), the connection of the power supply make the projector turn on.

AC IN Power cord

⚠ WARNING ▶ Please use extra caution when connecting the power cord, as incorrect or faulty connections may result in fire and/or electrical shock.

  • Do not touch the power cord with a wet hand.
  • Only use the power cord that came with the projector. If it is damaged, consult your dealer to get a new one. Never modify the power cord.
  • Only plug the power cord into an outlet whose voltage is matched to the power cord. The power outlet should be close to the projector and easily accessible. Remove the power cord for complete separation.
  • Do not distribute the power supply to multiple devices. Doing so may overload the outlet and connectors, loosen the connection, or result in fire, electric shock or other accidents.
  • Connect the ground terminal for the AC inlet of this unit to the ground terminal of the building using an appropriate power cord (bundled).

NOTICE ▶This product is also designed for IT power systems with a phase-to-phase voltage of 220 to 240 V.

Fastening the adapter cover

Use the supplied adapter cover to prevent the USB wireless adapter from coming off easily.

  1. Loosen the screw (marked with triangle) on the bottom right of the USB TYPE A port.
  2. Insert the tab of the cover into the hole at the upper left of the USB TYPE A port in the direction of the arrow.
  3. Align the screw holes on the projector and the cover. Then insert the screw removed from the projector into the hole and tighten the screw.

1 2 Tab 3

⚠ WARNING ▶ Keep small parts away from children and pets. Take care not to put in the mouth.

Using the security bar and slot

A commercially available anti-theft chain or wire can be attached to the security bar on the projector. Refer to the figure to choose an anti-theft chain or wire.

Also this product has the security slot for the Kensington lock.

For details, see the manual of the security tool. 12 mm

01. 18 mm

12 mm 18 m In 10 mm

Security slot 12mm 18mm 18mm Anti-theft security bar chain or wire

⚠ WARNING ▶ Do not use the security bar and slot to prevent the projector from falling down, since it is not designed for it.
⚠️ CAUTION ▶ Do not place anti-theft chain or wire near the exhaust vents. It may become too hot.

NOTE • The security bar and slot is not comprehensive theft prevention measures. It is intended to be used as supplemental theft prevention measure.

Remote control

Installing the batteries

Please insert the batteries into the remote control before using it. If the remote control starts to malfunction, try to replace the batteries. If you will not use the remote control for long period, remove the batteries from the remote control and store them in a safe place.

  1. Holding the hook part of the battery cover, remove it.
  2. Align and insert the two AA batteries (HITACHI MAXELL or HITACHI MAXELL ENERGY, Part No.LR6 or R6P) according

1 2 3

to their plus and minus terminals as indicated in the remote control.

  1. Replace the battery cover in the direction of the arrow and snap it back into place.

⚠ WARNING ▶ Always handle the batteries with care and use them only as directed. Improper use may result in battery explosion, cracking or leakage, which could result in fire, injury and/or pollution of the surrounding environment.

  • Be sure to use only the batteries specified. Do not use batteries of different types at the same time. Do not mix a new battery with used one.
  • Make sure the plus and minus terminals are correctly aligned when loading a battery.
  • Keep a battery away from children and pets.
  • Do not recharge, short circuit, solder or disassemble a battery.
  • Do not place a battery in a fire or water. Keep batteries in a dark, cool and dry place.
  • If you observe battery leakage, wipe out the leakage and then replace a battery. If the leakage adheres to your body or clothes, rinse well with water immediately.
  • Obey the local laws on disposing the battery.

About the remote control signal

The remote control works with the projector's remote sensor. This projector has a remote sensor on the front. The sensor senses the signal within the following range when the sensor is active:

60 degrees (30 degrees to the left and right of the sensor) within 3 meters about.

3 m 30° 30° (approx.)

NOTE • The remote control signal reflected in the screen or the like may be available. If it is difficult to send the signal to the sensor directly, attempt to make the signal reflect.

  • The remote control uses infrared light to send signals to the projector (Class 1 LED), so be sure to use the remote control in an area free from obstacles that could block the remote control's signal to the projector.
  • The remote control may not work correctly if strong light (such as direct sun light) or light from an extremely close range (such as from an inverter fluorescent lamp) shines on the remote sensor of the projector. Adjust the position of projector avoiding those lights.

Using as a simple PC mouse & keyboard

The accessory remote control works as a simple mouse and keyboard of the computer, when the projector's USB TYPE B port and the computer's type A USB port are connected and MOUSE is selected for the USB TYPE B item in the OPTION menu (54).

USB TYPE B

USB TYPE B port

(1) PAGE UP key: Press PAGE UP button.
(2) PAGE DOWN key: Press PAGE DOWN button.
(3) Mouse left button: Press ENTER button.
(4) Move pointer: Use the cursor buttons ▲, ▼, ◀ and ▶.
(5) ESC key: Press ESC button.
(6) Mouse right button: Press RESET button.

NOTICE ▶ Improper use of the simple mouse & keyboard function could damage your equipment. While using this function, please connect this product only to a computer. Be sure to check your computer's manuals before connecting this product to the computer.

HITACHI CPX10WN - Using as a simple PC mouse & keyboard - 2

NOTE When the simple mouse & keyboard function of this product does not work correctly, please check the following.

  • When a USB cable connects this projector with a computer having a built-in pointing device (e.g. track ball) like a laptop computer, open BIOS setup menu, then select the external mouse and disable the built-in pointing device, because the built-in pointing device may have priority to this function.
  • Windows 95 OSR 2.1 or higher is required for this function. And also this function may not work depending on the computer's configurations and mouse drivers. This function can work with the computer which can operate general USB mouse or keyboard.
  • You cannot do things like press two buttons at once (for instance, pressing two buttons at the same time to move the mouse pointer diagonally).
  • This function is activated only when the projector is working properly. This function is not available in any of the following cases:
  • While the lamp is warming up. (The POWER indicator blinks in green.)
  • When either USB TYPE A or USB TYPE B port is selected.
  • While displaying BLANK (47), TEMPLATE (51) or MY IMAGE (71) screen.
  • When any menu is displayed on the screen.
  • While using the cursor buttons to operate the sound or screen functions such as adjusting the sound volume, correcting the keystone, correcting the picture position and magnifying the screen.

Power on/off

Turning on the power

  1. Make sure that the power cord is firmly and correctly connected to the projector and the outlet.
  2. Make sure that the POWER indicator is steady orange (100). Then remove the lens cover.
  3. Press STANDBY/ON button on the projector or the remote control.

The projection lamp will light up and POWER

indicator will begin blinking in green. When the

power is completely on, the indicator will stop blinking and light in steady green (100).

STANDBY/ON button POWER indicator STANDBY/ON INPUT MENU LAMP TEMP POWER

To display the picture, select an input signal according to the section Selecting an input signal (22).

The INITIAL SETTING Menu will be displayed by factory default upon startup. Once the INITIAL SETTING Menu is set, it will not appear until FACTORY RESET (62) is executed. If you wish to change the settings, refer to the LANGUAGE (47) and ALTITUDE (57) menu.

(1) LANGUAGE: Use the ▲/▼/◄/► buttons to select the desired language and press the ENTER button of the remote control or the INPUT button of the projector to execute.

INITIAL SETTING LANGUAGE ●ENGLISH ○FRANÇAIS ○DEUTSCH ○ESPAÑOL ○ITALIANO ○NORSK ○NEDERLANDS ○PORTUGUÊS ○日本語 ○延体中文 ○繁體中文 ○한over OSVENSKA OPYCKKII OSUOMI OPOLSKI OTÜRKÇE ODANSK OCESKY OMAGYAR OROMÄNÄ OSLOVENSKI OHRVATSKI OEALHNIKA OLIETUVIU OEESTI OLATVIEŞU Ö1mm Öörbi Övarası OPORTUGUÊS BRA ÖNDONESIAN ÖVIËT RESET + EXIT ENTER NEXT

(2) ALTITUDE: Use the ▲/▼ buttons to select NORMAL for altitude below 1600 m (5250 feet), otherwise select HIGH and press the ENTER button of the remote control or the INPUT button of the projector to execute.

INITIAL SETTING 2/2 ALTITUDE If the projector is used at an altitude of about 1,600m (5250feet) or higher. set ALTITUDE to HIGH [1,600m (5250feet) or higher]. Otherwise. set it to NORMAL [below 1,600m (5250feet)]. ©HIGH : 1,600m (5250feet) or higher @NORMAL : below 1,600m (5250feet) RESET + RETURN ENTER END

Turning off the power

  1. Press the STANDBY/ON button on the projector or the remote control. The message "Power off?" will appear on the screen for about 5 seconds.
  2. Press the STANDBY/ON button again while the message appears. The projector lamp will go off, and the POWER indicator will begin blinking in orange. Then POWER indicator will stop blinking and light in steady orange when the lamp cooling is complete (100).
  3. Attach the lens cover, after the POWER indicator turns in steady orange.

Do not turn the projector on for about 10 minutes or more after turning it off. Also, do not turn the projector off shortly after turning it on. Such operations might cause the lamp to malfunction or shorten the lifetime of some parts including the lamp.

⚠ WARNING ▶ A strong light is emitted when the projector's power is on. Do not look into the lens of the projector or look inside of the projector through any of the projector's openings.

▶ Do not touch around the lamp cover and the exhaust vents during use or just after use, since it is too hot.

NOTE • Turn the power on/off in right order. Please power on the projector prior to the connected devices.
- This projector has the function that can make the projector automatically turn on/off. Please refer to the DIRECT POWER ON (53) and AUTO POWER OFF (54) items of the OPTION menu.

Precaution for lens cover attachment and removal

When you attach or remove the lens cover, move it vertically up and down while keeping the knob to the right as illustrated in the figure.

HITACHI CPX10WN - Precaution for lens cover attachment and removal - 1

natural_image Diagram of a camera with an upward arrow indicating motion or force, no text or symbols present

Diagram showing a device with a red X symbol above it and an arrow pointing upward, indicating a warning or rejection.

Operating

Adjusting the volume

VOLUME +/- button

  1. Use the VOLUME +/VOLUME - buttons to adjust the volume. A dialog will appear on the screen to aid you in adjusting the volume. If you do not do anything, the dialog will automatically disappear after a few seconds.

VIDEO ASPECT AUTO BEACH FLANK MOBILITY FREEZE PAGE 3P CYLUE OK OK OK BY STONE HY BUTTON NOTE

  • When✗ is selected for current picture input port, the volume adjustment is disabled. Please see AUDIO SOURCE item of AUDIO menu (46).
  • Even if the projector is in the standby mode, the volume is adjustable when both of the following conditions are true:

  • An option other than ✗ is selected for AUDIO OUT STANDBY in the AUDIO SOURCE item of the AUDIO menu (46).

  • NORMAL is selected in the STANDBY MODE item of the SETUP menu (45).

Temporarily muting the sound

MUTE button

1 Press MUTE button on the remote control.

A dialog will appear on the screen indicating that you have muted the sound.

To restore the sound, press the MUTE, VOLUME + or VOLUME - button. Even if you do not do anything, the dialog will automatically disappear after a few seconds.

VIDEO COMPUTER CHANGE ASPECT AUTO SEARCH BLANK MOUNT FREEZE TIME PULSE ON INNO ON KEYSONS ANY BUTTON NONE NOTE

  • When ✗ is selected for current picture input port, the sound is always muted. Please see AUDIO SOURCE item of AUDIO menu (46).
  • C.C. (Closed Caption) is automatically activated when sound is muted and an input signal containing C.C. is received. This function is available only when the signal is NTSC for VIDEO or S-VIDEO, or 480i@60 for COMPUTER IN1 or COMPUTER IN2, and when AUTO is selected for DISPLAY in the C.C. menu under the SCREEN menu (52).

Selecting an input signal

1 Press INPUT button on the projector.

Each time you press the button, the projector switches its input port from the current port as below.

HITACHI CPX10WN - Press INPUT button on the projector. - 1

flowchart
graph TD
    A["COMPUTER IN1"] --> B["COMPUTER IN2"]
    B --> C["LAN"]
    D["S-VIDEO"] --> E["HDMI"]
    F["USB TYPE A"] --> G["USB TYPE B"]
    H["↑"] --> I["↓"]
    J["↑"] --> K["←"]

INPUT button MIN INPUT MC

  • While ON is selected for AUTO SEARCH item in OPTION menu (53), the projector will keep checking the ports in above order repeatedly till an input signal is detected.
  • It may take several seconds to project the images from the USB TYPE B port.

1 Press COMPUTER button on the remote control.

Each time you press the button, the projector switches its input port from the current port as below.

HITACHI CPX10WN - Press COMPUTER button on the remote control. - 1

flowchart
graph LR
    A["COMPUTER IN1"] --> B["COMPUTER IN2"]
    B --> C["LAN"]
    D["USB TYPE B"] <--_E["USB TYPE A"]

COMPUTER button
VIDEO COMPUTER MY SOURCE ASPECT AUTO SEARCH BLANK INFORMATION FREEZE PAGE VOLVE ON UP OFF DOWN OUTPUTING MY BUTTON MULTI

- While ON is selected for AUTO SEARCH item in OPTION menu, the

projector will keep checking every port sequentially till an input signal is detected (53). If COMPUTER button is pressed when VIDEO, S-VIDEO or HDMI port is selected, the projector will check COMPUTER IN1 port first.

- It may take several seconds to project the images from the USB TYPE B port.

1 Press VIDEO button on the remote control.

Each time you press the button, the projector switches its input port from the current port as below.

HITACHI CPX10WN - Press VIDEO button on the remote control. - 1

flowchart
graph LR
    A["→ HDMI → S-VIDEO → VIDEO"] --> B["—"]

VIDEO button
VIDEO COMPUTER AVIANCE AC/AC/AC ASPECT AUTO SEARCH BLANK MOUNT FIRELLA PAGE POLD ON OFF DOWN MOYA NEXTONE ON BUTTON NOTE

- While ON is selected for AUTO SEARCH item in OPTION menu, the projector will keep checking every port sequentially till an input signal is detected (53). If VIDEO button is pressed when COMPUTER IN1, COMPUTER IN2, LAN, USB TYPE A or USB TYPE B port is selected, the projector will check HDMI port first.

1 Press the MY SOURCE / DOC. CAMERA button on

the remote control. The input signal will be changed into the signal you set as MY SOURCE (57).

- This function also can use for document camera. Select the input port that connected the document camera.

MY SOURCE /
DOC. CAMERA button
VIDEO ASPECT AUTO BEANSER DECKERS BLANK FREEZE PAGE OFF DOY VALUE + MY BUTTON

Searching an input signal

1 Press SEARCH button on the remote control.

The projector will start to check its input ports as below in order to find any input signals.

When an input is found, the projector will stop searching and display the image. If no signal is found, the projector will return to the state selected before the operation.

HITACHI CPX10WN - Press SEARCH button on the remote control. - 1

flowchart
graph TD
    A["COMPUTER IN1"] --> B["COMPUTER IN2"]
    B --> C["LAN"]
    D["S-VIDEO"] --> E["HDMI"]
    F["USB TYPE A"] --> G["USB TYPE B"]
    H["↑"] --> I["↑"]
    J["↓"] --> K["↓"]

SEARCH button
MOLD OFFICE SHORT MUTE OFFICE SHORT MUTE OFFICE OFFICE MUTE OFFICE OFFICE MUTE OFFICE OFFICE MUTE OFFICE OFFICE MUTE OFFICE OFFICE MUTE OFFICE OFFICE MUTE OFFICE OFFICE MUTE OFFICE OFFICE MUTE OFFICE OFFICE MUTE OFFICE OFFICE MUTE OFFICE OFFICE MUTE OFFICE OFFICE

  • While ON is selected for AUTO SEARCH item in OPTION menu (53), the projector will keep checking the ports in above order repeatedly till an input signal is detected.
  • It may take several seconds to project the images from the USB TYPE B port.

Selecting an aspect ratio

1 Press ASPECT button on the remote control.

Each time you press the button, the projector switches the mode for aspect ratio in turn.

○ For a computer signal

CPX10WN/CPX11WN: NORMAL → 4:3 → 16:9 → 16:10

HITACHI CPX10WN - ○ For a computer signal - 1

flowchart
graph TD
    A["CPWX12WN: NORMAL → 4:3 → 16:9 → 16:10 → NATIVE"] --> B["↑"]
    B --> C["↓"]

ASPECT button
VIDEO COMMER AVOCOMBER AVOCOMBER ANJECT AUTO SLAVESI BLANK MACROWTH TURRIZE WAL VOLVI JP OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF

○ For an HDMI ^TM signal

CPX10WN/CPX11WN: NORMAL → 4:3 → 16:9 → 16:10 → 14:9

HITACHI CPX10WN - ○ For an HDMI ^TM signal - 1

natural_image Simple horizontal line with an upward arrow at the top (no text or symbols)

CPWX12WN: NORMAL → 4:3 → 16:9 → 16:10 → 14:9 → NATIVE

HITACHI CPX10WN - ○ For an HDMI ^TM signal - 2

○ For a video signal, s-video signal or component video signal

CPX10WN/CPX11WN: 4:3 → 16:9 → 14:9

HITACHI CPX10WN - ○ For a video signal, s-video signal or component video signal - 1

flowchart
graph TD
    A["CPWX12WN: 4:3 → 16:9 → 14:9 → NATIVE"] --> B["↑"]
    B --> C["←"]
    C --> D["↑"]

○ For an input signal from the LAN, USB TYPE A or USB TYPE B port, or if there is no signal

CPX10WN/CPX11WN: 4:3 (fixed) CPWX12WN: 16:10 (fixed)

  • ASPECT button does not work when no proper signal is inputted.
  • NORMAL mode keeps the original aspect ratio setting.

Adjusting the projector's elevator

When the place to put the projector is slightly uneven to the left or right, use the elevator feet to place the projector horizontally.

Using the feet can also tilt the projector in order to project at a suitable angle to the screen, elevating the front side of the projector within 12 degrees.

HITACHI CPX10WN - Adjusting the projector's elevator - 1

natural_image Technical line drawing of a solar panel array with 12° angle标注 (no text or symbols beyond measurement)

This projector has 2 elevator feet and 2 elevator knobs. An elevator foot is adjustable while pulling up the elevator knob on the same side as it.

  1. Holding the projector, pull the elevator knobs up to loose the elevator feet.
  2. Position the front side of the projector to the desired height.
  3. Release the elevator knobs in order to lock the elevator feet.
  4. After making sure that the elevator feet are locked, put the projector down gently.
  5. If necessary, the elevator feet can be manually twisted to make more precise adjustments. Hold the projector when twisting the feet.

HITACHI CPX10WN - Adjusting the projector's elevator - 2

natural_image Illustration of a projector with labeled ports and arrows indicating mechanical components (no text or symbols present)

To loose an elevator foot, pull up the elevator knob on the same side as it.

5 djust, twist the foot.

Tofinely adjust, twist the foot.

⚠️ CAUTION ▶ Do not handle the elevator buttons without holding the projector, since the projector may drop down.

▶ Do not tilt the projector other than elevating its front within 12 degrees using the adjuster feet. A tilt of the projector exceeding the restriction could cause malfunction or shortening the lifetime of consumables, or the projector itself.

Adjusting the zoom and focus

  1. Use the ZOOM ring to adjust the screen size.
  2. Use the FOCUS ring to focus the picture.

ZOOM ring FOCUS ring

Using the automatic adjustment feature

1 Press AUTO button on the remote control.

- Pressing this button performs the following.

○ For a computer signal

The vertical position, the horizontal position and the horizontal phase will be automatically adjusted.

Make sure that the application window is set to its maximum size prior to attempting to use this feature. A dark picture may still be incorrectly adjusted. Use a bright picture when adjusting.

AUTO button
VIDEO COMPUTER MY Basketball SCHEMA NO. ASPECT AUTO SEARCH BLANK SMAPY FREEZE PAGE VALUE ON U1 DOWN DOWN REVISION MY BUTTON MUTE

○ For a video signal and s-video signal

The video format best suited for the respective input signal will be selected automatically. This function is available only when the AUTO is selected for the VIDEO FORMAT item in the INPUT menu (☐40). The vertical position and horizontal position will be automatically set to the default.

○ For a component video signal

The vertical position and horizontal position will be automatically set to the default. The horizontal phase will be automatically adjusted.

  • The automatic adjustment operation requires approx. 10 seconds. Also please note that it may not function correctly with some input.
  • When this function is performed for a video signal, a certain extra such as a line may appear outside a picture.
  • When this function is performed for a computer signal, a black frame may be displayed on the edge of the screen, depending on the computer model.
  • The items adjusted by this function may vary when the FINE or DISABLE is selected for the AUTO ADJUST item of the SERVICE item in the OPTION menu (57).

Adjusting the position

  1. Press POSITION button on the remote control when no menu is indicated.

The "POSITION" indication will appear on the screen.

2 Use the ▲/▼/◄/► cursor buttons to adjust the picture position.

  1. When you want to reset the operation, press RESET button on the remote control during the operation.

To complete this operation, press POSITION button again. Even if you do not do anything, the dialog will automatically disappear after a few seconds.

POSITION MENU ENTER ESC RESET

POSITION button

  • When this function is performed on a video signal or an s-video signal, some image such as an extra-line may appear at outside of the picture.
  • When this function is performed on a video signal or s-video signal, the range of this adjustment depends on OVER SCAN in IMAGE menu (36) setting. It is not possible to adjust when OVER SCAN is set to 10.
  • If POSITION button is pressed when a menu is indicated on screen, the displayed picture does not move its position but the menu does.
  • This function is unavailable for a signal from the LAN, USB TYPE A, USB TYPE B or HDMI port.

Correcting the keystone distortions

KEYSTONE button

  1. Press KEYSTONE button on the remote control. A dialog will appear on the screen to aid you in correcting the distortion.

HITACHI CPX10WN - Correcting the keystone distortions - 1

VIDEO COMPUTER AUTO ASSEMB AUTO SEARCH BLANK AUTO FREEZE PAGE 1:1 2:104 100% KEYSTONE 1:1 2:104 MUTE

  1. Use the ▲/▼ cursor buttons to select AUTO or MANUAL operation, and press the ▶ button to perform the following.

(1) AUTO executes automatic vertical keystone correction.
(2) MANUAL displays a dialog for keystone correction.
Use the ◀/▶ buttons for adjustment.

To close the dialog and complete this operation, press KEYSTONE button again. Even if you do not do anything, the dialog will automatically disappear after a few seconds.

HITACHI CPX10WN - Correcting the keystone distortions - 3

  • The menu or dialog will automatically disappear after several seconds of inactivity. Pressing the KEYSTONE button again finishes the operation and closes the menu or dialog.
  • The adjustable range of this function will vary among inputs. For some input, this function may not work well.
  • When REAR / CEILING or FRONT / CEILING is selected for the INSTALLATION item in the SETUP menu, the automatic vertical keystone correction function may not work correctly if the projector screen is slanted or tilted downwards.
  • When the zoom adjustment is set to the TELE (telephoto focus), this function may be excessive. This function should be used when the zoom adjustment is set to the full WIDE (wide-angle focus) whenever possible.
  • When the projector is placed on the level (about ± 4^ ), the automatic keystone distortion correction may not work.
  • When the projector is inclined to near ± 30 degree or over, this function may not work well.
  • This function will be unavailable when the Transition Detector is on (77).

Using the magnify feature

  1. Press the MAGNIFY ON button on the remote control. The picture will be magnifi ed, and the MAGNIFY dialog

will appear on the screen. When the MAGNIFY ON button is pressed for the first time after the projector is turned on, the picture will be zoomed by 1.5 times. On the dialog, triangle marks to show each direction will be displayed.

HITACHI CPX10WN - Using the magnify feature - 1

MAGNIFY ON/OFF button
VIDEO CONFLUIDING VOCADO DOCCAMER ASPECT AUDIO SEARCH BLANK ONION DELETE PAGE 11 CONE OFF DOWN KEYSTONE MUTTER MUTE

  1. The display magnification of the projector switches in order with every press of the MAGNIFY ON button.

For computer signals, HDMI™ (RGB) signals, input signals from the LAN, USB TYPE A or USB TYPE B port

1.5 times → 2 times → 3 times → 4 times → 1 time

For video signals, s-video signals, component video signals or HDMI™ (Component) signals

1.5 times 2 times 1 time

HITACHI CPX10WN - Using the magnify feature - 3

  1. While the triangles are displayed on the dialog, use the ▲/▼/◄/► cursor buttons to shift the magnifying area.
  2. Press the MAGNIFY OFF button on the remote control to exit magnification.

  3. The MAGNIFY dialog will automatically disappear in several seconds with no operation. The dialog will appear again if the MAGNIFY ON button is pressed when the dialog has automatically disappeared.

  4. The magnification is automatically disabled when the displaying signal or its display condition is changed.
  5. While the magnification is active, the keystone distortion condition may vary. It will be restored when the magnification is disabled.
  6. Some horizontal stripes might be visible on the image while magnification is active.
  7. This function is not available in the following cases:

- A sync signal in the range not supported is input.

- There is no input signal.

Temporarily freezing the screen

FREEZE button

1 Press the FREEZE button on the remote control.

The “FREEZE” indication will appear on the screen (however, the indication will not appear when the OFF is selected for the MESSAGE item in the SCREEN menu (49)), and the projector will go into the FREEZE mode, which the picture is frozen.

To exit the FREEZE mode and restore the screen to normal, press the FREEZE button again.

VIDEO AUDIO MASCULARS ASPECT AUTO BEANS BLACK UNLESS FACE FACE (L) ONION ONION COM KEYSTONE MY BUTTON MUTE

  • The projector automatically exits from the FREEZE mode when some control buttons are pressed.
  • If the projector continues projecting a still image for a long time, the LCD panel might possibly be burned in. Do not leave the projector in the FREEZE mode for too long.
  • Images might appear degraded when this function is operated, but it is not a malfunction.

Temporarily blanking the screen

1 Press BLANK button on the remote control.

The BLANK screen will be displayed instead of the screen of input signal. Please refer to BLANK item in SCREEN menu (47).

To exit from the BLANK screen and return to the input signal screen, press BLANK button again.

- The projector automatically exits from the BLANK mode when some control buttons are pressed.

BLANK button
VIDEO COMPUTER Minority ASPECT AUTO SEARCH BLACK ON UP ON COM KEYSTONE MY BUTTON MUTE

⚠️ CAUTION ▶ If you wish to have a blank screen while the projector's lamp is on, use the BLANK function above.

Taking any other action may cause the damage on the projector.

NOTE • The sound is not connected with the BLANK screen function. If necessary, set the volume or mute first. To display the BLANK screen and mute the sound at one time, use AV MUTE function (57).

Using the menu function

This projector has the following menus:

PICTURE, IMAGE, INPUT, SETUP, AUDIO, SCREEN, OPTION, NETWORK, SECURITY and EASY MENU.

EASY MENU consists of functions often used, and the other menus are classified into each purpose and brought together as the ADVANCED MENU.

Each of these menus is operated using the same methods. While the projector is displaying any menu, the MENU button on the projector works as the cursor buttons. The basic operations of these menus are as follows.

INPUT button STANSDYON INPUT MENU LAMP TEMP POWER MENUBO Cursors buttons POTENT POTENT POTENT POTENT POTENT POTENT POTENT POTENT POTENT POTENT POTENT POTENT POTENT POTENT POTENT POTENT POTENT POTENT POTENT POTENT POTENT POTENT POTENT POTENT POTENT POTIENT POTIENT POTIENT POTIENT POTIENT POTIENT POTIENT POTIENT POTIENT POTIENT POTIENT POTIENT POTIENT POTIENT POTIENT POTIENT POTIENT POTIENT POTIENT POTIENT POTIENT POTIENT POTIENT POTIENT POTIENT POTINT POTINT POTINT POTINT POTINT POTINT POTINT POTINT POTINT POTINT POTINT POTINT POTINT POTINT POTINT POTINT POTINT POTINT POTINT POTINT POTINT POTINT POTINT POTINT POTINT POTINUT POTINUT POTINUT POTINUT POTINUT POTINUT POTINUT POTINUT POTINUT POTINUT POTINUT POTINUT POTINUT POTINUT POTINUT POTINUT POTINUT POTINUT POTINUT POTINUT POTINOUT POTINOUT POTINOUT POTINOUT POTINOUT POTINOUT POTINOUT POTINOUT POTINOUT POTINOUT POTINOUT

  1. To start the MENU, press the MENU button. The MENU you last used (EASY or ADVANCED) will appear. EASY MENU has priority to appear just after powered on.

2 In the EASY MENU

(1) Use the ▲/▼ cursor buttons to select an item to operate. If you want to change it to the ADVANCED MENU, select the ADVANCED MENU.
(2) Use the ◀/▶ cursor buttons to operate the item.

In the ADVANCED MENU

(1) Use the ▲/▼ cursor buttons to select a menu. If you want to change it to the EASY MENU, select the EASY MENU.

The items in the menu appear on the right side.

(2) Press the ▶ cursor button or ENTER button to move the cursor to the right side. Then use the

EASY MENU ASPECT AUTO KEYSTONE KEystone PICTURE MODE ECO MODE INSTALLATION RESET FILTER TIME LANGUAGE ADVANCED MENU EXIT NORMAL EXECUTE +0 NORMAL NORMAL EXECUTE Oh ENGLISH COMPUTER IN 1 1024 x 768 @60Hz

ADADVANCED MENU PICTURE IMAGE INPUT SETUP AUDIO SCREEN OPTION NETWORK SECURITY EASY MENU EXIT RIGHTNESS +0 CONTRAST +0 CHAMA DEFAULT-1 COLOR TEMP MD COLOR +0 TNT +0 SHARPNESS 4 MY MEMORY COMPUTER N 1 1324 x 764 @6Hz

▲/▼ cursor buttons to select an item to operate and press the ▶ cursor button or ENTER button to progress. The operation menu or dialog of the selected item will appear.

(3) Use the buttons as instructed in the OSD to operate the item.

(continued on next page)

Using the menu function (continued)

  1. To close the MENU, press the MENU button again or select EXIT and press the ▶ cursor button or ENTER button. Even if you do not do anything, the dialog will automatically disappear after about 30 seconds.

  2. If you want to move the menu position, use the cursor buttons after pressing the POSITION button.

  3. Some functions cannot be performed when a certain input port is selected, or when a certain input signal is displayed.
  4. When you want to reset the operation, press RESET button on the remote control during the operation. Note that some items (ex. LANGUAGE, VOLUME) cannot be reset.
  5. In the ADVANCED MENU, when you want to return to the previous display, press the ◀ cursor button or ESC button on the remote control.

Indication in OSD (On Screen Display)

BRIGHTNESS RETURN +0 EXIT

FILTER TIME RESET 1234h CANCEL OK

4 MY MEMORY_LOAD-4 TEMPORARY CONDITION ARE YOU SURE YOU WISH TO LOAD? :NO YES

The meanings of the general words on the OSD are as follows.

Indication Meaning
EXITSelecting this word finishes the OSD menu. It's the same as pressing the MENU button.
RETURN Selecting this word returns the menu to the previous menu.
CANCEL or NOSelecting this word cancels the operation in the present menu and returns to the previous menu.
OK or YESSelecting this word executes the prepared function or shifts the menu to the next menu.

EASY MENU

From the EASY MENU, items shown in the table below can be performed.

Select an item using the ▲/▼ cursor buttons. Then perform it according to the following table.

EASY MENU ASPECT AUTO KEYSTONE KEYSTONE PICTURE MODE ECO MODE INSTALLATION RESET FILTER TIME LANGUAGE ADVANCED MENU EXIT NORMAL EXECUTE +0 NORMAL NORMAL EXECUTE Oh ENGLISH COMPUTER IN 1 1024 x 768 @60Hz 012345678901

Item Description
ASPECTUsing the ◀/► buttons switches the mode for aspect ratio. See the ASPECT item in IMAGE menu (36).
AUTO KEYSTONEUsing the ► button executes the auto keystone function. See the AUTO KEYSTONE item in SETUP menu (43).
KEYSTONEUsing the ◀/► buttons corrects the vertical keystone distortion. See the KEYSTONE item in SETUP menu (43).
PICTURE MODEUsing the ◀/► buttons switches the picture mode. The picture modes are combinations of GAMMA and COLOR TEMP settings. Choose a suitable mode according to the projected source. → NORMAL ⇔ CINEMA ⇔ DYNAMIC ⇔ BOARD(BLACK) → DAYTIME ⇔ WHITEBOARD ⇔ BOARD(GREEN) ←
GAMMA COLOR TEMP
NORMAL 1 DEFAULT2 MID
CINEMA 2 DEFAULT3 LOW
DYNAMIC 3 DEFAULT1 HIGH
BOARD(BLACK) 4 DEFAULT4 Hi-BRIGHT-1
BOARD(GREEN) 4 DEFAULT5 Hi-BRIGHT-2
WHITEBOARD 5 DEFAULT2 MID
DAYTIME 6 DEFAULT6 Hi-BRIGHT-3
When the combination of GAMMA and COLOR TEMP differs from pre-assigned modes above, the display on the menu for the PICTURE MODE is “CUSTOM”. Please refer to the GAMMA and COLOR TEMP (33, 34) items in PICTURE menu. Lines or other noise might appear on the screen when this function is operated, but it is not a malfunction.

(continued on next page)

Item Description
ECO MODEUsing the ◀/► buttons swithes the ECO MODE.See the ECO MODE item in SETUP menu (44).
INSTALLATIONPressing the ► button displays the INSTALLATION dialog.See the INSTALLATION item in SETUP menu (44).
RESETPerforming this item resets all of the EASY MENU items except the FILTER TIME and LANGUAGE.A dialog is displayed for confirmation. Selecting the OK using the ► button performs resetting.
FILTER TIMEThe usage time of the air filter is shown in the menu.Performing this item resets the filter time which counts usage time of the air filter.A dialog is displayed for confirmation. Selecting the OK using the ► button performs resetting.See the FILTER TIME item in OPTION menu (55).
LANGUAGEUsing the ◀/► buttons changes the display language.See the LANGUAGE item in SCREEN menu (47).
ADVANCED MENUPress the ► or ENTER button to use the menu of PICTURE, IMAGE, INPUT, SETUP, AUDIO, SCREEN, OPTION, NETWORK or SECURITY.
EXITPress the ◀ or ENTER button to finish the OSD menu.

PICTURE menu

From the PICTURE menu, items shown in the table below can be performed.

Select an item using the ▲/▼ cursor buttons, and press the ▶ cursor button or ENTER button to execute the item. Then perform it according to the following table.

ADANCED MENU PICTURE IMAGE INPUT SETUP AUDIO SCREEN OPTION NETWORK SECURITY EASY MENU EXIT BRIGHTNESS +0 CONTRAST +0 GAVAMA DEFAULT-1 COLOR TEMP MID COLOR +0 TIRT +0 SHARPNESS 4 MY MEMORY COMPUTER IN 1 1024 x 768 @60Hz

Item Description
BRIGHTNESSUsing the ◀/► buttons adjusts the brightness. Dark ⇔ Light
CONTRASTUsing the ◀/► buttons adjusts the contrast. Weak ⇔ Strong
GAMMAUsing the ▲/▼ buttons switches the gamma mode. 1 DEFAULT ⇔ 1 CUSTOM ⇔ 2 DEFAULT ⇔ 2 CUSTOM ⇔ 3 DEFAULT 6 CUSTOM 3 CUSTOM 6 DEFAULT ⇔ 5 CUSTOM ⇔ 5 DEFAULT ⇔ 4 CUSTOM ⇔ 4 DEFAULTTo adjust CUSTOMSelecting a mode whose name includes CUSTOM and then pressing the ► button or the ENTER button displays a dialog to aid you in adjusting the mode. This function is useful when you want to change the brightness of particular tones. Choose an item using the ◀/► buttons, and adjust the level using the ▲/▼ buttons. You can display a test pattern for checking the effect of your adjustment by pressing the ENTER button. Each time you press the ENTER button, the pattern changes as below. No pattern ⇒ Gray scale of 9 steps → HITACHI CPX10WN - PICTURE menu - 2 ↑Ramp ⇔ Gray scale of 15 stepsThe eight equalizing bars correspond to eight tone levels of the test pattern (Gray scale of 9 steps) except the darkest in the left end. If you want to adjust the 2nd tone from left end on the test pattern, use the equalizing adjustment bar “1”. The darkest tone at the left end of the test pattern cannot be controlled with any of equalizing adjustment bar. • Lines or other noise might appear on the screen when this function is operated, but it is not a malfunction. HITACHI CPX10WN - PICTURE menu - 3

(continued on next page)

Item Description
COLOR TEMPUsing the ▲/▼ buttons switches the color temperature mode.1 HIGH ⇔ 1 CUSTOM ⇔ 2 MID ⇔ 2 CUSTOM6 CUSTOM 3 LOW6 Hi-BRIGHT-3 3 CUSTOM5 CUSTOM ⇔ 5 Hi-BRIGHT-2 ⇔ 4 CUSTOM ⇔ 4 Hi-BRIGHT-1To adjust CUSTOMSelecting a mode whose name includes CUSTOM and then pressing the ▶ button or the ENTER button displays a dialog to aid you in adjusting the OFFSET and GAIN of the selected mode.OFFSET adjustments change the color intensity on the whole tones of the test pattern.GAIN adjustments mainly affect color intensity on the brighter tones of the test pattern.Choose an item using the ◀/► buttons, and adjust the level using the ▲/▼ buttons.You can display a test pattern for checking the effect of your adjustment by pressing the ENTER button.Each time you press the ENTER button, the pattern changes as below.No pattern ⇒ Gray scale of 9 steps [IMAGE]Ramp ⇔ Gray scale of 15 steps• Lines or other noise might appear on the screen when this function is operated, but it is not a malfunction. HITACHI CPX10WN - PICTURE menu - 4
COLORUsing the ◀/► buttons adjusts the strength of whole color.Weak ⇔ Strong• This item can be selected only for a video, s-video and component video signal.• For an HDMITMsignal, this item can also be selected if either (1) or (2) applies.(1) HDMI FORMAT item in the INPUT menu is set to VIDEO.(2) HDMI FORMAT item in the INPUT menu is set to AUTO, and the projector recognizes that it receives video signals.
TINTUsing the ◀/► buttons adjusts the tint.Reddish ⇔ Greenish• This item can be selected only for a video, s-video and component video signal.• For an HDMITMsignal, this item can also be selected if either (1) or (2) applies.(1) HDMI FORMAT item in the INPUT menu is set to VIDEO.(2) HDMI FORMAT item in the INPUT menu is set to AUTO, and the projector recognizes that it receives video signals.
SHARPNESSUsing the ◀/▶ buttons adjusts the sharpness.Weak ⇔ StrongThere may be some noise and/or the screen may flicker for a moment when an adjustment is made. This is not a malfunction.
MY MEMORYThis projector has 4 memories for adjustment data (for all the items of the PICTURE menu).Selecting a function using the ▲/▼ buttons and pressing the ▶ or ENTER button performs each function.HITACHI CPX10WN - PICTURE menu - 5SAVE-1, SAVE-2, SAVE-3, SAVE-4Performing a SAVE function saves the current adjustment data into the memory linked in the number included in the function's name.Remember that the current data being stored of a memory will be lost by saving new data into the memory.LOAD-1, LOAD-2, LOAD-3, LOAD-4Performing a LOAD function loads the data from the memory linked in the number included in the function's name, and adjusts the picture automatically depending on the data.The LOAD functions whose linked memory has no data are skipped.Remember that the current adjusted condition will be lost by loading data. If you want to keep the current adjustment, please save it before performing a LOAD function.There may be some noise and the screen may flicker for a moment when loading data. This is not malfunction.You can perform the LOAD function using MY BUTTON. Please see MY BUTTON item in OPTION menu (56, 57).

IMAGE menu

From the IMAGE menu, items shown in the table below can be performed.

Select an item using the ▲/▼ cursor buttons, and press the ▶ cursor button or ENTER button to execute the item. Then perform it according to the following table.

ADANCED MENU PICTURE IMAGE INPUT SETUP AUDIO SCREEN OPTION NETWORK SECURITY EASY MENU EXIT ASPECT NORMAL OVER SCAN 5 V POSITION 35 H POSITION 294 H PHASE 2 H SIZE 1344 AUTO ADJUST EXECUTE COMPUTER IN 1 1024 x 768 @SOHz

Item Description
ASPECTUsing the ▲/▼ buttons switches the mode for aspect ratio.For a computer signalCPX10WN/CPX11WN: NORMAL ⇔ 4:3 ⇔ 16:9 ⇔ 16:10CPWX12WN: NORMAL ⇔ 4:3 ⇔ 16:9 ⇔ 16:10 ⇔ NATIVEFor an HDMITM signalCPX10WN/CPX11WN: NORMAL ⇔ 4:3 ⇔ 16:9 ⇔ 16:10 ⇔ 14:9CPWX12WN: NORMAL ⇔ 4:3 ⇔ 16:9 ⇔ 16:10 ⇔ 14:9 ⇔ NATIVEFor a video signal, s-video signal or component video signalCPX10WN/CPX11WN: 4:3 ⇔ 16:9 ⇔ 14:9CPWX12WN: 4:3 ⇔ 16:9 ⇔ 14:9 ⇔ NATIVEFor an input signal from the LAN, USB TYPE A or USB TYPE B port, or if there is no signalCPX10WN/CPX11WN: 4:3 (fixed) CPWX12WN: 16:10 (fixed)• The NORMAL mode keeps the original aspect ratio of the signal.
OVER SCANUsing the ◀/► buttons adjusts the over-scan ratio.Small (It magnifies picture) ⇔ Large (It reduces picture)• This item can be selected only for a video, s-video and component video signal.• For an HDMITM signal, this item can also be selected if either (1) or (2) applies.(1) HDMI FORMAT item in the INPUT menu is set to VIDEO.(2) HDMI FORMAT item in the INPUT menu is set to AUTO, and the projector recognizes that it receives video signals.

(continued on next page)

Item Description
V POSITIONUsing the ◀/► buttons adjusts the vertical position. Down ⇔ UpOver-adjusting the vertical position may cause noise to appear on the screen. If this occurs, please reset the vertical position to the default setting. Pressing the RESET button when the V POSITION is selected will reset the V POSITION to the default setting.When this function is performed on a video signal or an s-video signal, the range of this adjustment depends on OVER SCAN (36) setting. It is not possible to adjust when OVER SCAN is set to 10.This function is unavailable for a signal from the LAN, USB TYPE A, USB TYPE B or HDMI port.
H POSITIONUsing the ◀/► buttons adjusts the horizontal position. Right ⇔ LeftOver-adjusting the horizontal position may cause noise to appear on the screen. If this occurs, please reset the horizontal position to the default setting. Pressing the RESET button when the H POSITION is selected will reset the H POSITION to the default setting.When this function is performed on a video signal or an s-video signal, the range of this adjustment depends on OVER SCAN (36) setting. It is not possible to adjust when OVER SCAN is set to 10.This function is unavailable for a signal from the LAN, USB TYPE A, USB TYPE B or HDMI port.

(continued on next page)

Item Description
H PHASEUsing the ◀/► buttons adjusts the horizontal phase to eliminate flicker.Right ⇔ LeftThis item can be selected only for a computer signal or a component video signal. This function is unavailable for a signal from the LAN, USB TYPE A, USB TYPE B or HDMI port.
H SIZEUsing the ◀/► buttons adjusts the horizontal size.Small ⇔ LargeThis item can be selected only for a computer signal. This function is unavailable for a signal from the LAN, USB TYPE A, USB TYPE B or HDMI port.When this adjustment is excessive, the picture may not be displayed correctly. In such a case, please reset the adjustment by pressing the RESET button on the remote control during this operation.Images might appear degraded when this function is operated, but it is not a malfunction.
AUTO ADJUST EXECUTESelecting this item performs the automatic adjustment feature.For a computer signalThe vertical position, the horizontal position and the horizontal phase will be automatically adjusted.Make sure that the application window is set to its maximum size prior to attempting to use this feature. A dark picture may still be incorrectly adjusted. Use a bright picture when adjusting.For a video signal and s-video signalThe video format best suited for the respective input signal will be selected automatically. This function is available only when the AUTO is selected for the VIDEO FORMAT item in the INPUT menu (40). The vertical position and horizontal position will be automatically set to the default.For a component video signalThe vertical position and horizontal position will be automatically set to the default. The horizontal phase will be automatically adjusted.The automatic adjustment operation requires approx. 10 seconds. Also please note that it may not function correctly with some input.When this function is performed for a video signal, a certain extra such as a line may appear outside a picture.When this function is performed for a computer signal, a black frame may be displayed on the edge of the screen, depending on the computer model.The items adjusted by this function may vary when the FINE or DISABLE is selected for the AUTO ADJUST item of the SERVICE item in the OPTION menu (57).

INPUT menu

From the INPUT menu, items shown in the table below can be performed.

Select an item using the ▲/▼ cursor buttons, and press the ▶ cursor button or ENTER button to execute the item. Then perform it according to the following table.

ADANCED MENU PICTURE IMAGE INPUT SETUP AUDIO SCREEN OPTION NETWORK SECURITY EASY MENU EXIT PROGRESSIVE TV VIDEO NR MID COLOR SPACE AUTO VIDEO FORMAT HDMI FORMAT AUTO HDMI RANGE AUTO COMPUTER IN FRAME LOCK RESOLUTION COMPUTER IN 1 1024 x 768 @SOHz

Item Description
PROGRESSIVEUsing the ▲/▼ buttons switches the progress mode.TV ⇔ FILM ⇔ OFFThis function works only for a video signal, s-video signal, component video signal (of 480i@60 or 576i@50 or 1080i@50/60) and an HDMITMsignal (of 480i@60 or 576i@50 or 1080i@50/60).When TV or FILM is selected, the screen image will be sharp. FILM adapts to the 2-3 Pull-Down conversion system. But these may cause a certain defect (for example, jagged line) of the picture for a quick moving object. In such a case, please select OFF, even though the screen image may lose sharpness.
VIDEO NRUsing the ▲/▼ buttons switches the noise reduction mode.HIGH ⇔ MID ⇔ LOWThis function works only for a video signal, s-video signal, component video signal (of 480i@60 or 576i@50 or 1080i@50/60) and an HDMITM signal (of 480i@60 or 576i@50 or 1080i@50/60).
COLOR SPACEUsing the ▲/▼ buttons switches the mode for color space.AUTO ⇔ RGB ⇔ SMPTE240 ⇔ REC709 ⇔ REC601This item can be selected only for a computer signal (except for signals from the LAN, USB TYPE A and USB TYPE B ports) or a component video signal.The AUTO mode automatically selects the optimum mode.The AUTO operation may not work well at some signals. In such a case, it might be good to select a suitable mode except AUTO.

(continued on next page)

Item Description
VIDEO FORMATThe video format for S-VIDEO port and VIDEO port can be set.(1) Use the ▲/▼ buttons to select the input port.(2) Using the ◀/► buttons switches the mode for video format.HITACHI CPX10WN - INPUT menu - 2AUTO ⇔ NTSC ⇔ PAL ⇔ SECAMN-PAL ⇔ M-PAL ⇔ NTSC4.43This item is performed only for a video signal from theVIDEO port or theS-VIDEOport.The AUTO mode automatically selects the optimum mode.The AUTO operation may not work well for some signals. If the picture becomes unstable (e.g. an irregular picture, lack of color), please select the mode according to the input signal.
HDMI FORMATUsing the ▲/▼ cursor buttons switches the video format for an input from theHDMI port.AUTO ⇔ VIDEO ⇔ COMPUTERFeatureAUTO automatically sets the optimum mode.VIDEO sets the suitable mode for DVD signals.COMPUTER sets the suitable mode for computer signals.When the COMPUTER is selected, the functions COLOR (PICTURE menu), TINT (PICTURE menu) and OVER SCAN (IMAGE menu) are unavailable.
HDMI RANGEUsing the ▲/▼ cursor buttons changes the digital range for input from theHDMI port.AUTO ⇔ NORMAL ⇔ ENHANCEDFeatureAUTO automatically sets the optimum mode.NORMAL sets the suitable mode for DVD signals. (16-235)ENHANCEDsets the suitable mode for computer signals. (0-255)If the contrast of the screen image is too strong or too weak, try finding a more suitable mode.

(continued on next page)

Item Description
COMPUTER INThe computer input signal type for COMPUTER IN1 and IN2 ports can be set.(1) Use the ▲/▼ buttons to select the COMPUTER IN port to be set.(2) Use the ◀/► buttons to select the computer input signal type. AUTO ⇔ SYNC ON G OFF HITACHI CPX10WN - INPUT menu - 3Selecting the AUTO mode allows you to input a sync on G signal or component video signal from the port (11, 13).In the AUTO mode, the picture may be distorted with certain input signals. In such a case, remove the signal connector so that no signal is received and select the SYNC ON G OFF, and then reconnect the signal.
FRAME LOCKSet the frame lock function on/off for each port.(1) Use the ▲/▼ buttons to select the input ports.(2) Use the ◀/► buttons to turn the frame lock function on/off .ON ⇔ OFFThis item can be performed only on a signal with a vertical frequency of 49 to 51Hz, 59 to 61 Hz.When ON is selected, moving pictures are displayed more smoothly.

(continued on next page)

Item DescriptionThe resolution for the COMPUTER IN1 and COMPUTER IN2 input signals can be set on this projector.(1) In the INPUT menu select the RESOLUTION using the ▲/▼ buttons and press the ▶ button.The RESOLUTION menu will be displayed.(2) In the RESOLUTION menu select the resolution you wish to display using the ▲/▼ buttons.Selecting AUTO will set a resolution appropriate to the input signal.(3) Pressing the ▶ or ENTER button when selecting a STANDARD resolution will automatically adjust the horizontal and vertical positions, clock phase and horizontal size.The INPUT_INFORMATION dialog will be displayed.(4) To set a custom resolution use the ▲/▼ buttons to select the CUSTOM and the RESOLUTION_CUSTOM box will be displayed.Set the horizontal (HORZ) and vertical (VERT) resolutions using the ▲/▼/◀/▶ buttons.This function may not support all resolutions.(5) Move the cursor to OK on screen and press the ▶ or ENTER button. The message "ARE YOU SURE YOU WISH TO CHANGE RESOLUTION?" appears. To save the setting, press the ▶ button.The horizontal and vertical positions, clock phase and horizontal size will be automatically adjusted.The INPUT_INFORMATION dialog will be displayed.(6) To revert back to the previous resolution without saving changes, move the cursor to CANCEL on screen and press the ◀ or ENTER button.The screen will then return to the RESOLUTION menu displaying the previous resolution.• For some pictures, this function may not work well.
RESOLUTION

SETUP menu

From the SETUP menu, items shown in the table below can be performed.

Select an item using the ▲/▼ cursor buttons, and press the ▶ cursor button or ENTER button to execute the item. Then perform it according to the following table.

ADANCED MENU PICTURE IMAGE INPUT SETUP AUDIO SCREEN OPTION NETWORK SECURITY EASY MENU EXIT AUTO KEYSTONE KEYSTONE AUTO ECO MODE ECO MODE INSTALLATION STANDBY MODE MONITOR OUT EXECUTE +0 OFF NORMAL NORMAL COMPUTER IN 1 1024 x 768 @SOHz

Item Description
AUTO KEYSTONESelecting this item performs the Automatic keystone distortion correction. Projector automatically corrects vertical keystone distortion due to the (forward/backward) setup angle by itself. This function will be executed only once when selected in the menu. When the slant of the projector is changed, execute this function again.The adjustable range of this function will vary among inputs. For some input, this function may not work well.When REAR / CEILING or FRONT / CEILING is selected for the INSTALLATION item in the SETUP menu, this function may not work correctly if the projector screen is slanted or tilted downwards.When the zoom adjustment is set to the TELE (telephoto focus), this function may be excessive. This function should be used when the zoom adjustment is set to the full WIDE (wide-angle focus) whenever possible.When the projector is placed on the level (about ±4°), this function may not work.When the projector is inclined to near ±30 degree or over, this function may not work well.This function will be unavailable when the Transition Detector is on (77).
HITACHI CPX10WN - SETUP menu - 2 KEYSTONEUsing the ◀/► buttons corrects the vertical keystone distortion.Shrink the bottom of the image ⇌ Shrink the top of the imageThe adjustable range of this function will vary among inputs. For some input, this function may not work well.When the zoom adjustment is set to the TELE (telephoto focus), this function may be excessive. This function should be used when the zoom adjustment is set to the full WIDE (wide-angle focus) whenever possible.This function will be unavailable when the Transition Detector is on (77).

(continued on next page)

Item Description
AUTO ECO MODEUsing the ▲/▼ buttons turns on/off the AUTO ECO MODE.ON ⇔ OFFWhen ON is selected, the projector will always be set to Eco mode at start-up regardless of the ECO MODE (below) setting. An OSD message “AUTO ECO MODE” will be displayed for a while when the projector starts with this function activated.
ECO MODEUsing the ◀/► buttons swithes the ECO MODE.ECO ⇔ INTELLIGENT ECO ⇔ NORMALWhen the ECO is selected, acoustic noise and screen brightness are reduced.When INTELLIGENT ECO is selected, the brightness of the lamp changes according to the level of the input signal. The lamp becomes brighter when the input signal level is high and darker when the level is low. If dark images are projected continuously, the brightness of the lamp may increase to maintain its performance.When AUTO ECO MODE (above) is set to ON, the projector will always be set to Eco mode at start-up regardless this setting.
INSTALLATIONPressing the ►button displays the dialog for changing the INSTALLATION setting.HITACHI CPX10WN - SETUP menu - 3Use the ▲/▼ buttons to select the desired setting on the INSTALLATION dialog, and press the ENTER button of the remote control or the INPUT button of the projector to execute. If Transition Detector is ON and the INSTALLATION status is changed, the TRANSITION DETECTOR ON alarm (77) will be displayed when the projector is restarted.

(continued on next page)

Item Description
STANDBY MODEUsing ▲/▼ buttons switches the standby mode setting between NORMAL and SAVING.NORMAL ⇔ SAVINGWhen SAVING is selected, the power consumption in the standby mode is lowered with some functional restriction as below:When SAVING is selected, the RS-232C communication control except to turn the projector on and the network function are disabled while the projector is in the standby mode. If the COMMUNICATION TYPE in the COMMUNICATION menu is set to NETWORK BRIDGE, all of the RS-232C commands are disabled (59).When SAVING is selected, AUDIO OUT STANDBY setting of AUDIO SOURCE (46) is invalid, and no signal is output fromAUDIO OUT port in the standby mode.When SAVING is selected, STANDBY setting of MONITOR OUT is invalid, and no signal is output fromMONITOR OUT port in the standby mode.
MONITOR OUTWhile the image signal from the input port chosen in step (1) is projected, the image signal from the input port selected in step (2) is output toMONITOR OUT port.(1) Choose a picture input port using ▲/▼ buttons.Choose STANDBY to select the picture output in the standby mode.(2) Select one of theCOMPUTER IN ports using ◀/► buttons.Select OFF to disable theMONITOR OUT port for the input port or standby mode chosen in the step (1).You cannot select COMPUTER IN2 for COMPUTER IN1, and vice versa.If you have changed the setting of STANDBY, it applies only to the current standby mode, NORMAL or SAVING, selected under STANDBY MODE, without changing the setting of the other mode. The factory settings are as follows:- COMPUTER IN1 for the NORMAL mode of STANDBY MODE- OFF for the SAVING mode of STANDBY MODE HITACHI CPX10WN - SETUP menu - 4

AUDIO menu

From the AUDIO menu, items shown in the table below can be performed. Select an item using the ▲/▼ cursor buttons, and press the ▶ cursor button or the ENTER button to execute the item. Then perform it according to the following table.

ADVANCED MENU PICTURE IMAGE INPUT SETUP AUDIO SCREEN OPTION NETWORK SECURITY EASY MENU EXIT VOLUME 24 SPEAKER ON AUDIO SOURCE HDMI AUDIO 1 COMPUTER IN 1 1024 x 768 @SOHz

Item Description
VOLUMEUsing the ◀/► buttons adjusts the volume.Low ⇔ High
SPEAKERUsing the ▲/▼ buttons turns on/off the built-in speaker.ON ⇔ OFFWhen OFF is selected, the built-in speaker does not work.
AUDIO SOURCEWhile the image signal from the input port chosen in step (1) is projected, the audio signal from the input port selected in step (2) is output to both theAUDIO OUTport and built-in speaker of this projector. However, the built-in speaker does not work when SPEAKER is set to OFF.(1) Choose a picture input port using the ▲/▼ buttons.Choose AUDIO OUT STANDBY to select the sound output in the standby mode.(2) Select an audio input port or the mute icon using the ◀/► buttons.The icons indicate the following;No.1: AUDIO IN1 port No.2: AUDIO IN2 portNo.3: LAN port No.4: USB TYPE B portNo.5: HDMI port ✕: mutes the soundAudio input from port nos 3 to 5 can only be selected by each of the picture input ports.Even if the projector is in the standby mode, cooling fans may work and make noises when the built-in speaker is in operation.C.C. (Closed Caption) is automatically activated when ✕ is selected and an input signal containing C.C. is received. This function is available only when the signal is NTSC forVIDEOorS-VIDEO, or 480i@60 forCOMPUTER IN1 or COMPUTER IN2, and when AUTO is selected for DISPLAY in the C.C. menu under the SCREEN menu(52).
HDMI AUDIOUsing the ▲/▼ buttons switches the mode for the HDMITMaudio.Check each of the two modes provided and select the suitable one for your HDMITMaudio device.1 ⇔ 2

SCREEN menu

From the SCREEN menu, items shown in the table below can be performed.

Select an item using the ▲/▼ cursor buttons, and press the ▶ cursor button or ENTER button to execute the item. Then perform it according to the following table.

ADVANCED MENU PICTURE IMAGE INPUT SETUP AUDIO SCREEN OPTION NETWORK SECURITY EASY MENU EXIT LANGUAGE ENGLISH MENU POSITION BLANK BLACK START UP ORIGINAL MyScreen EXECUTE MyScreen Lock OFF MESSAGE ON SOURCE NAME TEMPLATE TEST PATTERN C.C. COMPUTER IN 1 1024 x 768 @50Hz

Item Description
LANGUAGEUsing the ▲/▼/◄/► buttons switches the OSD (On Screen Display) language.ENGLISH ⇔ FRANÇAIS ⇔ DEUTSCH ⇔ ESPAÑOL↑ ...... (shown in the LANGUAGE dialog) ...... ↑Press the ENTER or INPUT button to save the language setting.
MENU POSITIONUsing the ▲/▼/◄/► buttons adjusts the menu position.To quit the operation, press the MENU button on the remote control or keep no operation for about 10 seconds.
BLANKUsing the ▲/▼ buttons switches the mode for the blank screen.The blank screen is a screen for the temporarily blanking feature (28). It is displayed by pressing the BLANK button on the remote control.MyScreen ⇔ ORIGINAL ⇔ BLUE ⇔ WHITE ⇔ BLACK↑MyScreen : Screen can be registered by the MyScreen item (48).ORIGINAL : Screen preset as the standard screen.BLUE, WHITE, BLACK : Plain screens in each color.• To avoid remaining as an afterimage, the MyScreen or ORIGINAL screen will change to the plain black screen after several minutes.
START UPUsing the ▲/▼ buttons switches the mode for the start-up screen.The start-up screen is a screen displayed when no signal or an unsuitable signal is detected.MyScreen ⇔ ORIGINAL ⇔ OFF↑MyScreen : Screen can be registered by the MyScreen item (48).ORIGINAL : Screen preset as the standard screen.OFF : Plain black screen.• To avoid remaining as an afterimage, the MyScreen or ORIGINAL screen will change to the BLANK screen (above) after several minutes. If also the BLANK screen is the MyScreen or ORIGINAL, the plain black screen is instead used.• When the ON is selected to the MyScreen PASSWORD item in the SECURITY menu (75), the START UP is fixed to MyScreen.

(continued on next page)

Item Description
MyScreenThis item allows you to capture an image for use as a MyScreen image which can be used as the BLANK screen and START UP screen. Display the image you want to capture before executing the following procedure.Selecting this item displays a dialog titled “MyScreen”. It will ask you if HITACHI CPX10WN - SCREEN menu - 2you start capturing an image from the current screen.Please wait for the target image to be displayed, and press the ENTER or INPUT button when the image is displayed. The image will freeze and the frame for capturing will appear.To stop performing, press the RESET button on the remote control.Using the ▲/▼/◄/► buttons adjusts the frame position.Please move the frame to the position of the image which you want to use. The frame may not be able to be moved for some input signals.To start registration, press the ENTER HITACHI CPX10WN - SCREEN menu - 3or INPUT button on the remote control.To restore the screen and return to the previous dialog, press the RESET button on the remote control.Registration may take several minutes.When the registration is completed, the registered screen and the following message is displayed for several seconds:“MyScreen registration is finished.”If the registration failed, the following message is displayed:“A capturing error has occurred. Please try again.”This function cannot be selected when the ON is selected to the MyScreen Lock item (49).This function cannot be selected when the ON is selected to the MyScreen PASSWORD item in SECURITY menu (75).This function is unavailable for a signal from the LAN, USB TYPE A, USB TYPE B or HDMI port.

(continued on next page)

Item Description
MyScreen LockUsing the ▲/▼ buttons turns on/off the MyScreen lock function.ON ⇔ OFFWhen the ON is selected, the item MyScreen is locked. Use this function for protecting the current MyScreen.• This function cannot be selected when the ON is selected to the MyScreen PASSWORD item in SECURITY menu (75).
MESSAGEUsing the ▲/▼ buttons turns on/off the message function.ON ⇔ OFFWhen the ON is selected, the following message function works.“AUTO IN PROGRESS” while automatically adjusting“NO INPUT IS DETECTED”“SYNC IS OUT OF RANGE”“INVALID SCAN FREQ.”“Searching....” while searching for the input“Detecting....” while an input signal is detected“AUTO ECO MODE” while starting up with AUTO ECO MODEThe indication of the input signal displayed by changingThe indication of the aspect ratio displayed by changingThe indication of the PICTURE MODE displayed by changingThe indication of the MY MEMORY displayed by changingThe indication of “FREEZE” and “II” while freezing the screen by pressing the FREEZE button.The indication of the TEMPLATE displayed by changing.The indication of the ECO MODE displayed by changing.• When the OFF is selected, please remember if the picture is frozen. Do not mistake freezing for a malfunction (28).

(continued on next page)

Item Description
SOURCE NAMEEach input port for this projector can have a name applied to it.(1) Use the ▲/▼ buttons on the SCREEN menu to select SOURCE NAME and press the ▶ or ENTER button.The SOURCE NAME menu will be displayed.(2) Use the ▲/▼ buttons on the SOURCE NAME menu to select the port to be named and press the ▶ button. The SOURCE NAME dialog will be displayed.Right side of the menu is blank until a name is specified.(3) Select an icon you would like to assign to the port in the SOURCE NAME dialog.The name assigned to the port will also be automatically switched according to your icon selection. Press the ENTER or INPUT button to determine your icon selection.(4) Select a number you would like to assign to the port along with the icon. You can select the number either from blank (no number assigned), 1, 2, 3, or 4.Then press the ENTER or INPUT button.(5) If you would like to modify the name assigned to the port, select CUSTOM NAME and press the ENTER or INPUT button.(continued on next page) HITACHI CPX10WN - SCREEN menu - 4HITACHI CPX10WN - SCREEN menu - 5HITACHI CPX10WN - SCREEN menu - 6HITACHI CPX10WN - SCREEN menu - 7

(continued on next page)

Item Description
SOURCE NAME(continued)(6) The current name will be displayed on the first line. Use the ▲/▼/◄/► buttons and the ENTER or INPUT button to select and enter characters. To erase 1 character at one time, press the RESET button or press the ◀ and INPUT button at the same time. Also if you move the cursor to DELETE or ALL CLEAR on screen and press the ENTER or INPUT button, 1 character or all characters will be erased. The name can be a maximum of 16 characters.(7) To change an already inserted character, press the ▲ button to move the cursor to the first line, and use the ◀/► buttons to move the cursor on the character to be changed.After pressing the ENTER or INPUT button, the character is selected. Then, follow the same procedure as described at the item (6) above.(8) To finish entering text, move the cursor to the OK on screen and press the ►, ENTER or INPUT button. To revert to the previous name without saving changes, move the cursor to the CANCEL on screen and press the ◀, ENTER or INPUT button.
TEMPLATEUsing the ▲/▼ cursor buttons switches the mode for the template screen.Press the ► cursor (or the ENTER) button to display the selected template, and press the ◀ cursor button to close the displayed screen.The last selected template is displayed when the MY BUTTON allocated to the TEMPLATE function is pressed (57).TEST PATTERN ⇔ DOT-LINE1 ⇔ DOT-LINE2 ⇔ DOT-LINE3 ↑↓ ↑↓MAP2 ⇔ MAP1 ⇔ CIRCLE2 ⇔ CIRCLE1 ⇔ DOT-LINE4 You can turn a map upside down and scroll it horizontally when MAP1 or MAP2 is selected. To invert or scroll the map, display the guidance by pressing the RESET button on the remote three seconds or more when MAP1 or MAP2 appears.

(continued on next page)

Item Description
C.C.(Closed Caption)The C.C. is the function that displays a transcript or dialog of the audio portion of a video, files or other presentation or other relevant sounds. It is required to have NTSC format video or 480i@60 format component video source supporting C.C. feature to utilize this function.It may not work properly, depending on equipment or signal source.In this case, please turn off the Closed Caption.
DISPLAYSelect Closed Caption DISPLAY setting from following options using ▲/▼ buttons.AUTO ⇔ ON ⇔ OFFAUTO: Closed Caption automatically displays when the volume is muted.ON: Closed Caption is on.OFF: Closed Caption is off.The caption is not displayed when the OSD menu is active.The Closed Caption is the function to display the dialogue, narration, and / or sound effects of a television program or other video sources. The Closed Caption availability is depending upon broadcaster and/or content.
MODESelect Closed Caption MODE setting from following options using ▲/▼ buttons.CAPTIONS ⇔ TEXTCAPTIONS: Display Closed Caption.TEXT: Display Text data, which is for additional information such as news reports or a TV program guide. The information covers the entire screen. Not all of the C.C. program has Text information.
CHANNELSelect Closed Caption CHANNEL from following options using ▲/▼ buttons.1 ⇔ 2 ⇔ 3 ⇔ 41: Channel 1, primary channel / language2: Channel 23: Channel 34: Channel 4The channel data may vary, depending on the content. Some channel might be used for secondary language or empty.

OPTION menu

From the OPTION menu, items shown in the table below can be performed.

Select an item using the ▲/▼ cursor buttons, and press the ▶ cursor button or ENTER button to execute the item, except for the items LAMP TIME and FILTER TIME. Then perform it according to the following table.

ADVANCED MENU PICTURE IMAGE INPUT SETUP AUDIO SCREEN OPTION NETWORK SECURITY EASY MENU EXIT AUTO SEARCH ON AUTO KEYSTONE ON DIRECT POWER ON OFF AUTO POWER OFF On USB TYPE B USB DISPLAY LAMP TIME On FILTER TIME Oh MY BUTTON MY SOURCE COMPUTER IN 2 SERVICE COMPUTER IN 1 1024 x 768 @50Hz

Item Description
AUTO SEARCHUsing the ▲/▼ buttons turns on/off the automatic signal search function.ON ⇔ OFFWhen the ON is selected, detecting no signal automatically cycles through input ports in the following order. The search is started from the current port. Then when an input is found, the projector will stop searching and display the image.→ COMPUTER IN1 ⇒ COMPUTER IN2 ⇒ LAN ⇒ USB TYPE AVIDEO ⇔ S-VIDEO ⇔ HDMI ⇔ USB TYPE B←• It may take several seconds to project the images from the USB TYPE B port.
AUTO KEYSTONEUsing the ▲/▼ buttons turns on/off the automatic keystone function.ON ⇔ OFFON: Automatic keystone distortion correction will be executed whenever changing the slant of the projector.OFF: This function is disabled. Please execute the AUTO KEYSTONE (EXECUTE) in the SETUP menu for automatic keystone distortion correction.When the projector is suspended from the ceiling this feature will not function properly so select the OFF.This function will be unavailable when the Transition Detector is on(77).
DIRECT POWER ONUsing the ▲/▼ buttons turns on/off the DIRECT POWER ON function.ON ⇔ OFFWhen set to the ON, the lamp in projector will be automatically turned on without the usual procedure (19), only when the projector is supplied with the power after the power was cut while the lamp was on.This function does not work as long as the power has been supplied to the projector while the lamp is off.After turning the lamp on by the DIRECT POWER ON function, if neither input nor operation is detected for about 30 minutes, the projector is turned off, even though the AUTO POWER OFF function(54) is disabled.

(continued on next page)

Item Description
AUTO POWER OFFUsing the ▲/▼ buttons adjusts the time to count down to automatically turn the projector off.Long (max. 99 minutes) ⇔ Short (min. 0 minute = DISABLE)HITACHI CPX10WN - OPTION menu - 2 HITACHI CPX10WN - OPTION menu - 3When the time is set to 0, the projector is not turned off automatically.When the time is set to 1 to 99, and when the passed time with no-signal or an unsuitable signal reaches at the set time, the projector lamp will be turned off.If one of the projector's buttons or the remote control buttons is pressed or one of the commands (except get commands) is transmitted to theCONTROLport during the corresponding time, projector will not be turned off.Please refer to the sectionTurning off the power (20).
USB TYPE BUsing the ▲/▼ buttons selects the function of USB TYPE B port.To use this function, you need to connect the USB TYPE B port of the projector and the type A USB port of a computer.MOUSE ⇔ USB DISPLAYMOUSE: The accessory remote control works as the simple mouse and keyboard of the computer.USB DISPLAY: The port works as an input port that receives image signals from the computer (89).It may take several seconds to project the images from the USB TYPE B port.In the following cases, a message to notify you that USB TYPE B port is not available for picture input appears together with the USB TYPE B dialog:- This setting is switched to MOUSE while a picture input from the USB TYPE B port is projected.- The USB TYPE B port is selected as the picture input source while this setting is set to MOUSE. Select USB DISPLAY in the dialog to project the picture input to the USB TYPE B port. In this case, you cannot use the simple mouse and keyboard function. Otherwise select other port for picture input.

(continued on next page)

Item Description
LAMP TIMEThe lamp time is the usage time of the lamp, counted after the last resetting. It is shown in the OPTION menu.Pressing the RESET button on the remote control or the ▶ button of the projector displays a dialog.To reset the lamp time, select the OK using the ▶ button.CANCEL ⇒ OKPlease reset the lamp time only when you have replaced the lamp, for a suitable indication about the lamp.For the lamp replacement, see the section Replacing the lamp (93).
FILTER TIMEThe filter time is the usage time of the air filter, counted after the last resetting. It is shown in the OPTION menu.Pressing the RESET button on the remote control or the ▶ button of the projector displays a dialog.To reset the filter time, select the OK using the ▶ button.CANCEL ⇒ OKPlease reset the filter time only when you have cleaned or replaced the air filter, for a suitable indication about the air filter.For the air filter cleaning, see the section Cleaning and replacing the air filter (95).

(continued on next page)

Item Description
MY BUTTONThis item assigns one of the following functions to the ECO button on the control panel (5) and MY BUTTON 1/2 on the remote control (6).(1) Choose a button to assign a function from ECO, MY BUTTON-1 and MY BUTTON-2. Use the ▲/▼ buttons to select the desired function on the menu and press the ▶ button.(2) Then using the ▲/▼/◄/► buttons sets one of the following functions to the chosen button. Press the ENTER or INPUT button to save the setting.COMPUTER IN1: Selects the input from COMPUTER IN1 port.COMPUTER IN2: Selects the input from COMPUTER IN2 port.LAN: Selects input from LAN port.USB TYPE A: Selects input from USB TYPE A port.USB TYPE B: Selects input from USB TYPE B port.HDMI: Selects input from HDMI port.S-VIDEO: Selects the input from S-VIDEO port.VIDEO: Selects the input from VIDEO port.SLIDESHOW: Selects the input from USB TYPE A, and starts a Slideshow.MY IMAGE: Displays the MY IMAGE menu (71).MESSENGER:Turns the messenger text displayed on the screen on/off (Messenger Function in the Network Guide).When there is no transferred text data to display, the message "NO MESSENGER DATA" appears.INFORMATION: Displays SYSTEM_INFORMATION, INPUT_INFORMATION (62), WIRELESS INFORMATION (67), WIRED INFORMATION (69) or nothing.AUTO KEYSTONE : Performs automatic keystone distortion correction (43).MY MEMORY: Loads one of adjustment data stored (35).When more than one data are saved, the adjustment changes every time the MY BUTTON is pressed.When no data is saved in memory, the dialog "No saved data" appears.When the current adjustment is not saved to memory, the dialog as shown in the right appears.If you want to keep the current adjustment, please press the ► button to exit. Otherwise loading a data will overwrite the current adjusted condition.(continued on next page)

(continued on next page)

Item Description
MY BUTTON(continued)PICTURE MODE: Changes the PICTURE MODE (31).FILTER RESET: Displays the filter time reset confirmation dialogue (55).TEMPLATE: Makes the template pattern selected to the TEMPLATE item (51) appear or disappear.AV MUTE: Turns the picture and audio on/off.RESOLUTION: Turns on/off the RESOLUTION dialog (42).ECO MODE: Changes the ECO MODE (44).BLANK: Turns on/off the blank function. (ECO button only)FREEZE: Turns on/off the freeze function. (ECO button only)VOLUME: Turns on/off the volume dialog. (ECO button only)AUTO:Performs the automatic adjustment function.(ECO button only)
MY SOURCEUsing ▲/▼ buttons selects the picture input port to be selected with pressing the MY SOURCE/DOC.CAMERA button on the remote control.You can use this function not only for document cameras but also computers and other equipment.VIDEO ⇔ COMPUTER IN1 ⇔ COMPUTER IN2 ⇔ LANS-VIDEO ⇔ HDMI ⇔ USB TYPE B ⇔ USB TYPE A
SERVICESelecting this item displays the SERVICE menu.Select an item using the ▲/▼ buttons, and press the ▶ button or the ENTER button on the remote control to execute the item.HITACHI CPX10WN - OPTION menu - 4
ALTITUDEUsing the ▲/▼ buttons switches the rotation speed of the cooling fans. The HIGH is the mode for use at highlands etc. If the projector is used at an altitude of about 1600 m (5250 feet) or higher, select HIGH. Otherwise, select NORMAL. Note that the projector is noisier when the HIGH is selected.HIGH ⇔ NORMAL
AUTO ADJUSTUsing the ▲/▼ buttons to select one of the mode. When the DISABLE is selected, the automatic adjustment feature is disabled.FINE ⇔ FAST ⇔ DISABLEFINE: Finer tuning including H.SIZE adjustment.FAST: Faster tuning, setting H.SIZE to prearranged data for the input signal.Depending on conditions, such as input image, signal cable to the projector, environment around the projector, etc., the automatic adjustment may not work correctly. In such a case, please choose DISABLE to disable the automatic adjustment, and make adjustment manually.

(continued on next page)

Item Description
SERVICE(continued)GHOSTAdjust the settings using the ▲/▼ buttons to eliminate ghosting.
FILTER MESSAGEUse the ▲/▼ button to set the timer for notifying by the message when to replace the filter unit100h ⇔ 200h ⇔ 500h ⇔ 1000h ⇔ 2000h ⇔ 3000h ⇔ 4000h ⇔ 5000h ⇔ OFFAfter choosing an item except OFF, the message “REMINDER *** HRS PASSED ....” will appear after the timer reaches the interval time set by this feature (99).When the OFF is chosen, the message will not appear. Utilize this feature to keep the air filter clean, setting the suitable time according to your environment of this projector.Please take care of the filter unit periodically, even if there is no message. If the air filter becomes to be blocked by dust or other matter, the internal temperature will rise, which could cause malfunction, or reduce the lifetime of the projector.Please be careful with the operating environment of the projector and the condition of the filter unit.
KEY LOCK(1) Use the ▲/▼ buttons to choose the operations control.CONTROL PANEL ⇔ REMOTE CONTROL(2) Use the ◀/► buttons to select ON or OFF.ON ⇔ OFFHITACHI CPX10WN - OPTION menu - 5Selecting ON in Step 2 locks the buttons except STANDBY/ON on the operations control selected in Step 1. Selecting OFF releases the locked buttons on the operations control selected in Step 1.Please use this function to prevent tampering or accidental operation.

(continued on next page)

Item Description
HITACHI CPX10WN - OPTION menu - 6COMMUNICATIONSelecting this item displays COMMUNICATION menu.In this menu, you can configure the serial communication settings of the projector using theCONTROL port.HITACHI CPX10WN - OPTION menu - 7Select an item using the cursor buttons ▲/▼. Then pressing the ► button opens the submenu for the setting item you selected. Or, pressing the ◀ button instead of the ► button makes the menu back to the previous one without changing the setup. Each submenu can be operated as described above.When COMMUNICATION TYPE (below) is set to OFF, the other items in COMMUNICATION menu are invalid.For the function of serial communication, refer to theNetwork Guide.
COMMUNICATION TYPESelect the communication type for transmission via theCONTROL port.HITACHI CPX10WN - OPTION menu - 8NETWORK BRIDGE: Select this type, if it is required to control an external device as a network terminal, via this projector from the computer. Select WIRELESS or WIRED as your network connection mode.TheCONTROL port doesn't accept RS-232C commands (Network Bridge Function in the Network Guide)OFF: Select this mode to receive RS-232C commands using theCONTROL port.OFF is selected as the default setting.When you select the NETWORK BRIDGE, check the item, TRANSMISSION METHOD (60).
  • Select an item using the cursor buttons ▲/▼. Then pressing the ▶ button opens the submenu for the setting item you selected. Or, pressing the ◀ button instead of the ▶ button makes the menu back to the previous one without changing the setup. Each submenu can be operated as described above.
  • When COMMUNICATION TYPE (below) is set to OFF, the other items in COMMUNICATION menu are invalid.
  • For the function of serial communication, refer to the Network Guide.

COMMUNICATION TYPE

• OFF is selected as the default setting.
- When you select the NETWORK BRIDGE, check the item, TRANSMISSION METHOD (60).

(continued on next page)

Item Description
SERVICE(continued)COMMUNICATION(continued)SERIAL SETTINGSSelect the serial communication condition for theCONTROL port.BAUD RATE4800bps ⇔ 9600bps ⇔ 19200bps ⇔ 38400bps↑↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓↓ ↓The BAUD RATE is fixed to 19200bps and PARITY is fixed NONE when the COMMUNICATION TYPE is set to OFF (59).
TRANSMISSION METHODSelect the transmission method for communication by the NETWORK BRIDGE from theCONTROL port.HALF-DUPLEX ⇔ FULL-DUPLEXHALF-DUPLEX: This method lets the projector make two way communication, but only one direction, either transmitting or receiving data, is allowed at a time.FULL-DUPLEX: This method lets the projector make two way communication, transmitting and receiving data at the same time.·HALF-DUPLEX is selected as the default setting.·If you select HALF-DUPLEX, check the setting of the item RESPONSE LIMIT TIME (61).

(continued on next page)

Item Description
SERVICE(continued)COMMUNICATION(continued)RESPONSE LIMIT TIMESelect the time period to wait for receiving response data from other device communicating by the NETWORK BRIDGE and the HALF-DUPLEX through theCONTROLport.OFF ⇔ 1s ⇔ 2s ⇔ 3sOFF: Select this mode if it is not required to check the responses from the device that the projector sends data to. In this mode, the projector can send out data from the computer continuously.1s /2s /3s: Select the time period to keep the projector waiting for response from the device that the projector sends data to. While waiting the response, the projector does not send out any data from theCONTROLport.This menu is available only when the NETWORK BRIDGE is selected for the COMMUNICATION TYPE and the HALF-DUPLEX is selected for the TRANSMISSION METHOD (59, 60).OFF is selected as the default setting.

(continued on next page)

Item Description
SERVICE(continued)INFORMATIONSelecting this item displays a dialog titled “INPUT_INFORMATION”. It shows the information about the current input.HITACHI CPX10WN - COMMUNICATION TYPE - 1 HITACHI CPX10WN - COMMUNICATION TYPE - 2 HITACHI CPX10WN - COMMUNICATION TYPE - 3The “FRAME LOCK” message on the dialog means the frame lock function is working.This item can't be selected for no signal and sync out.When the MY TEXT DISPLAY is set to ON, the MY TEXT is displayed together with the input information in the INPUT_INFORMATION box (79).
FACTORY RESETSelecting OK using the ▶ button performs this function. By this function, all the items in all of menus will collectively return to the initial setting. Note that the items LAMP TIME, FILTER TIME, LANGUAGE, FILTER MESSAGE, NETWORK and SECURITY settings are not reset.CANCEL ⇒ OKBe sure to set ALTITUDE after resetting all the settings (57).

NETWORK menu

Remember that incorrect network settings on this projector may cause trouble on the network. Be sure to consult with your network administrator before connecting to an existing access point on your network. Select "NETWORK" from the main menu to access the following functions.

Select an item using the ▲/▼ cursor buttons on the projector or remote control, and press the ▶ cursor button on the projector or remote control, or ENTER button on the remote control to execute the item. Then perform it according to the following table. See the Network Guide for details of NETWORK operation.

ADVANCED MENU PICTURE IMAGE INPUT SETUP AUDIO SCREEN OPTION NETWORK SECURITY EASY MENU EXIT WIRELESS SETUP WIRELESS INFORMATION WIRED SETUP WIRED INFORMATION PROJECTOR NAME NO NAME AMX D.D. OFF PRESENTATION SERVICE COMPUTER IN 1 1024 x 768 @60Hz

NOTE • To use the wireless network function of this projector, the designated USB wireless adapter that is sold as an option is required. Do not use any extension cable or device when connecting the adapter to the projector.

  • The projector does not allow both wireless and wired LAN to be connected to the same network.
  • Do not set the same network address for both wireless and wired LAN.
  • If you are not utilizing SNTP (Date/Time Settings in the Network Guide), then you must set the DATE AND TIME during the initial installation.
  • The network communication control is disabled while the projector is in standby mode if the STANDBY MODE item of SETUP menu is set to SAVING. Please connect the network communication to the projector after setting the STANDBY MODE to NORMAL (45).
Item Description
WIRELESS SETUPSelecting this item displays the WIRELESS SETUP menu for the wireless LAN.Use the ▲/▼ buttons to select an item, and the ▶ or ENTER button on the remote control to perform the item.
MODEUse the ▲/▼ buttons to select the mode of the network communication system. Select according to the settings of your computer.AD HOC ⇔ INFRASTRUCTURETo save the setting, press the ▶ button.When ADHOC is selected, IEEE802.11 n cannot be used.If ADHOC is set to MODE while one of WPA-PSK or WPA2-PSK is selected in ENCRYPTION, the ENCRYPTION (65) setting switches to OFF automatically.
WIRELESS SETUP (continued)DHCP (Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol)Use the ▲/▼ buttons to turn DHCP on/off.ON ⇔ OFFSelect OFF when the network does not have DHCP enabled. To save the setting, press the ▶ button.When the “DHCP” setting changes to “ON”, it takes a little time to obtain IP address from DHCP server.Auto IP function will be assigned an IP address if the projector could not obtain an IP address from server even if DHCP is “ON”
IP ADDRESSUse the ▲/▼/◄/► buttons to enter the IP ADDRESS.This function can only be used when DHCP is set to OFF.The IP ADDRESS is the number that identifies this projector on the network. You cannot have two devices with the same IP ADDRESS on the same network.The IP ADDRESS “0.0.0.0” is prohibited.
SUBNET MASKUse the ▲/▼/◄/► buttons to enter the same SUBNET MASK used by your computer.This function can only be used when DHCP is set to OFF.The SUBNET MASK “0.0.0.0” is prohibited.
DEFAULT GATEWAYUse the ▲/▼/◄/► buttons to enter the DEFAULT GATEWAY (a node on a computer network that serves as an access point to another network) address.This function can only be used when DHCP is set to OFF.
DNS SERVERUse the ▲/▼/◄/► buttons to input the DNS server address.The DNS server is a system to control domain names and IP addresses on the Network.
TIME DIFFERENCEUse the ▲/▼ buttons to enter the TIME DIFFERENCE.Set the same TIME DIFFERENCE as the one set on your computer. If unsure, consult your IT manager.Use the ► button to return to the menu after setting the TIME DIFFERENCE.When this item is set, the same item in the WIRED SETUP menu is overwritten with the same setting (69).

(continued on next page)

Item Description
WIRELESS SETUP (continued)DATE AND TIMEUse the ▲/▼/◄/► buttons to enter the Year (last two digits), Month, Date, Hour and Minute.When this item is set, the same item in the WIRED SETUP menu is overwritten with the same setting (69).The projector will override this setting and retrieve DATE AND TIME information from the Time server when SNTP is enabled. (Date/Time Settings in the Network Guide)This setting will be reset if the projector is turned off while STANDBY MODE in the SETUP menu is set to SAVING (45), or when the AC power is turned off.
CHUse the ▲/▼ buttons to select the channel of the wireless LAN to be used while MODE (63) is set to ADHOC. Select according to the settings of your computer.The channels 1 to 11 are available. To save the setting, press the ► button.The available channels would be various depending on a country. In addition, wireless network card might be required due to the standard.This item can only be selected when MODE is set to ADHOC. When MODE is set to INFRASTRUCTURE, the channel is automatically selected.
ENCRYPTIONUse the ▲/▼ buttons to select the encryption method to be used.WPA2-PSK(AES) ⇔ WPA2-PSK(TKIP)OFF WPA-PSK(AES)WEP 64bit ⇔ WEP 128bit ⇔ WPA-PSK(TKIP)To save the setting, press the ► button.When MODE (63) is set to ADHOC, either WPA-PSK and WPA2-PSK cannot be selected.If IEEE802.11 n is used while MODE is set to INFRASTRUCTURE, TKIP and WEP are disabled.If OFF or AES is not selected, communication will switch automatically to IEEE802.11 b/g.

(continued on next page)

Item Description
WIRELESS SETUP (continued)SSIDUse the ▲/▼buttons to select the SSID to display the SSID menu.#1 DEFAULT ⇔ #2 DEFAULT ⇔ #3 DEFAULT ↩→ #5 CUSTOM ⇔ #4 DEFAULT ←→Select one of the DEFAULT (#1~#4) and press ▶or ENTER button.To adjust CUSTOMPress the ▶ or ENTER button when the # 5 CUSTOM is selected. The SSID #5 CUSTOM menu will be appeared.(1) The current SSID will be displayed on the first line. If not yet written, the line will be blank. Use the ▲/▼/◄/► buttons and the ENTER or INPUT button to select and enter characters. To erase 1 character at one time, press the RESET button or press the ◀ and INPUT button at the same time. Also if you move the cursor to DELETE or ALL CLEAR on screen and press the ENTER or INPUT button, 1 character or all characters will be erased. The SSID can be input up to 32 characters.(2) To change an already inserted character, press the ▲/▼ button to move the cursor to one of the first 2 lines, and use the ◀/► buttons to move the cursor on the character to be changed. After pressing the ENTER or INPUT button, the character is selected. Then, follow the same procedure as described at the item (1) above.(3) To finish entering text, move the cursor to the OK on screen and press the ►, ENTER or INPUT button. To revert to the previous name without saving changes, move the cursor to the CANCEL on screen and press the ◀, ENTER or INPUT button.

(continued on next page)

Item Description
WIRELESS INFORMATION"Selecting this item displays the WIRELESS_INFORMATION dialog for viewing the wireless LAN settings." Use the ▲/▼ buttons to switch the page.The first page shows the wireless LAN settings. The second and subsequent pages display the signal information of wireless LAN connection devices.HITACHI CPX10WN - NETWORK menu - 2 HITACHI CPX10WN - NETWORK menu - 3For details of PASSCODE, refer to the manual for "LiveViewer".Nothing (blank) is shown in the PROJECTOR NAME (70) and SSID (66) field until you setup those items. Only the first 16 characters of the PROJECTOR NAME.IP ADDRESS, SUBNET MASK and DEFAULT GATEWAY indicate "0.0.0.0" in the following condition.(1) The USB wireless adapter is not inserted into the projector.(2) DHCP is ON and the projector does not get address from DHCP server.Nothing (blank) is shown in the CH and SPEED fields if the USB wireless adapter is not inserted.The actual performance and setting will be shown in the CH field, instead of the setting value in the WIRELESS SETUP menu.An icon is displayed to the left of the SSID of the device connected to the projector.

(continued on next page)

Item Description
WIRED SETUPSelecting this item displays the WIRED SETUP menu for the wired LAN.Use the ▲/▼ buttons to select an item, and the ▶ or ENTER button on the remote control to perform the item. HITACHI CPX10WN - NETWORK menu - 4
DHCP (Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol)Use the ▲/▼ buttons to turn DHCP on/off.ON ⇔ OFFSelect OFF when the network does not have DHCP enabled. To save the setting, press the ▶ button.When the “DHCP” setting changes to “ON”, it takes a little time to obtain IP address from DHCP server.Auto IP function will be assigned an IP address if the projector could not obtain an IP address from server even if DHCP is “ON”.
IP ADDRESSUse the ▲/▼/◄/► buttons to enter the IP ADDRESS.This function can only be used when DHCP is set to OFF.The IP ADDRESS is the number that identifies this projector on the network. You cannot have two devices with the same IP ADDRESS on the same network.The IP ADDRESS “0.0.0.0” is prohibited.
SUBNET MASKUse the ▲/▼/◄/► buttons to enter the same SUBNET MASK used by your computer.This function can only be used when DHCP is set to OFF.The SUBNET MASK “0.0.0.0” is prohibited.
DEFAULT GATEWAYUse the ▲/▼/◄/► buttons to enter the DEFAULT GATEWAY (a node on a computer network that serves as an access point to another network) address.This function can only be used when DHCP is set to OFF.
DNS SERVERUse the ▲/▼/◄/► buttons to input the DNS server address.The DNS server is a system to control domain names and IP addresses on the Network.

(continued on next page)

Item Description
WIRED SETUP (continued)TIME DIFFERENCEUse the ▲/▼ buttons to enter the TIME DIFFERENCE.Set the same TIME DIFFERENCE as the one set on your computer. If unsure, consult your IT manager.Use the ▶ button to return to the menu after setting the TIME DIFFERENCE.When this item is set, the same item in the WIRELESS SETUP menu is overwritten with the same setting (64).
DATE AND TIMEUse the ▲/▼/◄/► buttons to enter the Year (last two digits), Month, Date, Hour and Minute.When this item is set, the same item in the WIRELESS SETUP menu is overwritten with the same setting (65).The projector will override this setting and retrieve DATE AND TIME information from the Time server when SNTP is enabled. (Date/Time Settings in the Network Guide)This setting will be reset if the projector is turned off while STANDBY MODE in the SETUP menu is set to SAVING (45), or when the AC power is turned off.
WIRED INFORMATIONSelecting this item displays the WIRED INFORMATION dialog for viewing the wired LAN settings.HITACHI CPX10WN - NETWORK menu - 5For details of PASSCODE, refer to the manual for “LiveViewer”.Only the first 16 characters of the PROJECTOR NAME are displayed.IP ADDRESS, SUBNET MASK and DEFAULT GATEWAY indicate “0.0.0.0” when DHCP is ON and the projector has not gotten address from DHCP server.

(continued on next page)

Item Description
PROJECTOR NAME(1) Use the ▲/▼ buttons on the NETWORK menu to select the PROJECTOR NAME and press the ▶ button. The PROJECTOR NAME dialog will be displayed.(2) The current PROJECTOR NAME will be displayed on the first 3 lines. Particular projector name is pre-assigned by default.Use the ▲/▼/◄/► buttons and the ENTER or INPUT button to select and enter characters.To erase 1 character at one time, press the RESET button or press the ◀ and INPUT button at the same time. Also if you move the cursor to DELETE or ALL CLEAR on screen and push the ENTER or INPUT button, 1 character or all characters will be erased.The PROJECTOR NAME can be input up to 64 characters.(3) To change an already inserted character, press the ▲/▼ button to move the cursor to one of the first 3 lines, and use the ◀/► buttons to move the cursor on the character to be changed. After pressing the ENTER or INPUT button, the character is selected.Then, follow the same procedure as described at the item (2) above.(4) To finish entering text, move the cursor to the OK on screen and press the ▶, ENTER or INPUT button. To revert to the previous PROJECTOR NAME without saving changes, move the cursor to the CANCEL on screen and press the ◀, ENTER or INPUT button.HITACHI CPX10WN - NETWORK menu - 6
HITACHI CPX10WN - NETWORK menu - 7
HITACHI CPX10WN - NETWORK menu - 8

(continued on next page)

Item Description
MY IMAGESelecting this item displays the MY IMAGE menu.Use the application to transfer the image data. It can be downloaded from the Hitachi web site.Use the ▲/▼ buttons to select an item which is a still image by the MY IMAGE (My Image Function in the Network Guide) and the ▶ or ENTER button to display the image.The item without image stored cannot be selected.The image names are each displayed in 16 characters or less.To switch the image displayedUse the ▲/▼ buttons.To return to the menuPress the ◀ button on the remote control.To erase the image displayed and its source file in the projector.(1) Press the RESET button on the remote control while displaying an image to display the MY IMAGE DELETE menu.(2) Press the ▶ button to perform to erase.To stop erasing, press the ◀ button.
AMX D.D.(AMX Device Discovery)Use the ▲/▼ buttons to turn the AMX Device Discovery on/off.ON ⇔ OFFWhen ON is selected, the projector can be detected by controllers of AMX connected to the same network. For the details of AMX Device Discovery, visit the AMX web site.URL: http://www.amx.com/ (as of June 2011)

(continued on next page)

Item Description
PRESENTATIONSelecting this item displays the PRESENTATION menu.Use ▲/▼ buttons to select one of the following items, then press ▶or ENTER button to use the function.· To use Network Presentation, an exclusive application, "LiveViewer" is required. It can be installed from the bundled application CD.You can also download the latest version and relevant information from the Hitachi website (http://www.hitachi-america.us/digitalmedia or http://www.hitachidigitalmedia.com).For details of Network Presentation and instructions to install the "LiveViewer", refer to the manual for "LiveViewer".
QUIT PRESENTER MODEIf you set a computer to the Presenter mode while its image is projected, the projector is occupied by the computer and access from any other computer is blocked.Use this function to quit the Presenter mode and allow other computers to access the projector.Select this item to display a dialog.Press ▶ button to choose OK in the dialog.The Presenter mode is cancelled and a message is displayed indicating the result.· To make Presenter mode setting, use "LiveViewer". For details, refer to the manual for "LiveViewer".
MULTI PC MODEIf you set one or more computers to the Multi PC mode on "LiveViewer" and send their images to the projector, you can select the display mode on the projector from two options below.- Single PC mode: displays the image of the selected computer on full screen.- Multi PC mode: displays the images sent from up to four computers on screen that is divided into quarter sections.Select this item to display a dialog.Use the dialog to change the display mode as explained below.· To change from Multi PC mode to Single PC mode, select one of computers in the dialog using the ▲/▼/◄/► buttons and press the ENTER or INPUT button.Press the ► button to choose OK, and then press ENTER or INPUT again. The image for the selected computer is displayed on full screen.(continued on next page)

(continued on next page)

Item Description
PRESENTATION (continued)MULTI PC MODE (continued)• To change from Single PC mode to Multi PC mode, press ▶ button to choose OK in the dialog and press the ENTER or INPUT button. The display mode is changed. • For details on how to switch the display mode to Multi PC mode on your computer, refer to the manual for “LiveViwer”. • The Presenter mode setting of the selected computer becomes valid when the display mode is changed to Single PC mode. Also, the Presenter mode setting becomes invalid when the display mode is changed to Multi PC mode, regardless the setting on the computers. For details, refer to the manual for “LiveViewer”.HITACHI CPX10WN - NETWORK menu - 9
HITACHI CPX10WN - NETWORK menu - 10
DISPLAY USER NAMESelecting this item displays the user name. This function helps you identify from which computer the current image is sent. • You can set user names for each computer on “LiveViwer”. For details, refer to the manual for “LiveViwer”.
SERVICEExecuting this item restarts and initializes the network functions. Choose the NETWORK RESTART EXECUTE using the button ▶. HITACHI CPX10WN - NETWORK menu - 11 Then use the button ▶ to execute. HITACHI CPX10WN - NETWORK menu - 12 Network will be once cut off when choose restart. If DHCP is selected on, IP address may be changed. After selecting NETWORK RESTART EXECUTE, NETWORK menu may not be controlled approx. 30 seconds.

SECURITY menu

This projector is equipped with security functions. From the SECURITY menu, items shown in the table below can be performed.

To use SECURITY menu: User registration is required before using the security functions.

Enter to the SECURITY menu

  1. Press the ▶ button. The ENTER PASSWORD box will be displayed.
  2. Use the ▲/▼/◄/► buttons to enter the registered password.

The factory default password is as follows.

CPX10WN, CPX11WN: 3692

CPWX12WN: 2092

This password can be changed (below). Move the cursor to the right side of the ENTER PASSWORD box and press

the ▶ button to display the SECURITY menu.

  • It is strongly recommended the factory default password to be changed as soon as possible.
  • If an incorrect password is input, the ENTER PASSWORD box will be displayed again. If incorrect password is input 3 times, the projector will turn off. Afterwards the projector will turn off every time an incorrect password is input.

  • Items shown in the table below can be performed.

If you have forgotten your password

(1) While the ENTER PASSWORD box is displayed, press and hold the RESET button on the remote control for about 3 seconds or press and hold the INPUT button for 3 seconds while pressing the ▶ button on the projector.
(2) The 10 digit Inquiring Code will be displayed. Contact your dealer with the 10 digit Inquiring Code. Your password will be sent after your user registration information is confirmed.

- If there is no key input for about 55 seconds while the Inquiring Code is displayed, the menu will close. If necessary, repeat the process from (1).

ADVANCED MENU PICTURE IMAGE INPUT SETUP AUDIO SCREEN OPTION NETWORK SECURITY EASY MENU EXIT ENTER PASSWORD COMPUTER IN 1024 x 768 @60Hz

HITACHI CPX10WN - If you have forgotten your password - 2

SECURITY SECURITY PASSWORD CHANGE MyScreen PASSWORD OFF PIN LOCK OFF TRANSITION DETECTOR OFF MY TEXT PASSWORD OFF MY TEXT DISPLAY OFF MY TEXT WRITING RETURN

HITACHI CPX10WN - If you have forgotten your password - 4

HITACHI CPX10WN - If you have forgotten your password - 5

Item Description
SECURITY PASSWORD CHANGE(1) Use the ▲/▼ buttons on the SECURITY menu to select SECURITY PASSWORD CHANGE and press the ▶ button to display the ENTER NEW PASSWORD box. HITACHI CPX10WN - If you have forgotten your password - 6
(2) Use the ▲/▼/◄/► buttons to enter the new password. (3) Move the cursor to the right side of the ENTER NEW PASSWORD box and press the ► button to display the NEW PASSWORD AGAIN box, enter the same password again. HITACHI CPX10WN - If you have forgotten your password - 7
(4) Move the cursor to the right side of the NEW PASSWORD AGAIN box and press the ► button and the NOTE NEW PASSWORD box will be displayed for about 30 seconds, please make note of the password during this time. Pressing the ENTER button on the remote control or ► button on the projector will close the NOTE NEW PASSWORD box. · Please do not forget your password.

(continued on next page)

Item Description
MyScreen PASSWORDThe MyScreen PASSWORD function can be used to prohibit access to the MyScreen function and prevent the currently registered MyScreen image from being overwritten.1 Turning on the MyScreen PASSWORD1-1 Use the ▲/▼ buttons on the SECURITY menu to select MyScreen PASSWORD and press the ▶ button to display the MyScreen PASSWORD on/off menu.1-2 Use the ▲/▼ buttons on the MyScreen PASSWORD on/off menu to select ON.The ENTER NEW PASSWORD box (small) will be displayed.1-3 Use the ▲/▼/◄/► buttons to enter the password. Move the cursor to the right side of the ENTER NEW PASSWORD box (small) and press the ► button to display the NEW PASSWORD AGAIN box, enter the same PASSWORD again.1-4 Move the cursor to the right side of the NEW PASSWORD AGAIN box and press the ► button to display the NOTE NEW PASSWORD box for about 30 seconds, please make note of the password during this time.Pressing the ENTER button on the remote control or ► button on the projector will return to MyScreen PASSWORD on/off menu.When a password is set for MyScreen:· The MyScreen registration function (and menu) will be unavailable.· The MyScreen Lock menu will be unavailable.· The START UP setting will be locked on MyScreen (and the menu will be unavailable).Turning the MyScreen PASSWORD off will allow normal operation of these functions.· Please do not forget your MyScreen PASSWORD.2 Turning off the MyScreen PASSWORD2-1 Follow the procedure in 1-1 to display the MyScreen PASSWORD on/off menu.2-2 Select OFF to display the ENTER PASSWORD box (large). Enter the registered password and the screen will return to the MyScreen PASSWORD on/off menu.If an incorrect PASSWORD is input, the menu will close. If necessary, repeat the process from 2-1.3 If you have forgotten your password3-1 Follow the procedure in 1-1 to display the MyScreen PASSWORD on/off menu.3-2 Select OFF to display the ENTER PASSWORD box (large). The 10 digit Inquiring Code will be displayed inside the box.3-3 Contact your dealer with the 10 digit Inquiring Code. Your password will be sent after your user registration information is confirmed.

MyScreen PASSWORD

(continued on next page)

Item Description
PIN LOCKPIN LOCK is a function which prevents the projector from being used unless a registered Code is input.1 Turning on the PIN LOCK1-1 Use the ▲/▼ buttons on the SECURITY menu to select PIN LOCK and press the ▶ button or the ENTER button to display the PIN LOCK on/off menu.1-2 Use the ▲/▼ buttons on the PIN LOCK on/off menu to select ON and the Enter PIN Code box will be displayed.1-3 Input a 4 part PIN code using the ▲/▼/◄/►, COMPUTER or INPUT button.The PIN Code again box will appear. Reenter the same PIN code. This will complete the PIN code registration.If there is no key input for about 55 seconds while the Enter PIN Code box or the PIN Code again box is displayed, the menu will close. If necessary, repeat the process from 1-1.Afterwards, anytime the projector is restarted after AC power is turned off the Enter PIN Code box will be displayed. Enter the registered PIN code. The projector can be used after entering the registered PIN code. If an incorrect PIN code is input, the Enter PIN code box will be displayed again. If an incorrect PIN code is input 3 times, the projector will turn off. Afterwards the projector will turn off every time an incorrect PIN code is input. The projector will also turn off if there is no key input for about 5 minutes while the Enter PIN code box is displayed.This function will activate only when the projector is started after AC power is turned off.Please do not forget your PIN code.Turning off the PIN LOCK2-1 Follow the procedure in 1-1 to display the PIN LOCK on/off menu.2-2 Use the ▲/▼ buttons to select OFF and the Enter PIN Code box will be displayed.Enter the registered PIN code to turn the PIN LOCK function off.If an incorrect PIN code is input 3 times, the projector will turn off.3 If you have forgotten your PIN code3-1 While the Enter PIN code box is displayed, press and hold the RESET button for three seconds or press and hold the INPUT button for 3 seconds while pressing the ▶ button on the projector.The 10 digit Inquiring Code will be displayed.If there is no key input for about 5 minutes while the Inquiring Code is displayed, the projector will turn off.3-2 Contact your dealer with the 10 digit Inquiring Code. Your PIN code will be sent after your user registration information is confirmed.

(continued on next page)

Item Description

«TRANSITION DETECTOR OR» The projector has been transferred from previously installed positions. If you wish to have a square wave on screen again, disable TransitionDetector on menu.

If this function is set to ON and the vertical angle of the projector or the INSTALLATION setting is different from the previous recorded setting, the TRANSITION DETECTOR ON alarm will be displayed and the input signal will not be displayed.

• To display the signal again, set this function OFF.
• After about 5 minutes of displaying the TRANSITION DETECTOR ON alarm, the lamp will turn off.
- Keystone adjustment feature has been prohibited as long as the Transition Detector function is on.

1 Turning on the TRANSITION DETECTOR

1-1 Use the ▲/▼ buttons on the SECURITY menu to select TRANSITION DETECTOR and press the ▶ or the ENTER button to display the TRANSITION DETECTOR on/off menu.

HITACHI CPX10WN - Turning on the TRANSITION DETECTOR - 1

1-2 Use the ▲/▼ buttons on the TRANSITION DETECTOR on/off menu to select ON. Selecting ON will save the setting of the current angle and the INSTALLATION setting. The ENTER NEW PASSWORD box (small) will be displayed.

TRANSITION DETECTOR ENTER NEW PASSWORD CANCEL 0 0 0 0 OK ENTER NEW PASSWORD box (small)

1-3 Use the ▲/▼/◄/► buttons to enter a password. Move the cursor to the right side of the ENTER NEW PASSWORD box (small) and press the ► button to display the NEW PASSWORD AGAIN box, enter the same password again.

HITACHI CPX10WN - Turning on the TRANSITION DETECTOR - 3

1-4 Move the cursor to the right side of the NEW PASSWORD AGAIN box and press the ▶ button to display the NOTE NEW PASSWORD box for about 30 seconds,

HITACHI CPX10WN - Turning on the TRANSITION DETECTOR - 4

please make note of the password during this time. Pressing the ENTER button on the remote control or the ▶ button on the projector will return to the TRANSITION DETECTOR on/off menu.

  • Please do not forget your TRANSITION DETECTOR password.
  • This function will activate only when the projector is started after turning off the AC power.
  • This feature may not function properly if the projector is not in a stable position when ON is selected.

2 Turning off the TRANSITION DETECTOR

2-1 Follow the procedure in 1-1 to display the TRANSITION DETECTOR on/off menu.

2-2 Select OFF to display the ENTER PASSWORD box (large). Enter the registered password and the screen will return to the TRANSITION DETECTOR on/off menu.

TRANSITION DETECTOR ENTER PASSWORD Inquiring Code 01 2345 6789 CANCEL 0 0 0 0 OK

If an incorrect password is input, the menu will close. If necessary, repeat the process from 2-1.

ENTER PASSWORD box (large)

3 If you have forgotten your password

3-1 Follow the procedure in 1-1 to display the TRANSITION DETECTOR on/off menu.
3-2 Select OFF to display the ENTER PASSWORD box (large). The 10 digit Inquiring Code will be displayed inside the box.
3-3 Contact your dealer with the 10 digit Inquiring Code. Your password will be sent after your user registration information is confirmed.

Item Description
MY TEXT PASSWORDThe MY TEXT PASSWORD function can prevent the MY TEXT from being overwritten. When the password is set for the MY TEXT;• The MY TEXT DISPLAY menu will be unavailable, which can prohibit changing the DISPLAY setting.• The MY TEXT WRITING menu will be unavailable, which can prevent the MY TEXT from being overwritten.1 Turning on the MY TEXT PASSWORD1-1 Use the ▲/▼ buttons on the SECURITY menu to select the MY TEXT PASSWORD and press the ► button to display the MY TEXT PASSWORD on/off menu. HITACHI CPX10WN - If you have forgotten your password - 11-2 Use the ▲/▼ buttons on the MY TEXT PASSWORD on/off menu to select ON. The ENTER NEW PASSWORD box (small) will be displayed. HITACHI CPX10WN - If you have forgotten your password - 21-3 Use the ▲/▼/◄/► buttons to enter the password. Move the cursor to the right side of the ENTER NEW PASSWORD box (small) and press the ► button to display the NEW PASSWORD AGAIN box, and then enter the same password again. ENTER NEW PASSWORD box (small)1-4 Move the cursor to the right side of the NEW PASSWORD AGAIN box and press ► button to display the NOTE NEW PASSWORD box for about 30 seconds, then please make note of the password during this time. HITACHI CPX10WN - If you have forgotten your password - 3HITACHI CPX10WN - If you have forgotten your password - 4Pressing the ENTER button on the remote control or ► button on the projector will return to the MY TEXT PASSWORD on/off menu.2 Turning off the MY TEXT PASSWORD2-1 Follow the procedure in 1-1 to display the MY TEXT PASSWORD on/off menu.2-2 Select OFF to display the ENTER PASSWORD box (large). Enter the registered password and the screen will return to the MY TEXT PASSWORD on/off menu. HITACHI CPX10WN - If you have forgotten your password - 5ENTER PASSWORD box (large)If an incorrect password is input, the menu will close. If necessary, repeat the process from 2-13 If you have forgotten your password3-1 Follow the procedure in 1-1 to display the MY TEXT PASSWORD on/off menu.3-2 Select OFF to display the ENTER PASSWORD box (large). The 10 digit inquiring code will be displayed inside the box.3-3 Contact your dealer with the 10 digit inquiring code. Your password will be sent after your user registration information is confirmed.

(continued on next page)

Item Description
MY TEXT DISPLAY(1) Use the ▲/▼ buttons on the SECURITY menu to select the MY TEXT DISPLAY and press the ▶ or ENTER button to display the MY TEXT DISPLAY on/off menu. HITACHI CPX10WN - If you have forgotten your password - 6(2) Use the ▲/▼ buttons on the MY TEXT DISPLAY on/off menu to select on or off.ON ⇔ OFF HITACHI CPX10WN - If you have forgotten your password - 7When it is set ON, the MY TEXT will be displayed on the START UP screen and the INPUT_INFORMATION when the INFORMATION on the SERVICE menu is chosen. • This function is available only when the MY TEXT PASSWORD function is set to the OFF. HITACHI CPX10WN - If you have forgotten your password - 8
MY TEXT WRITING(1) Use the ▲/▼ buttons on the SECURITY menu to select the MY TEXT WRITING and press the ▶button. The MY TEXT WRITING dialog will be displayed.(2) The current MY TEXT will be displayed on the first 3 lines. If not yet written, the lines will be blank.Use the ▲/▼/◄/► buttons and the ENTER or INPUT button to select and enter characters. To erase 1 character at one time, press the RESET button or press the ◀ and INPUT button at the same time. Also if you move the cursor to DELETE or ALL CLEAR on screen and press the ENTER or INPUT button, 1 character or all characters will be erased. The MY TEXT can be input up to 24 characters on each line.(3) To change an already inserted character, press the ▲/▼ button to move the cursor to one of the first 3 lines, and use the ◀/► buttons to move the cursor on the character to be changed.After pressing the ENTER or INPUT button, the character is selected. Then, follow the same procedure as described at the item (2) above.(4) To finish entering text, move the cursor to the OK on screen and press the ►, ENTER or INPUT button. To revert to the previous MY TEXT without saving changes, move the cursor to the CANCEL on screen and press the ◀, ENTER or INPUT button.• The MY TEXT WRITING function is available only when the MY TEXT PASSWORD function is set to OFF. HITACHI CPX10WN - If you have forgotten your password - 9HITACHI CPX10WN - If you have forgotten your password - 10HITACHI CPX10WN - If you have forgotten your password - 11

Presentation tools

The projector has the following two convenient tools that enable on-screen presentations easily and quickly:

- PC-LESS Presentation (below)

- USB Display (89)

PC-LESS Presentation

The PC-LESS Presentation reads image and audio data from the storage media inserted into the USB TYPE A port and displays the image in the following modes. The PC-LESS Presentation can be started by selecting the USB TYPE A port as the input source.

This feature allows you to make your presentations without using your computer.

- Thumbnail Mode (81)

- Full Screen Mode (85)

- Slideshow Mode (86)

[Supported storage media]

- USB memory (USB memory type, USB hard disk and USB card reader type)

NOTE • USB readers (adapters) that have more than one USB slot may not work (if the adapter is acknowledged as multiple devices connected).

- USB hubs may not work.

- USB devices with security software may not work.

- Be careful when inserting or removing a USB device. (12, 83)

[Supported format]

• FAT12, FAT16 and FAT32

• NTFS is not supported.NOTE

PC-LESS Presentation (continued)

[Supported file format and its extension]

  • JPEG (.jpeg, .jpg) * Progressive is not supported.
  • Bitmap (.bmp) * 16bit mode and compressed bitmap is not supported.
  • PNG (.png) * Interlace PNG is not supported.
  • GIF (.gif)

NOTE • Files with a resolution larger than the following are not supported.

CPX10WN, CPX11WN: 1024 x 768

CPWX12WN: 1280 x 800

(* Some computers may not support 1280 x 800.)

  • Files with a resolution smaller than 36x36 are not supported.
  • Files with a resolution smaller than 100x100 may not be displayed.
  • Some supported files may not be displayed.
  • Only a frame appears when the content of image data cannot be displayed in the Thumbnail mode.
  • Even with the file format and audio format combinations described above, playback of some files may fail.

Thumbnail Mode

The Thumbnail mode displays the images stored in a USB storage device on the Thumbnail screen. Maximum 20 images are displayed in a screen.

If you wish, you can jump into the Full Screen mode or Slideshow mode, after you select some images in the Thumbnail mode.

The Thumbnail mode will be started as the primary function of the PC-LESS Presentation after selecting the USB TYPE A port as the input source.

USB TYPE A 001/003 page SORT SLIDESHOW Selected image Folder_1 Folder_2 001.jpg 001.jpg 002.jpg 003.jpg 004.jpg 005.jpg 006.jpg 007.jpg 008.jpg 009.jpg 010.jpg 011.jpg 012.jpg 013.jpg 014.jpg 015.jpg 016.jpg 017.jpg Thumbnail menu Thumbnail images INPUT MENU REMOVE USB ENTER SET

PC-LESS Presentation (continued)

Operating by buttons or keys

You can control the images on the Thumbnail screen with the remote control, control panel or Web Remote Control. The following functions can be supported while the Thumbnail is displayed.

Button operationFunctions
The remote controlControl panelWeb Remote Control
▲/▼/◄/►▲/▼/◄/►[▲]/[▼]/[◄]/[►]Moves cursor.
PAGE UP PAGE DOWN-[PAGE UP] [PAGE DOWN]Switches pages.
ENTER INPUT [ENTER]• Displays the selected image on the Full Screen mode when a cursor is on a thumbnail image.• Displays the SETUP menu (below) for the selected image when a cursor is on a thumbnail image number.

The SETUP menu for the selected image

Item Functions
SETUPUse the ◀/▶ cursor buttons to switch each setting or use the ▶cursor button to execute the functions as follows.
RETURNPress the ▶ cursor button or ENTER to return to the Thumbnail screen.
STARTSwitch to ON to set the selected image as the first image in the Slideshow. This setting information will be saved in the “playlist.txt” file (88).
STOPSwitch to ON to set the selected image as the last image in the Slideshow. This setting information will be saved in the “playlist.txt” file (88).
SKIPSwitch to ON to skip the selected image in the Slideshow. This setting information will be saved in the “playlist.txt” file (88).
ROTATEPress the ▶ cursor or ENTER button to rotate the selected still image 90 degrees clockwise. This setting information will be saved in the “playlist.txt” file (88).

PC-LESS Presentation (continued)

Operating by the menu on the Thumbnail screen

You can also control the images by using the menu on the Thumbnail screen.

Item Functions
Moves to an upper folder.
SORT Allows you to sort files and folders as following.
RETURNPress the ▶ cursor button or ENTER to return to the Thumbnail screen.
NAME UP Sorts in ascending order by file name.
NAME DOWN Sorts in descending order by file name.
DATE UP Sorts in ascending order by file date.
DATE DOWN Sorts in descending order.by file date.
▲/▼ Go to previous / next page.
SLIDESHOW Configures and starts the Slideshow ( 86).
RETURNPress the ▶ cursor button or ENTER to return to the Thumbnail screen.
PLAYPress the ▶ cursor button or ENTER to start the Slideshow.
START Sets the beginning number of the Slideshow.
STOP Sets the end number of the Slideshow.
INTERVALSets the interval time of displaying still images during the Slideshow.
PLAY MODE Selects the Slideshow mode.
INPUT Switches the input port.
MENU Displays the menu.
REMOVE USBBe sure to use this function before removing USB storage device from the projector. After that, the projector will not recognize a USB storage device until you insert it again into the USB TYPE A input port.

PC-LESS Presentation (continued)

NOTE • These operations are not accessible while the projector OSD is displayed.

  • The Thumbnail mode is able to display up to 20 files in one page.
  • It is not possible to change the input port by using the INPUT button when the Thumbnail screen, Slideshow, or Full Screen is displayed.
  • Some error icons will be displayed in the Thumbnail.

HITACHI CPX10WN - PC-LESS Presentation (continued) - 1

This file seems to be broken or not supported format.

HITACHI CPX10WN - PC-LESS Presentation (continued) - 2

HITACHI CPX10WN - PC-LESS Presentation (continued) - 3

HITACHI CPX10WN - PC-LESS Presentation (continued) - 4

A file that cannot be displayed on the thumbnail screen is indicated by a file format icon.

HITACHI CPX10WN - PC-LESS Presentation (continued) - 5

HITACHI CPX10WN - PC-LESS Presentation (continued) - 6

PC-LESS Presentation (continued)

Full Screen Mode

The Full Screen mode shows a full display image. To display in Full Screen mode, select an image in the Thumbnail screen. Then press the ENTER button on the remote control, the INPUT button on the control panel or click [ENTER] on the Web Remote Control.

Full screen display

Operations for still images

The following operations are enabled in the Full Screen mode while a still image is displayed.

Button operationFunctions
The remote controlControl panelWeb Remote Control
▼▶orPAGE DOWN▼or▶[▼][▶]or[PAGE DOWN]Shows the next file.
▲◀orPAGE UP▲or◀[▲][◀]or[PAGE UP]Shows the previous file.
ENTER INPUT[ENTER] DisplaysThumbnail.

PC-LESS Presentation (continued)

Slideshow Mode

The Slideshow mode displays images in full screen and switches the images at intervals set in INTERVAL on the Thumbnail screen menu (83).

HITACHI CPX10WN - Slideshow Mode - 1

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Food and dishes"] <--> B["Landscape"]
    B <--> C["Animal"]
    C --> D["Beach"]
    D -.-> E["Pet animals"]
    E --> F["Animal"]
    F --> A

You can start this function from the Slideshow menu. To display the Slideshow menu, select the SLIDESHOW button in the Thumbnail mode and press the ENTER button on the remote control, INPUT button on the control panel, or click [ENTER] on the Web Remote Control.

While the Slideshow is displayed, the following button operations are enabled when still images are displayed, and the same button operations in the Full Screen mode are enabled when movies are displayed.

Button operationFunctions
The remote controlControl panelWeb Remote Control
ENTER INPUT [ENTER] Displaysthumbnail.

NOTE • These operations are not accessible while the projector OSD is displayed.

- It is not possible to change the input port by using the INPUT button when the Thumbnail screen, Slideshow, or Full Screen is displayed.

- When the Slideshow mode is set to ONE TIME and the last file is a still image, the last slide of the presentation will remain displayed until the ENTER button on the remote control or Web Remote Control, or the INPUT button on the control panel is pressed.

PC-LESS Presentation (continued)

You can play the Slideshow at your desired configuration. Configure the Slideshow items in the Thumbnail.

1) RETURN : Returns to the thumbnail mode.

2) PLAY : Play the Slideshow.

3) START : Set the beginning number of the Slideshow.

4) STOP : Set the end number of the Slideshow.

5) INTERVAL : Sets the interval time for displaying still images during the Slideshow. It is not recommend to set the interval time very short something like several seconds, because it may take more than several seconds to read and display an image file if it is stored in very deep layer directory or if so many files are stored in the same directory.

6) PLAY MODE : Select the Slideshow mode. ONE TIME : Play the Slideshow one time. ENDLESS : Play the Slideshow endless.

SLIDESHOW RETURN EXECUTE PLAY EXECUTE START #1 STOP #10 INTERVAL 1s PLAY MODE ONE TIME

NOTE • The settings of the Slideshow are saved to the “playlist.txt” file that is stored in the storage media. If the file is not existed, it is generated automatically.

  • The settings for the START, STOP, INTERVAL, and PLAY MODE are saved to the Playlist.
  • If the storage media is under the write protection or the "playlist.txt" is the read only type file, it is impossible to change the settings of the Slideshow.

PC-LESS Presentation (continued)

Playlist

The Playlist is a DOS format text file, which decides the order of displayed still image files in the Thumbnail or Slideshow.

The playlist file name is “playlist.txt” and it can be edited on a computer.

It is created in the folder that contains the selected image files when the PC-LESS

Presentation is started or the Slideshow is configured.

[Example of "playlist.txt" files]

START setting : STOP setting : INTERVAL setting : PLAY MODE setting :

img001.jpg::::

img002.jpg:600:::

img003.jpg:700:rot1::

img004.jpg: : :SKIP:

img005.jpg:1000:rot2:SKIP:

The “playlist.txt” file contains the following information.

Each piece of information requires to be separated by “:”, and “:” at the end of each line.

1st line: START, STOP, INTERVAL and PLAY MODE settings (☐87).

2nd line and after: file name, interval time, rotation setting and skip setting.

interval time: It can be set from 0 to 999900 (ms) with an increment of 100 (ms).

rotation setting : “rot1” means a rotation at 90 degrees clockwise; “rot2” and “rot3” increase another 90 degrees in order.

skip setting: “SKIP” means that the image will not be displayed in the Slideshow.

NOTE • The maximum length in a line on the "playlist.txt" file is 255 characters including linefeed. If any line exceeds the limit, the "playlist.txt" file becomes invalid.

- Up to 999 files can be registered to the Playlist. However, if some folders exist in the same directory the limit number is decreased by the number of folders.

Any files over the limit will not be shown in the Slideshow.

- If the storage device is protected or does not have sufficient space, the “playlist.txt” file cannot be created.

- For the Slideshow settings, refer to the section Slideshow Mode (86).

HITACHI CPX10WN - Playlist - 1

USB Display

The projector can display images transferred from a computer via an USB cable (11).

Hardware and software requirement for computer

  • OS: One of the following. (32 bit version only)
    Windows ^® XP Home Edition /Professional Edition
    Windows Vista ^® Home Basic /Home Premium /Business /Ultimate /Enterprise
    Windows ^® 7 Starter /Home Basic /Home Premium /Professional / Ultimate / Enterprise
    • CPU: Pentium 4 (2.8 GHz or higher)
    • Graphic card: 16 bit, XGA or higher
    • Memory: 512 MB or higher
  • Hard disk space: 30 MB or higher
  • USB Port
  • USB cable : 1 piece

Starting USB Display

Select the USB DISPLAY for the USB TYPE B item in the OPTION menu. When you connect your computer to the USB TYPE B port on the projector using a USB cable, the projector will be recognized as a CD-ROM drive on your computer. Then, the software in the projector, "LiveViewerLiteUSB.exe", will run automatically and the application, "LiveViewer Lite for USB", will be ready on your computer for the USB Display. The application, "LiveViewer Lite for USB", will close automatically when the USB cable is unplugged. However, it may remain displayed at times.

NOTE • If the software does not start automatically (this is typically because CD-ROM autorun is disabled on your OS), follow the instructions below.

(1) Click on the [Start] button on the toolbar and select the "Run"

(2) Enter F:\LiveViewerLiteUSB.exe and then press the [OK]

If your CD-ROM drive is not drive F on your computer, you will need to replace F with the correct drive letter assigned to your CD-ROM drive.

  • CD-ROM autorun is disabled while the screen saver is running.
  • The image transmission from the computer is suspended while the password-protected screen saver is running. To resume the transmission, exit the screen saver.
  • If "Waiting for connection." remains displayed while the USB cable is connected, remove the USB cable and reconnect after a while.
  • Check our web site for the latest version of the software and its manual.

(User's Manual (concise))

Follow the instructions that can be obtained at the site for updating.

USB Display (continued)

This application will appear in the Windows notification area once it starts. You can quit the application from your computer by selecting "Quit" on the menu.

3:00 PM

NOTE • The “LiveViewer” (refer to the Network Guide) and this application cannot be used at the same time. If you connect your computer to the projector by using a USB cable

LiveViewer Lite for USB Cannot start LiveViewer Lite for USB while LiveViewer is running. OK

while the "LiveViewer" is running, the following message will be displayed.

  • Depending on the software installed on your computer, images on your computer cannot be transferred using "LiveViewer Lite for USB".
  • If any application software having the firewall function is installed into your computer, make the firwall function invalid with following the user's manual.
  • Some security software may block image transmission. Please change the security software setting to allow the use of "LiveViewer Lite for USB".

- When the audio input from USB TYPE B (46) is selected, if the sound level is still low even after raising the volume level in the projector to the maximum, check whether your computer outputs audio and raise the volume level accordingly.

- If the computer in use is equipped with HDMI port, the audio setting will be changed and sound interruption or noise may occur when the HDMI cable is connected or disconnected during USB Display. Restart USB Display for this case.

- Image distortion or sound interruption may occur when “LiveViewer” is connected to LAN (wireless or wired) during USB Display. The above decline in performance is noticeable especially when multiple computers are connected to “LiveViewer”.

USB Display (continued)

Right-Click menu

The menu shown in the right will be displayed when you right-click the application icon in the Windows notification area.

Display Quit 3:00 PM

Display : The Floating menu is displayed, and the icon disappears from the Windows notification area.

Quit : The application is closed, and the icon disappears from the Windows notification area.

NOTE • If you wish to restart the application, you need to unplug the USB cable and plug it again.

Floating menu

If you select "Display" on the Right-Click menu, the Floating menu shown in the right will appear on your computer screen.

① Start capture button The transmission to the projector is started and the images will be displayed.
② Stop button The image transmission is stopped.
③ Hold button The image on the projector's screen is temporally frozen. The last image before the button is clicked is remained on the screen. You can revise the image data on your computer without showing it on the projector's screen.
④ Option button The Options window is displayed.
⑤ Minimize button The Floating menu is closed, and the icon reappears in the Windows notification area.

NOTE • If you click the Start capture button and/or Stop button repeatedly, images may not be displayed on the screen.

LiveViewer Lite for USB ① ③ ④ ⑤ ②

USB Display (continued)

Options window

If you select the Option button on the Floating menu, the Options window is displayed.

Optimize Performance

The “LiveViewer Lite for USB” captures screenshots in JPEG data and sends them to the projector. The “LiveViewer Lite for USB” has two options that have different compression rate of JPEG data.

Options Settings About Optimize Performance ○ Transmission speed ● Image quality ✓ Keep PC resolution ✓ Sound Close

Transmission speed

Speed takes priority over Image quality.

It makes JPEG compression rate higher.

The screen on the projector is rewritten quicker because the transferred data is smaller, but the image quality is worse.

Image quality

Image quality takes priority over Speed.

It makes JPEG compression rate lower.

The screen on the projector is rewritten slower because the transferred data is larger, but the image quality is better.

Keep PC resolution

If you remove the check mark from the [Keep PC resolution] box, the screen resolution of your computer will be switched as follows, and the display speed may be faster.

CPX10WN, CPX11WN: 1024 x 768 (XGA)

CPWX12WN: 1280 x 800

If your computer does not support the display resolution specified above, a smaller resolution that is the largest among the resolutions that are supported by the computer will be selected.

Sound

Turns the sound on/off. The image quality may deteriorate when you play back audio data transferred together with the image data. To give priority to the image quality, turn off the sound by selecting the checkbox.

About

The version information of the "LiveViewer Lite for USB".

NOTE • When the resolution is changed, the arrangement of icons on computer desktop screen may be changed.

- If one of the AUDIO IN ports is selected or ✗ is selected for USB TYPE B in AUDIO SOURCE of the AUDIO menu (46), audio sound operation in the Options window will be disabled.

Maintenance

Replacing the lamp

A lamp has finite product life. Using the lamp for long periods of time could cause the pictures darker or the color tone poor. Note that each lamp has a different lifetime, and some may burst or burn out soon after you start using them.

Preparation of a new lamp and early replacement are recommended. To prepare a new lamp, make contact with your dealer and tell the lamp type number.

Type number : DT01191

Replacing the lamp

  1. Turn the projector off, and unplug the power cord. Allow the projector to cool for at least 45 minutes.
  2. Prepare a new lamp. If the projector is mounted on a ceiling, or if the lamp has broken, also ask the dealer to replace the lamp.

Lamp cover

In case of replacement by yourself, follow the following procedure.

  1. Loosen the screw (marked by arrow) of the lamp cover and then slide and lift the lamp cover to the side to remove it.
  2. Loosen the 2 screws (marked by arrow) of the lamp, and slowly pick up the lamp by the handle. Never loosen any other screws.
  3. Insert the new lamp, and retighten firmly the 2 screws of the lamp that are loosened in the previous process to lock it in place.
  4. While putting the interlocking parts of the lamp cover and the projector together, slide the lamp cover back in place. Then firmly fasten the screw of the lamp cover.

  5. Turn the projector on and reset the lamp time using the LAMP TIME item in the OPTION menu.

3 4 5 Handle

HITACHI CPX10WN - In case of replacement by yourself, follow the following procedure. - 2

natural_image Line drawing of a refrigerator with a door and control panel (no text or symbols)

(1) Press the MENU button to display a menu.
(2) Point at the ADVANCED MENU in the menu using the ▼/▲ button, then press the ▶ button.
(3) Point at the OPTION in the left column of the menu using the ▼/▲ button, then press the ▶ button.

(4) Point at the LAMP TIME using the ▼/▲ button, then press the ▶ button. A dialog will appear.

(5) Press the ▶ button to select "OK" on the dialog. It performs resetting the lamp time.

⚠️ CAUTION ▶ Do not touch any inner space of the projector, while the lamp is taken out.

NOTE • Please reset the lamp time only when you have replaced the lamp, for a suitable indication about the lamp.

Replacing the lamp (continued)

Lamp warning

HITACHI CPX10WN - Lamp warning - 1

HIGH VOLTAGE

HITACHI CPX10WN - HIGH VOLTAGE - 1

HIGH TEMPERATURE

HITACHI CPX10WN - HIGH TEMPERATURE - 1

HIGH PRESSURE

⚠ WARNING ▶ The projector uses a high-pressure mercury glass lamp. The lamp can break with a loud bang, or burn out, if jolted or scratched, handled while hot, or worn over time. Note that each lamp has a different lifetime, and some may burst or burn out soon after you start using them. In addition, if the bulb bursts, it is possible for shards of glass to fly into the lamp housing, and for gas containing mercury and dust containing fine particles of glass to escape from the projector's vent holes.
▶ About disposal of a lamp: This product contains a mercury lamp; do not put it in a trash. Dispose of it in accordance with environmental laws.

- For lamp recycling, go to www.lamprecycle.org (in the US).

- For product disposal, consult your local government agency or www.eiae.org (in the US) or www.epsc.ca (in Canada).

For more information, call your dealer.

HITACHI CPX10WN - HIGH PRESSURE - 1

Disconnect the plug from the power outlet

  • If the lamp should break (it will make a loud bang when it does), unplug the power cord from the outlet, and make sure to request a replacement lamp from your local dealer. Note that shards of glass could damage the projector's internals, or cause injury during handling, so please do not try to clean the projector or replace the lamp yourself.
  • If the lamp should break (it will make a loud bang when it does), ventilate the room well, and make sure not to inhale the gas or fine particles that come out from the projector's vent holes, and not to get them into your eyes or mouth.
  • Before replacing the lamp, turn the projector off and unplug the power cord, then wait at least 45 minutes for the lamp to cool sufficiently. Handling the lamp while hot can cause burns, as well as damaging the lamp.

HITACHI CPX10WN - HIGH PRESSURE - 2

- Never unscrew except the appointed (marked by an arrow) screws.

- Do not open the lamp cover while the projector is suspended from a ceiling. This is dangerous, since if the lamp's bulb has broken, the shards will fall out when the cover is opened. In addition, working in high places is dangerous, so ask your local dealer to have the lamp replaced even if the bulb is not broken.

- Do not use the projector with the lamp cover removed. At the lamp replacing, make sure that the screws are screwed in firmly. Loose screws could result in damage or injury.

HITACHI CPX10WN - HIGH PRESSURE - 3

- Use only the lamp of the specified type. Use of a lamp that does not meet the lamp specifications for this model could cause a fire, damage or shorten the life of this product.

- If the lamp breaks soon after the first time it is used, it is possible that there are electrical problems elsewhere besides the lamp. If this happens, consult your local dealer or a service representative.

- Handle with care: jolting or scratching could cause the lamp bulb to burst during use.

- Using the lamp for long periods of time, could cause it dark, not to light up or to burst. When the pictures appear dark, or when the color tone is poor, please replace the lamp as soon as possible. Do not use old (used) lamps; this is a cause of breakage.

Cleaning and replacing the air filter

The air filter unit of this projector consists of a filter cover, two kinds of filters, and a filter frame. The new double large filters system is expected to function longer. However, please check and clean it periodically to keep ventilation needed for normal operation of the projector.

When the indicators or a message prompts you to clean the air filter, comply with it as soon as possible. Replace the filters when they are damaged or too soiled. To prepare new filters, make contact with your dealer and tell the following type number.

Type number : UX36761 (Filter set)

When you replace the lamp, please replace the air filter. An air filter of specified type will come together with a replacement lamp for this projector.

  1. Turn the projector off, and unplug the power cord. Allow the projector to sufficiently cool down.
  2. Use a vacuum cleaner on and around the filter cover.
  3. Pick and pull up the filter cover knobs to take it off.
  4. Use a vacuum cleaner for the filter vent of the projector.
  5. Take the fine meshed filter out while holding the filter cover. It is recommended to leave the coarse meshed filter in the filter cover as it is.
  6. Use a vacuum cleaner on both sides of the fine meshed filter while holding it so it will not be sucked in. Use a vacuum cleaner for the inside of the filter cover to clean up the coarse meshed filter. If the filters are damaged or heavily soiled, replace them with new ones.
  7. Put the fine meshed filter on the coarse meshed one, turning its stitched side up.
  8. Put the filter unit back into the projector.

2 Filter cover

HITACHI CPX10WN - Type number : UX36761 (Filter set) - 2

natural_image Line drawing of a car air conditioner panel with grid layout and fan base (no text or symbols)

Filter cover knobs

4 Intake vent

HITACHI CPX10WN - Type number : UX36761 (Filter set) - 4

natural_image Two rectangular objects with grid patterns, possibly woven or mesh surfaces, placed side by side (no text or symbols visible)

Filter (coarse meshed) Filter (fine meshed)

HITACHI CPX10WN - Type number : UX36761 (Filter set) - 5
Stitched side

(continued on next page)

Cleaning and replacing the air filter (continued)

9. Turn the projector on and reset the filter time using the FILTER TIME item in the EASY MENU.

(1) Press the MENU button to display a menu.
(2) Point at the FILTER TIME using the ▼/▲ button, then press the ▶ button. A dialog will appear.
(3) Press the ▶ button to select "OK" on the dialog. It performs resetting the filter time.

⚠ WARNING ▶ Before taking care of the air filter, make sure the power cable is not plugged in, then allow the projector to cool sufficiently. Taking care of the air filter in a high temperature state of the projector could cause an electric shock, a burn or malfunction to the projector.

▶ Use only the air filter of the specified type. Do not use the projector without the air filter or the filter cover. It could result in a fire or malfunction to the projector.
▶ Clean the air filter periodically. If the air filter becomes clogged by dust or the like, internal temperatures rise and could cause a fire, a burn or malfunction to the projector.

NOTE • Please replace the air filter when it is damaged or heavily soiled.

  • When you replace the projection lamp, please replace the air filter. An air filter of specified type will come together with a replacement lamp for this projector.
  • Please reset the filter time only when you have cleaned or replaced the air filter, for a suitable indication about the air filter.
  • The projector may display the message such as “CHECK THE AIR FLOW” or turn off the projector, to prevent the internal heat level rising.

Other care

Inside of the projector

In order to ensure the safe use of your projector, please have it cleaned and inspected by your dealer about once every year.

Caring for the lens

If the lens is flawed, soiled or fogged, it could cause deterioration of display quality. Please take care of the lens, being cautious of handling.

  1. Turn the projector off, and unplug the power cord. Allow the projector to cool sufficiently.
  2. After making sure that the projector is cool adequately, lightly wipe the lens with a commercially available lens-cleaning wipe. Do not touch the lens directly with your hand.

Caring for the cabinet and remote control

Incorrect care could have adverse influence such as discoloration, peeling paint, etc.

  1. Turn the projector off, and unplug the power cord. Allow the projector to cool sufficiently.
  2. After making sure that the projector is cool adequately, lightly wipe with gauze or a soft cloth.
    If the projector is extremely dirty, dip soft cloth in water or a neutral cleaner diluted in water, and wipe lightly after wringing well. Then, wipe lightly with a soft, dry cloth.

⚠ WARNING ▶ Before caring, make sure the power cord is not plugged in, and then allow the projector to cool sufficiently. The care in a high temperature state of the projector could cause a burn and/or malfunction to the projector.

▶ Never try to care for the inside of the projector personally. Doing is so dangerous.
▶ Avoid wetting the projector or inserting liquids in the projector. It could result in a fire, an electric shock, and/or malfunction to the projector.
- Do not put anything containing water, cleaners or chemicals near the projector.
- Do not use aerosols or sprays.

⚠️ CAUTION ▶ Please take right care of the projector according to the following. Incorrect care could cause not only an injury but adverse influence such as discoloration, peeling paint, etc.

▶ Do not use cleaners or chemicals other than those specified in this manual.

▶ Do not polish or wipe with hard objects.

NOTICE ▶ Do not directly touch the lens surface with hands.

Troubleshooting

If an abnormal operation should occur, stop using the projector immediately.

⚠ WARNING ▶ Never use the projector if abnormal operations such as smoke, strange odor, excessive sound, damaged casing or elements or cables, penetration of liquids or foreign matter, etc. should occur. In such cases, immediately disconnect the power plug from the power outlet. After making sure that the smoke or odor has stopped, contact to your dealer or service company.

Otherwise if a problem occurs with the projector, the following checks and measures are recommended before requesting repair.

If this does not resolve the problem, please contact your dealer or service company. They will tell you what warranty condition is applied.

When some message appears, check and cope with it according to the following table. Although these messages will be automatically disappeared around several minutes, it will be reappeared every time the power is turned on.

Message Description
HITACHI CPX10WN - Related messages - 1There is no input signal.Please confirm the signal input connection, and the status of the signal source.
HITACHI CPX10WN - Related messages - 2The USB TYPE B port is selected as the picture input source even if MOUSE is selected for USB TYPE B (54).Select USB DISPLAY in the dialog to project the picture input to the USB TYPE B port. In this case, you cannot use the simple mouse and keyboard function. Otherwise select other port for picture input.
HITACHI CPX10WN - Related messages - 3Projector is waiting for an image file.Check the hardware connection, settings on the projector and network-related settings.The computer-Projector network connection might be disconnected. Please re-connect them.
HITACHI CPX10WN - Related messages - 4
HITACHI CPX10WN - Related messages - 5The horizontal or vertical frequency of the input signal is not within the specified range.Please confirm the specs for your projector or the signal source specs.
HITACHI CPX10WN - Related messages - 6An improper signal is input.Please confirm the specs for your projector or the signal source specs.

(continued on next page)

Message Description
HITACHI CPX10WN - Related messages (continued) - 1The internal temperature is rising.Please turn the power off, and allow the projector to cool down at least 20 minutes. After having confirmed the following items, please turn the power ON again.Is there blockage of the air passage aperture?Is the air filter dirty?Does the peripheral temperature exceed 35°C?If the projector is used at an altitude of about 1600 m (5250 feet) or higher, set ALTITUDE of the SERVICE item in the OPTION menu to HIGH (57).If the projector is used with a wrong setting, it may cause damage to the projector itself or the parts inside.
HITACHI CPX10WN - Related messages (continued) - 2A note of precaution when cleaning the air filter.Please immediately turn the power off, and clean or change the air filter referring to the Cleaning and replacing the air filter section of this manual. After you have cleaned or changed the air filter, please be sure to reset the filter timer (55, 95).
HITACHI CPX10WN - Related messages (continued) - 3The button operation is not available.

Regarding the indicator lamps

When operation of the LAMP, TEMP and POWER indicators differs from usual, check and cope with it according to the following table.

POWER indicatorLAMP indicatorTEMP indicatorDescription
Lighting In OrangeTurned offTurned offThe projector is in a standby state.Please refer to the section “Power on/off”.
Blinking In GreenTurned offTurned offThe projector is warming up.Please wait.
Lighting In GreenTurned offTurned offThe projector is in an on state. Ordinary operations may be performed.
Blinking In OrangeTurned offTurned offThe projector is cooling down.Please wait.
Blinking In Red(discretionary)(discretionary)The projector is cooling down. A certain error has been detected.Please wait until POWER indicator finishes blinking, and then perform the proper measure using the item descriptions below.
Blinking In Red or Lighting In RedLighting In RedTurned offThe lamp does not light, and there is a possibility that interior portion has become heated.Please turn the power off, and allow the projector to cool down at least 20 minutes. After the projector has sufficiently cooled down, please make confirmation of the following items, and then turn the power on again.Is there blockage of the air passage aperture?Is the air filter dirty?Does the peripheral temperature exceed 35°C?If the same indication is displayed after the remedy, please change the lamp referring to the sectionReplacing the lamp.
Blinking In Red or Lighting In RedBlinking In RedTurned offThe lamp cover has not been properly fixed.Please turn the power off, and allow the projector to cool down at least 45 minutes. After the projector has sufficiently cooled down, please make confirmation of the attachment state of the lamp cover. After performing any needed maintenance, turn the power on again.If the same indication is displayed after the remedy, please contact your dealer or service company.
Blinking In Red or Lighting In RedTurned offBlinking In RedThe cooling fan is not operating.Please turn the power off, and allow the projector to cool down at least 20 minutes. After the projector has sufficiently cooled down, please make confirmation that no foreign matter has become caught in the fan, etc., and then turn the power on again.If the same indication is displayed after the remedy, please contact your dealer or service company.
Blinking In Red or Lighting In RedTurned offLighting In RedThere is a possibility that the interior portion has become heated.Please turn the power off, and allow the projector to cool down at least 20 minutes. After the projector has sufficiently cooled down, please make confirmation of the following items, and then turn the power on again.Is there blockage of the air passage aperture?Is the air filter dirty?Does the peripheral temperature exceed 35°C?If the projector is used at an altitude of about 1600 m (5250 feet) or higher, set ALTITUDE of the SERVICE item in the OPTION menu to HIGH (57). If the projector is used with a wrong setting, it may cause damage to the projector itself or the parts inside.
Lighting In GreenSimultaneous blinking in RedIt is time to clean the air filter.Please immediately turn the power off, and clean or change the air filter referring to the section Cleaning and replacing the air filter. After cleaning or changing the air filter, please be sure to reset the filter timer. After the remedy, reset the power to ON.
Lighting In GreenAlternative blinking in RedThere is a possibility that the interior portion has become overcooled.Please use the unit within the usage temperature parameters (5°C to 35°C).After the treatment, reset the power to ON.
Blinking In Green for approx. 3 seconds.Turned offTurned offAt least 1 Power ON schedule is saved to the projector.Please refer to Schedule Settings in the Network Guide.

NOTE • When the interior portion has become overheated, for safety purposes, the projector is automatically shut down, and the indicator lamps may also be turned off. In such a case, disconnect the power cord, and wait at least 45 minutes. After the projector has sufficiently cooled down, please make confirmation of the attachment state of the lamp and lamp cover, and then turn the power on again. If the projector is used at an altitude of about 1600 m (5250 feet) or higher, set ALTITUDE of the SERVICE item in the OPTION menu to HIGH(☐57). Otherwise, set it to NORMAL.

Resetting all settings

When it is hard to correct some wrong settings, the FACTORY RESET function of SERVICE item in OPTION menu (62) can reset all settings (except settings such as LANGUAGE, LAMP TIME, FILTER TIME, FILTER MESSAGE, SECURITY and NETWORK) to the factory default. Be sure to set ALTITUDE after resetting all the settings (57).

Phenomena that may be easy to be mistaken for machine defects

About the phenomenon confused with a machine defect, check and cope with it according to the following table.

Phenomenon Cases not involving a machine defectReference page
Power does not come on.The electrical power cord is not plugged in.Correctly connect the power cord.15
The main power source has been interrupted during operation such as by a power outage (blackout), etc.Please disconnect the power plug from the power outlet, and allow the projector to cool down at least 10 minutes, then turn the power on again.15
Either there is no lamp and/or lamp cover, or either of these has not been properly fixed.Please turn the power off and disconnect the power plug from the power outlet, and allow the projector to cool down at least 45 minutes. After the projector has sufficiently cooled down, please make confirmation of the attachment state of the lamp and lamp cover, and then turn the power on again.93
Neither sounds nor pictures are outputted.The signal cables are not correctly connected.Correctly connect the connection cables.10 ~ 14
Signal source does not correctly work.Correctly set up the signal source device by referring to the manual of the source device.-
The input changeover settings are mismatched.Select the input signal, and correct the settings.21 ~ 23
The BLANK function for pictures and the MUTE function for sounds are working.AV MUTE may be active.Refer to the item “Sound does not come out” and “No pictures are displayed” on the next page to turn off the MUTE and BLANK functions.28, 57, 103
Phenomenon CCases not involving a machine defectReference page
Sound does not come out.The signal cables are not correctly connected.Correctly connect the audio cables.10 ~ 14
The MUTE function is working.Restore the sound pressing MUTE or VOLUME +/-button on the remote control.21
The volume is adjusted to an extremely low level.Adjust the volume to a higher level using the menu function or the remote control.21, 46
The AUDIO SOURCE/SPEAKER setting is not correct.Correctly set the AUDIO SOURCE/SPEAKER in AUDIO menu.46
The mode selected for HDMI AUDIO is not suitable.Check each of the two modes provided and select the suitable one for your HDMITM audio device.46
The Sound button or checkbox is disabled.If you have selected USB TYPE B, remove the check mark from the Sound checkbox in the Options window of "LiveViewer Lite for USB".If you have selected LAN, remove the check mark from the Sound checkbox in the Option menu of "LiveViewer".92
No pictures are displayed.The lens cover is attached.Remove the lens cover.4, 20
The signal cables are not correctly connected.Correctly connect the connection cables.10 ~ 14
The brightness is adjusted to an extremely low level.Adjust BRIGHTNESS to a higher level using the menu function.33
The computer cannot detect the projector as a plug and play monitor.Make sure that the computer can detect a plug and play monitor using another plug and play monitor.10
The BLANK screen is displayed.Press BLANK button on the remote control.28
The USB TYPE B port is selected as the picture input source even if MOUSE is selected for USB TYPE B.Select USB DISPLAY for USB TYPE B in OPTION menu to project the picture input to the port. Otherwise select other port for picture input.54
"Waiting for connection." remains displayed even though the USB TYPE B port is selected.Remove the USB cable and reconnect after a while.89
Phenomenon Cases not involving a machine defectReference page
No pictures are displayed. (continued)The projector does not recognize the USB storage device inserted into USB TYPE A port.Use the REMOVE USB function first, remove the USB storage device, and then insert it into the port again.Before removing the USB storage device, be sure to use the REMOVE USB function on the thumbnail screen, which appears when the USB TYPE A port is selected as the input source.12, 83
Video screen display freezes.The FREEZE function is working.Press FREEZE button to restore the screen to normal.28
Colors have a faded-out appearance, or Color tone is poor.Color settings are not correctly adjusted.Perform picture adjustments by changing the COLOR TEMP, COLOR, TINT and/or COLOR SPACE settings, using the menu functions.34, 39
COLOR SPACE setting is not suitable.Change the COLOR SPACE setting to AUTO, RGB, SMPTE240, REC709 or REC601.39
Pictures appear dark.The brightness and/or contrast are adjusted to an extremely low level.Adjust BRIGHTNESS and/or CONTRAST settings to a higher level using the menu function.33
The projector is operating in Eco mode.Set ECO MODE to NORMAL, and set AUTO ECO MODE to OFF, in the SETUP menu.44
The lamp is approaching the end of its product lifetime.Replace the lamp.93, 94
Pictures appear blurry.Either the focus and/or horizontal phase settings are not properly adjusted.Adjust the focus using the focus ring, and/or H PHASE using the menu function.24, 38
The lens is dirty or misty.Clean the lens referring to the section Caring for the lens.97
Phenomenon CCases not involving a machine defectReference page
Some kind of image degradation such as flickering or stripes appear on screen.When the projector is operating in Eco mode, flickering may appear on screen.Set ECO MODE to NORMAL, and set AUTO ECO MODE to OFF, in the SETUP menu.44
The OVER SCAN ratio is too big.Adjust OVER SCAN in the IMAGE menu smaller.36
Excessive VIDEO NR.Change the setting of VIDEO NR in the INPUT menu.39
The FRAME LOCK function cannot work on the current input signal.Set FRAME LOCK in the INPUT menu to OFF.41
The sound or image is unstable or is output intermittently.When LAN or USB TYPE B port is selected, some parts of the output may be missing due to signal processing delay.Change the signal or use another port.22, 46
The computer connected to the USB TYPE B port of the projector does not start up.The computer cannot start up in the current hardware configuration.Disconnect the USB cable from the computer, then reconnect it after starting up the computer.12
RS-232C does not work.The SAVING function is working.Select NORMAL for STANDBY MODE item in the SETUP menu.45
The COMMUNICATION TYPE for the CONTROL port is set to NETWORK BRIDGE.Select OFF for COMMUNICATION TYPE item in the OPTION - SERVICE - COMMUNICATION menu.59
NETWORK BRIDGE function does not workThe NETWORK BRIDGE function is turned off.Select NETWORK BRIDGE for COMMUNICATION TYPE item in the OPTION - SERVICE - COMMUNICATION menu.59
Network does not workThe SAVING function is working.Select NORMAL for STANDBY MODE item in the SETUP menu.45
The same network address is set for both wireless and wired LAN.Change the network address setting for wireless or wired LAN.63, 68
Schedule function does not workThe SAVING function is working.Select NORMAL for STANDBY MODE item in the SETUP menu.45
The internal clock has been reset.Once you turn off the projector in the SAVING mode or the AC power, the current date and time setting is reset.Check the DATE AND TIME setting for WIRELESS SETUP or WIRED SETUP in the NETWORK menu.65, 69
When the projector is connected to wired LAN, it powers off and on as described below.Powers off←↓POWER indicatorblinks in orange a few times↓Goes into standby modeDisconnect the LAN cable and check that the projector is working properly.If this phenomenon occurs after connecting to the network, there may be a loop between two Ethernet switching hubs within the network, as explained below.- There are two or more Ethernet switching hubs in a network.- Two of the hubs are doubly connected by LAN cables.- This double connection forms a loop between the two hubs.Such a loop may have an adverse effect on the projector as well as the other network devices.Check the network connection and remove the loop by disconnecting the LAN cables such that there is only one connecting cable between two hubs.-

NOTE • Although bright spots or dark spots may appear on the screen, this is a unique characteristic of liquid crystal displays, and it does not constitute or imply a machine defect.

Specifications

Please see the Specifications in the User's Manual (concise) which is a book.

End User License Agreement for the Projector Software

  • Software in the projector consists of the plural number of independent software modules and there exist our copyright or/and third party copyrights for each of such software modules.
  • Be sure to read "End User License Agreement for the Projector Software" which is separated document.

Projector

CPX10WN/CPX11WN/ CPWX12WN

User's Manual (detailed) Network Guide

HITACHI CPX10WN - User's Manual (detailed) Network Guide - 1

natural_image Line drawing of a projector with ventilation grilles and a circular lens (no text or symbols)

Thank you for purchasing this product.

This manual is intended to explain only the network function. For proper use of this product, please refer to this manual and the other manuals for this product.

⚠ WARNING ▶ Before using this product, be sure to read all manuals for this product. After reading them, store them in a safe place for future reference.

Features

This projector has the network function that brings you the following main features.

√ Network Presentation : allows the projector to project computer images transmitted through a network. (15)
√ Web Control : allows you to monitor and control the projector through a network from a computer. (16)
√ My Image : allows the projector to store up to four still images and project them. (☐ 50)
√ Messenger : allows the projector to display text sent from a computer through a network. (51)
√ Network Bridge : allows you to control an external device through the projector from a computer. (52)

NOTE • The information in this manual is subject to change without notice.

  • The manufacturer assumes no responsibility for any errors that may appear in this manual.
  • The reproduction, transfer or copy of all or any part of this document is not permitted without express written consent.

Trademark acknowledgment

  • Microsoft ^ , Internet Explorer ^ , Windows ^ , Windows Vista ^ and Aero ^ are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the U.S. and/or other countries.
  • Adobe® and Flash® are registered trademarks of Adobe Systems Incorporated.
  • Pentium® is a registered trademark of Intel Corporation.
  • JavaScript ^ is a registered trademark of Sun Microsystems, Inc.
  • HDMI, the HDMI logo and High-Definition Multimedia Interface are trademarks or registered trademarks of HDMI Licensing LLC in the United States and other countries.
  • Crestron®, Crestron e-Control®, e-Control®, Crestron RoomView® and RoomView™ are trademarks or registered trademarks of Crestron Electronics, Inc. in the United States and other countries.

• Trademark PJLink is a trademark applied for trademark rights in Japan, the United States of America and other countries and areas. All other trademarks are the properties of their respective owners.

HITACHI CPX10WN - Trademark acknowledgment - 1

Contents

HITACHI CPX10WN - Contents - 1

Caution 4

1. Connection to the network 5

1.1 System requirements 5

1.1.1 Required equipment preparation 5
1.1.2 Hardware and software requirement for computer 5

1.2 Quick connection 6

1.3 Manual network connection setting - Wired LAN - 7

1.3.1 Equipments connection 7
1.3.2 Network settings 7
1.3.3 "Internet Option" setting 10

1.4 Manual network connection setting - Wireless LAN - 11

1.4.1 Preparation for wireless LAN connection 11
1.4.2 Wireless LAN connection set up 12

2. Network Presentation ...... 15

3. Web Control 16

3.1 Projector Web Control 17

3.1.1 Logon 17
3.1.2 Network Information 18
3.1.3 Network Settings 19
3.1.4 Port Settings 22
3.1.5 Mail Settings 24
3.1.6 Alert Settings 25
3.1.7 Schedule Settings 27
3.1.8 Date/Time Settings 30
3.1.9 Security Settings 32
3.1.10 Projector Control 33
3.1.11 Remote Control 39
3.1.12 Projector Status 40
3.1.13 Network Restart 41

3.2 Crestron e-Control ^® 42

3.2.1 Main window 43
3.2.2 Tools window 45
3.2.3 Info window 47
3.2.4 Help Desk window 48
3.2.5 Emergency Alert 49

4. My Image Function 50

5. Messenger Function 51

  1. Network Bridge Function ...... 52
    6.1 Connecting devices 52
    6.2 Communication setup 53
    6.3 Communication port 53
    6.4 Transmission method 54
    6.4.1 HALF-DUPLEX 54
    6.4.2 FULL-DUPLEX 55
  2. Other Functions .... 56
    7.1 E-mail Alerts 56
    7.2 Projector Management using SNMP 58
    7.3 Event Scheduling 59
    7.4 Command Control via the Network 62
    7.5 Crestron RoomView ^® 67
  3. Troubleshooting 68
  4. Specifications 69
  5. Warranty and after-sales service 70

Caution

To use the wireless network function of this projector, the designated USB wireless adapter that is sold as an option is required. For precautions according to the standards and laws, refer to the documents that come with the adapter.

[Restriction on plugging and unplugging the USB wireless adapter]

Before you insert or pull out the USB wireless adapter from the projector, turn off the power of the projector and pull out the power cord's plug from the outlet. Do not touch the USB wireless adapter that is connected to the projector while the projector is receiving AC power.

Do not use any extension cable or device when connecting the adapter to the projector.

[Security precautions when using wireless LAN]

It is recommended that security settings, such as SSID and ENCRYPTION, are specified when using wireless LAN communication. If the security settings are not specified, the contents may be intercepted or it may cause unauthorized access to the system. For details on wireless LAN security settings, refer to 3.1 Projector Web Control or 📄NETWORK menu in the Operating Guide.

⚠️ CAUTION ▶ The optional IEEE802.11b/g/n USB wireless adapter uses the 2.4GHz radio frequency band. You do not need a radio license to use the adapter, but you should be aware of the following:

• DO NOT USE NEAR THE FOLLOWING!

  • Microwave ovens
  • Industrial, scientific or medical devices
  • Designated low power radio stations
  • Premises radio stations

Using the USB wireless adapter near the above may cause radio interference, which would result in a decrease in transmission speed or interruption, and even lead to malfunctioning of devices such as pacemakers.

- Depending on the location where the USB wireless adapter is used, radio wave interference may occur, which may result in a decrease in transmission speed or interruption in communication. In particular, please be aware that using the USB wireless adapter at locations where there is reinforced steel, other types of metals or concrete is likely to cause radio wave interference.

• Available Channels The USB wireless adapter uses the 2.4GHz radio frequency band, but depending on the country or region you are in, the channels that you can use might be limited. Please consult your dealer for information on the usable channels.

- Bringing the optional USB wireless adapter out of the country or region you reside in and using it there could lead to a violation of the radio laws of that country or region.

1. Connection to the network

1.1 System requirements

1.1.1 Required equipment preparation

The following equipments are required to connect the projector to your computer through the network.

■ Common The projector: 1 unit, Computer : minimum 1 set
■ Depending on how you want to connect

1) For the wired connection *1

LAN cable (CAT-5 or greater): 1 piece

2) For the wireless connection *2

- Projector side

IEEE802.11b/g/n USB wireless adapter (option : USB-WL-11N) : 1 unit

- Computer side

IEEE802.11 b/g/n wireless LAN equipment: 1 unit for each *3

*1: The system for using the network function of the projector requires communication environment conforming 100Base-TX or 10Base-T.
*2: An access point is required when the wireless LAN connection is used as Infrastructure mode.
*3: Depending on the type of wireless network device and computer you are using, the projector may not be able to communicate properly with your computer, even if the computer is equipped with a built-in wireless LAN function.

To eliminate communication problems, please use a Wi-Fi certified wireless network device.

1.1.2 Hardware and software requirement for computer

To connect your computer to the projector and use the network function of the projector, your computer needs to meet the following requirements.

√ OS: One of the following.

Windows ^® XP Home Edition /Professional Edition (32 bit version only) Windows Vista ^® Home Basic /Home Premium /Business /Ultimate /Enterprise (32 bit version only)

Windows ^® 7 Starter /Home Basic /Home Premium /Professional /Ultimate /Enterprise (32 bit version only)

√ CPU: Pentium 4 (2.8 GHz or higher)
√ Graphic card: 16 bit, XGA or higher

* When using the "LiveViewer" it is recommended that the display resolution of your computer is set to 1024 x 768.

√ Memory: 512 MB or higher
√ Hard disk space: 100 MB or higher
√ Web browser: Internet Explorer® 6.0 or higher
√ CD-ROM drive

1. Connection to the network

1.1 System requirements (continued)

NOTE • The network communication control is disabled while the projector is in standby mode if the STANDBY MODE item is set to SAVING. Please connect the network communication to the projector after setting the STANDBY MODE to NORMAL. (SETUP menu in the Operating Guide)

- You can get the latest version of the applications for the network functions of the projector and the latest information for this product from the Hitachi website. (http://www.hitachi-america.us/digitalmedia or http://www.hitachidigitalmedia.com).

1.2 Quick connection

The "LiveViewer" supports very quick and simple connection to the network. When making use of the network function, it is recommended that you install the "LiveViewer" on your computer. For details, refer to the manual for "LiveViewer".

In case you don't want to use the "LiveViewer" or you cannot use it by some reason, proceed to the manual setting, the item 1.3 for the wired LAN (7) and the item 1.4 for the wireless LAN. (11)

1.3 Manual network connection setting - Wired LAN -

This section explains how to set it up manually.

1.3.1 Equipments connection

Connect the projector and a computer with a LAN cable.

* Before connecting with an existing network, contact the network administrator.

Next, check the following computer settings.

1.3.2 Network settings

This is the explanation of network connection settings for Windows® 7 and Internet Explorer.

1) Log on to Windows® 7 as administrator authority. Administrator authority is the account, which can access to all functions.
2) Open "Control Panel" from "Start" menu.
3) Open "View network status and tasks" in "Network and Internet". With the icons in the "Control Panel" window displayed, click "Network and Sharing Center".

Adjust your computer's settings System and Security Formes your computer's basic Data on your website Find and the positions. Network and Internet Connected with a key user Create networkless data sharing system. Hardware and sound New devices and users. Add a server. Research on a program Adjust commonly used mobile settings Programs Created a program User Accounts and Family Safety Make up to ensure your account(s) Make up to create a new user's app Appearance and Personalization Change the name Change device background Apply system resources Click, Language, and Business Change superwrants or similar user networks Change Beauty language Use of Access At Windows subject settings Describe visual effects

Adjust your computer's settings Action Currency Organic and Personal City Management Draft Graphics Director and Process Finds Optimization Inspection Options Mouse External Currency Photo and Module Memory Forest System View Accounts Windows Forward Administrative Tools Geometry Course Essential Manager Desktop Design Design Tools Building Options Microsoft and Sharing Currency Information Specification and Settings Power Opticsy Region and Language Search Navigation Search and Start Menu Windows CardSpace Windows Memory Lanes LabPlay Musician Drive Enterprise Data and Time Service Manager Link to Internet Center Setting Server Microsoft CMS Drive the Web Systems and other services Verification Area Book Information & Software Information & Software Programs and Markets Technology and Desktop Communications Sys Cards Webinarizing Windows Defender Internet Update

4) Click "Change adapter settings" in the menu on the left side of the "Network and Sharing Center" window.

Alt-Costal Panel System Network and Sharing Center Custom Panel Network Change networking settings Change enhanced sharing settings View your basic network information and set up connections Alt PC (This computer) Unidentified network Internet Set full ring View your active networks Connect environment Unidentified network Fuzzy network Asset type Connections No Internal access Local free Connections. Change your networking settings Set up a new connection to network Set up a wireless, broadband, dash-up, and how an ITPC connectivity or set as a router or connection point. Connect to a network Connect or recovered to a wireless, wired, disrupt, or ITPC network connection. Change homework and sharing settings Access files and pointers located on other network computers, or change sharing settings. Troubleshooting processes Disgrainer and repair network problems, or get handle/freeing information.

(continued on next page)

1. Connection to the network

1.3 Manual network connection setting - Wired LAN - (continued)

5) Right-click "Local Area Connection" to open the menu, and select "Properties".

Bluetooth Network Connection Local Area Connection Unlured Name Diagnosis Bridge Connections Create Virtual Properties

6) Select "Internet Protocol Version 4 (TCP/IPv4)" and click [Properties].

Local Area Connection Properties Networking Sharing Connect using RoutBank AT1.036/10x Famp Fast Ethernet HC Configure This connection covers the following text: □ Closed for Microsoft Networks □ Soft Packet Scheduler □ File and Printer Sharing for Microsoft Networks □ Server Protection Discovery 5.0.0.0.0.0 □ Server Layer Monitoring Discovery Manager to Driver □ Link Layer Inspection Discovery Responsable Properties Install Cancel Description Transmission Control Protocol/Thermal Protocol: The default-wide IntraNetwork protocol that provides communication across Apache Infrastructure networks OK Cancel

7) Select "Use the following IP address" and configure the IP address, Subnet mask and Default gateway for the computer accordingly. If a DHCP server exists in the network, you can select "Obtain an IP address automatically" and the IP address will be assigned automatically. After setting is complete, click [OK] to close the window.

Internal Protocol network PDSIP-4.0 Performance Standard This can get if the network is optimized if you want to support its capacity. Differences, you need to ask your network resources for the appropriate IP settings. Allow IP address permissions: Use for following IP address: IP address: 192.798.1.19 Send word: 250.274.355.8 Used password: Allow IP address address permission: Use for following IP address address: Preferred IP address: Alternate IP address: Browse settings open user: OK Cancel

(continued on next page)

1.3 Manual network connection setting - Wired LAN - (continued)

[About IP address]

■ Setting manually

The Network address portion of the IP address setting on your computer must be the same as the setting on the projector. Also, the entire IP address on the computer must not overlap with that of the other devices on the same network, including the projector.

For example

The projector's settings are as follows.

IP address: 192.168.1.254

Subnet mask: 255.255.255.0

(Network address: 192.168.1 in this case)

Therefore, specify the computer's IP address as follows.

IP address: 192.168.1.xxx (xxx shows decimal number.)

Subnet mask: 255.255.255.0

(Network address: 192.168.1 in this case)

Select from 1 to 254 for “xxx” not duplicating with any other equipments. In this case, since the IP address of the projector is “192.168.1.254”, specify a setting between 1 to 253 for the computer.

NOTE • “0.0.0.0” cannot be set to the IP address.

  • The projector's IP address can be changed by using the configuration utility via a web browser. (21)
  • If the projector and the computer exist in the same network (i.e., same network address), you can leave the default gateway field blank.
  • When the projector and the computer exist in different networks, the default gateway must be set. Consult to the network administrator in detail.

■ Setting automatically

When a DHCP server exists in the connected network, it is possible to assign an IP address to the projector and computer automatically.

* DHCP is abbreviation for “Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol” and has the function to provide necessary setting for network like IP address from server to client. A server that has DHCP function is called DHCP server.

(continued on next page)

1. Connection to the network

1.3 Manual network connection setting - Wired LAN - (continued)

1.3.3 "Internet Option" setting

1) Click "Internet Options" in "Network and Sharing Center" window to open "Internet Properties" window.

Control Panel Home Manage wireless networks Change wireless network Change advanced networking settings. View your basic network information and set up connections INUC (The computer) Unidentified networks Internet See full map View your active networks Connect to connected Unidentified network Fading network Active type: No Internet access Connections: UP Local Drive Connection Change your networking settings Set up a new connection of network Set up a wireless, broadcast, dial-up, and top, or WiFi connectivity, or set up a router or user port. Connect to a network Connect or required to a wireless, wind, dial-up, or WiFi network connections. Choose homeowners and sharing systems Access True and providers located on other network computers, or change starting settings. Enabling problems: Diagnose and repair network problems, or get breastfeeding information.

2) Click "Connections" tab and then click [LAN settings] button to open "Local Area Network (LAN) Settings".

Internet Options General Security Privacy Control Combinations Combinations To set up to Internet Options, all rights Help Set-up and virtual Privacy settings OK Cancel Help Browse Choose settings if any options to configure a key server first connection. Use the same options: Use immediate or very quick passwords to all providers Use the next key network extension. Show options: Show information (I:C) settings Link Settings do not apply to set-up alternatives. Choose Settings above for doing settings 126 minutes

3) Uncheck all boxes in "Local Area Network (LAN) Settings" window. After setting is complete, click [OK] to close the window.

Local Arm Network CLAME Settings Automatics configuration: Automatics network settings must install (newed settings) to ensure the system of local connections, enable automatic configurations. Automatics direct settings Automatics connected settings System settings System is using a local pin (USB) (Newer settings will not apply to the system or PPS connections). Selected pins: new user to final connections.

1.4 Manual network connection setting - Wireless LAN -

Using the designated USB wireless adapter (option) on the projector enables the projector and computer to communicate in both the Ad-Hoc and Infrastructure modes.

This section is intended to explain how to set up wireless LAN connection manually.

1.4.1 Preparation for wireless LAN connection

HITACHI CPX10WN - Preparation for wireless LAN connection - 1

natural_image Illustration of a laptop connected to a projector (no text or symbols present)

Fig. 1.4.1.a Without an access point communication (Ad-Hoc)

HITACHI CPX10WN - Preparation for wireless LAN connection - 2

natural_image Diagram showing a projector connected to a laptop via wireless signal transmission (no text or symbols)

Fig. 1.4.1.b With an access point communication (Infrastructure)

* Ad-Hoc is one of the wireless LAN communication methods without having access point to communicate.
* Infrastructure is one of the wireless LAN communication methods with having access point to communicate. If certain quantities of equipments are used, this mode is efficient.
If communicating with existing network, consult to your network administrator.

First, insert the USB wireless adapter into the USB TYPE A port.

(Connecting with your devices in the Operating Guide)

Then, set up the computer for wireless communication.

When the computer comes with a built-in IEEE802.11b/g/n wireless LAN device, enable it and disable other network connections. If a wireless LAN device is not built into the computer, connect an IEEE802.11b/g/n wireless LAN device and install the device driver. For details, refer to the user's guide for the computer and wireless LAN device.

1. Connection to the network

1.4 Manual network connection setting - Wireless LAN - (continued)

1.4.2 Wireless LAN connection set up

Using wireless LAN utility for Windows® 7 standard.

Wireless LAN initial settings for the projector is as follows.

Connection Control : Ad-Hoc

SSID : wireless

Channel : 1

Encryption rating : None

IP address : 192.168.10.254

* You can change these settings via a web browser on your computer or from the menu of the projector. Refer to the item 3.1.3 Network Settings (20) or NETWORK menu in the Operating Guide.

1) Select "Change adapter settings" from the menu on the left side of the "Network and Sharing Center" window.

All-Costal Press Change wireless network Change advanced sharing Settings View your basic network information and at up connections ENQ (This computer) Connect to a network Find the security and environment in any networks Change your networking settings Set up a new connection on networks Set up a mining broadcast, that is, and find out VPN connections or set up a router or access point. Connect to a network Connect or connect to a wireless, wind, drain, or VPN network connections. Choose homeowners and sharing patterns Actions these and press located on other networks. Companies, or change sharing settings. Repairments problems Diagnosed and repair network problems, or get loadoverloading information

2) Right-click "Wireless Network Connection" to open the menu, and select "Properties".

Bluetooth Network Connection Not Learning Knowledge Device Personal Area Windows Network Connection Disable Connect/Download Access Diagnosis Bridge Connections Create ShortLine History Reliance Properties

3) Select "Internet Protocol Version 4 (TCP/IPv4)" and click [Properties].

VMware Network Connection Program Networking Options Microsoft Group Microsoft PROSPNwide (MRNA) Network Comparison Configure File Environment: All the following items: ● Cloud for Microsoft Networks ● Web Pocket Server ● Web Pocket Ordering by Microsoft Networks ● Web Pocket Ordering by Microsoft Networks ● Web Pocket Ordering by Microsoft Networks ● Web Pocket Ordering by Microsoft Networks ● Web Pocket Ordering by Microsoft Networks ● Web Pocket Ordering by Microsoft Networks ● Web Pocket Ordering by Microsoft Networks ● Web Pocket Ordering by Microsoft Networks ● Web Pocket Ordering by Microsoft Networks ● Web Pocket Ordering by Microsoft Networks ● Web Pocket Ordering by Microsoft Networks ● Web Pocket Ordering by Microsoft Networks ● Web Pocket Ordering by Microsoft Networks ● Web pocket Ordering by Microsoft Networks ● Web pocket Ordering by Microsoft Networks ● Web pocket Ordering by Microsoft Networks ● Web pocket Ordering by Microsoft Networks ● Web pocket Ordering by Microsoft Networks ● Web pocket Ordering by Microsoft Networks ● Web pocket Ordering by Microsoft Networks ● Web pocket Ordering by Microsoft Networks ● Web pocket Ordering by Microsoft Networks ● Web pocket Ordering by Microsoft Networks ● Web pocket Ordering by Microsoft Networks ● Web pocket Ordering by Microsoft Networks ● Web pocket Ordering by Microsoft Nurses ● Web pocket Ordering by Microsoft Nurses ● Web pocket Ordering by Microsoft Nurses ● Web pocket Ordering by Microsoft Nurses ● Web pocket Ordering by Microsoft Nurses ● Web pocket Ordering by Microsoft Nurses ● Web pocket Ordering by Microsoft Nurses ● Web pocket Ordering by Microsoft Nurses ● Web pocket Ordering by Microsoft Nurses ● Web pocket Ordering by Microsoft Nurses ● Web pocket Ordering by Microsoft Nurses ● Web pocket Ordering by Microsoft Nurses ● Web pocket Ordering by Microsoft Nurses ● Web packet Ordering by Microsoft Nurses ● Web packet Ordering by Microsoft Nurses ● Web packet Ordering by Microsoft Nurses ● Web packet Ordering by Microsoft Nurses ● Web packet Ordering by Microsoft Nurses ● Web packet Ordering by Microsoft Nurses ● Web packet Ordering by Microsoft Nurses ● Web packet Ordering by Microsoft Nurses ● Web packet Ordering by Microsoft Nurses ● Web packet Ordering by Microsoft Nurses ● Web packet Ordering by Microsoft Nurses ● Web packet Ordering by Microsoft Nurses ● Web packet Ordering by Microsoft nurses ● Web packet Ordering by Microsoft nurses ● Web packet Ordering by Microsoft nurses ● Web packet Ordering by Microsoft nurses ● Web packet Ordering by Microsoft nurses ● Web packet Ordering by Microsoft nurses ● Web packet Ordering by Microsoft nurses ● Web packet Ordering by Microsoft nurses ● Web packet Ordering by Microsoft nurses ● Web packet Ordering by Microsoft nurses ● Web packet Ordering by Microsoft nurses ● Web packet Ordering by Microsoft nurses ● Web packet Ordering by Microsoft nurses ● Web path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path orPath or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or Path or path or path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the paths of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path of the path on a specific path on a specific path on a specific path on a specific path on a specific path on a specific path on a specific path on a specific path on a specific path on a specific path on a specific path on a specific path on a specific path on a specific path on a specific path on a specific path on a specific path on a specific path on a specific path on a specific path on a specific path on a specific path on a specific path on a specific path on a specific path on a similar path on a similar path on a similar path on a similar path on a similar path on a similar path on a similar path on a similar path on a similar path on a similar path on a similar path on a similar path on a similar path on a similar path on a similar path on a similar path on a similar path on a similar path on a similar path on a similar path on a similar path on a similar path on a similar path on a similar path on a similar path on a comparable path on a similar path on a similar path on a similar path on a similar path on a similar path on a similar path on a similar path on a similar path on a similar path on a similar path on a similar path on a similar path on a similar path on a similar path on a similar path on a similar path on a similar path on a similar path on a similar path on a similar path on a similar path on a similar path on a similar path on a similar path on a similarly shorter version.

(continued on next page)

1.4 Manual network connection setting - Wireless LAN - (continued)

4) Select "Use the following IP address" and configure the IP address, Subnet mask and Default gateway for the computer accordingly.

After setting is complete, click [OK] to close the window.

Served Protocol: Windows 4.0.1.0.1.0.1.0.1.0 General You can get or download any additional automatically if your network supports file capability. Therefore, you need to ask your network access for the appropriate IP settings. Use the following IP address: IP address: 100, 100, 57, 96 Serial fields: 200, 200, 200, 96 Other points: 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, Select PDF server address directly: Select PDF server address: Prepared PDF server: Alternate PDF server: Update settings open out: Advanced... OK Cancel

[About IP address]

The Network address portion of the IP address setting on your computer must be the same as the setting on the projector. Also, the entire IP address on the computer must not overlap with that of the other devices on the same network, including the projector.

For example

The projector's settings are as follows.

IP address: 192.168.10.254

Subnet mask: 255.255.255.0

(Network address: 192.168.10 in this case)

Therefore, specify the computer's IP address as follows.

IP address: 192.168.10.xxx (xxx shows decimal number.)

Subnet mask: 255.255.255.0

(Network address: 192.168.10 in this case)

Select from 1 to 254 for "xxx" not duplicating with any other equipments.

In this case, since the IP address of the projector is “192.168.10.254”, specify a setting between 1 to 253 for the computer.

NOTE • "0.0.0.0" cannot be set to the IP address.

  • The projector's IP address can be changed by using the configuration utility via a web browser. (20)
  • If the projector and the computer exist in the same network (i.e., same network address), you can leave the default gateway field blank.
  • When the projector and the computer exist in different networks, the default gateway must be set.

1. Connection to the network

1.4 Manual network connection setting - Wireless LAN - (continued)

5) Right-click "Wireless Network Connection" to open the menu, and select "Connect / Disconnect".

Connect/Disconnect Connect/Disconnect Bridge Connection Create Virtual Resource Properties

6) From the connectable wireless networks, select the SSID of the projector (set to "wireless" by default), and click [Connect]. If you have enabled encryption, a window asking for input of the encryption key will be displayed. Input the preset key.

7) After connection is established, "Connected" will appear to the right of SSID.

Not connected Connections are available Microsoft Network Connection FID: (014) version: (0) WAL: (215) WAL: (6) Show options next user file options might be able to others. Save... Save between and Sharing Lines

Currently connected to: Unidentified network No network access Wireless Network Connected Connection R10-0038 connection (Y) MIRK2001445 M90.2010 M8.123 Connected FlyUp Network and Sharing Center

2. Network Presentation

The projector can display or play back the computer screen images and audio data that are transmitted through the network. This Network Presentation feature helps you to smoothly make your presentations and conduct conferences.

HITACHI CPX10WN - Network Presentation - 1

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Laptop with video camera"] --> B["Wireless LAN"]
    C["Laptop with laptop"] --> B
    D["Laptop with fruit images"] --> E["Wired LAN"]
    F["Laptop with laptop"] --> E
    G["Fluores with fruits"] --> H["Wired LAN"]
    I["Fluores with fruit"] --> H
    B --> J["Central device"]

To use Network Presentation, an exclusive application, "LiveViewer" is required. It can be installed from the bundled application CD. You can also download the latest version and relevant information from the Hitachi website (http://www.hitachi-america.us/digitalmedia or http://www.hitachidigitalmedia.com). For details of Network Presentation and instructions to install the "LiveViewer", refer to the manual for "LiveViewer".

To start the Network Presentation, select the LAN port as the input source on the projector and click the Starting Capture button on the "LiveViewer".

3. Web Control

You can adjust or control the projector via a network from a web browser on a computer that is connected to the same network.

NOTE • Internet Explorer® 6.0 or later is required.

  • If JavaScript ^ is disabled in your web browser configuration, you must enable JavaScript ^ in order to use the projector web pages properly. See the Help files for your web browser for details on how to enable JavaScript ^ .
  • It is recommended that all web browser updates are installed.
  • If data is transferred via wireless and wired LAN at the same time, the projector may not be able to process the data correctly.

Refer to the following for configuring or controlling the projector via a web browser. Make sure that your computer and the projector is connected via network, and then start Web browser.

Enter the projector's IP address into URL input box of the Web browser as the example below, and then press the Enter key or → button.

Example: If the IP address of the projector is set to 192.168.1.10:

Enter "http://192.168.1.10/" into the address bar of the web browser and press the Enter key or click → button.

If a correct URL is input, and the projector and your computer are connected to the same network correctly, the selection window as shown on the right will be displayed.

You can choose to use Projector Web Control or Crestron e-Control® as a tool for controlling the projector. Click one of them.

For more details, refer to 3.1 Projector Web Control (17) or 3.2 Crestron e-Control® (42).

Projector Web Control Chestron e-Control

NOTE • If Crestron e-Control in the Network Settings (21) is set to Disable, the selection window above does not appear, but the Logon window of the Projector Web Control is displayed.

- Crestron e-Control® is created using Flash®. You need to install Adobe® Flash® Player on your computer to use Crestron e-Control®.

3.1 Projector Web Control

3.1.1 Logon

To use the Projector Web Control function, you need to logon with your user name and password.

Below are the factory default settings for user name and password.

Windows Security The server 191168.1.10 at Web Server Authentication requires a username and password. Warning: This server is requesting that your username and password be sent in an insecure manner (basic authentication without a secure connection). User name Password Remember my credentials OK Cancel

Logon window

User name Password
Administrator

Enter your user name and password, and then click the [OK]. If you logon successfully, the screen below will be displayed.

Main menu Top:Network Information Common Information Projector Name: PCL_001562130FIC Wireless Information Mode: infrastructure HLLP: ON IP Address: 192.168.16.10 Subword Mask: 755.255.255.0 Default Gateway: 193.168.16.1 DNS Server Address: 192.168.16.100 MAC Address: ACR1120728.99 Ch: / Energynet: WPA-PSK(ALS)2 VDD: wireless Sound: 34M Wired Information GCP: ON IP Address: 192.168.16.10 Subword Mask: 755.255.255.0 Default Gateway: 192.168.16.1

Click the desired operation or configuration item on the main menu.

NOTE • The language used on the Projector Web Control screen is the same as that of the OSD on the projector. If you want to change it, you need to change the OSD language on the projector. (SCREEN menu in the Operating Guide)

3.1 Projector Web Control (continued)

3.1.2 Network Information

Top Network Information Common Information Projected Name: PRI_0019.7.2.2007C Wireless Information Mesh: Retrastructural SNP 73: ON IP Address: 192.368.10.10 Subnet Mesh: 255.255.255.0 Default Subnetry: 192.368.10.1 DNS Server Address: 192.368.10.100 MAC Address: AC011.257304F CS: 1 Exceptionals: M09A-PMR(45%)2 NOS: address NOS: 5444 Wired Information SNP 73: ON IP Address: 192.368.1.10 Subnet Mesh: 255.368.255.0 Default Subnetry: 192.368.1.1

Displays the projector's current network configuration settings.

Item Description
Common InformationDisplays information common to both wireless and wired LAN.
Projector Name Displays the projector name settings.
Wireless Information Displays the current settings of wireless LAN.
Mode Displays the mode of wireless LAN communication.
DHCP Displays the DHCP setting.
IP Address Displays the IP address.
Subnet Mask Displays the subnet mask.
Default Gateway Displays the default gateway.
DNS Server Address Displays the DNS server address.
MAC Address Displays the MAC address.
Ch Displays the channel used for wireless LAN.
Encryption Displays the data encryption setting.
SSID Displays the SSID used by the projector.
SpeedDisplays the current wireless LAN transmission speed.
Wired InformationDisplays the current wired LAN settings.
DHCP Displays the DHCP setting.
IP Address Displays the IP address.
Subnet Mask Displays the subnet mask.
Default Gateway Displays the default gateway.
DNS Server Address Displays the DNS server address.
MAC Address Displays the MAC address.

3.1 Projector Web Control (continued)

3.1.3 Network Settings

Network Settings / Common Setup Project Name: m2_sport1.com application (SDBP) application (SDBP) AMRD. SL. To apply changes to network settings: click Apply, then perform 'Network Restart'.

Displays and configures network settings.

Item Description
Common SetupDisplays information common to both wireless and wired LAN.
Projector NameConfigures the name of the projector.The length of the Projector Name can be up to 64 alphanumeric characters. Only alphabets, numbers and following symbols can be used.!#$%&'()*+,-./:;<=>?@[^\]^_`{}~ and space.Particular projector name is pre-assigned by default.
sysLocation (SNMP)Configures the location to be referred to when using SNMP.The length of the sysLocation can be up to 255 alphanumeric characters. Only numbers ‘0-9’ and alphabet ‘a-z’, ‘A-Z’ can be used.
sysContact (SNMP)Configures the contact information to be referred to when using SNMP.The length of the sysContact can be up to 255 alphanumeric characters. Only numbers ‘0-9’ and alphabet ‘a-z’, ‘A-Z’ can be used.
AMX D.D.(AMX Device Discovery)Configures the AMX Device Discovery setting to detect the projector from the controllers of AMX connected to the same network. For the details of AMX Device Discovery, visit the AMX web site.URL: http://www.amx.com (as of Dec. 2010)

(continued on next page)

3.1 Projector Web Control - Network Settings (continued)

Item Description
Wireless SetupConfigures the wireless LAN settings.
Mode Select"AD-HOC" or "Infrastructure".
IP ConfigurationConfigures network settings.
DHCP ON EnablesDHCP.
DHCP OFF Disables DHCP.
IP AddressConfigures the IP address when DHCP is disabled.
Subnet MaskConfigures the subnet mask when DHCP is disabled.
Default GatewayConfigures the default gateway when DHCP is disabled.
DNS Server AddressConfigures the DNS server address.
ChSelect from "1" to "11" a channel to use in the AD-HOC mode.
NOTE · Depending on the country where you are the channels may vary. In addition, depending on the country or region where you are may be required to use a wireless network card that confirm to the standards in the respective country or region.
Encryption Select dataencryption method.
WEP KeyInput the WEP key. Either ASCII characters or hexadecimal numbers can be used during WEP key input. However, you cannot use a combination of both. The length of the key is defined as follows according to the WEP and character formats.
Encryption AS CII characters HEX numbers
WEP 64bit 5 characters 10 characters
WEP 128bit 13 characters 26 characters
WPA PassphraseInput WPA Passphrase. Available number of input characters is 8 to 63. Only alphabets, numbers and following symbols can be used.!"#%&'()*+,-./;;<=>?@[\]^_~ and space
SSIDSelect an SSID from the list. If you require to set your unique SSID, select [Custom], then set your own SSID following the rules below. Maximum number of input characters is 32. Only alphabets, numbers and following symbols can be used.!"#%&'()*+,-./;;<=>?@[\]^_{}~ and space.

(continued on next page)

3.1 Projector Web Control - Network Settings (continued)

Item Description
Wired SetupConfigures the wired LAN settings.
IP ConfigurationConfigures network settings.
DHCP ON EnablesDHCP.
DHCP OFF DisablesDHCP.
IP AddressConfigures the IP address when DHCP is disabled.
Subnet MaskConfigures the subnet mask when DHCP is disabled.
Default GatewayConfigures the default gateway when DHCP is disabled.
DNS Server AddressConfigures the DNS server address.
Other SetupConfigures other network settings.
Crestron e-ControlSet whether to or not to use Crestron e-Control®.If you choose Disable, the Logon window of Projector Web Control and not the selection window will be displayed at first of the Web Control.

Click the [Apply] button to save the settings.

NOTE • The new configuration settings are activated after restarting the network connection. When the configuration settings are changed, you must restart the network connection. You can restart the network connection by clicking [Network Restart] on the main menu (41).

  • If you connect the projector to an existing network, consult a network administrator before setting server addresses.
  • The WEP Key, WPA passphrase and SSID settings will not be set if the invalid characters are used.
  • The projector does not allow both wireless and wired LAN to be connected to the same network. Do not set the same network address for both wireless and wired LAN.

3.1 Projector Web Control (continued)

3.1.4 Port Settings

Port Settings Network Control Port1 (Port:23) Portagent Enable Authentication Enable Network Control Port2 (Port:9715) Portagent Enable Authentication Enable PJLink Port (Port:4352) Portagent Enable Authentication Enable My Image Port (Port:9716) Portagent Enable Authentication Enable Messenger Port (Port:9718) Portagent Enable Authentication Enable

Displays and configures communication port settings.

Item Description
Network Control Port1 (Port:23)Configures command control port 1 (Port:23).
Port open Click the [Enable] check box to use port 23.
AuthenticationClick the [Enable] check box when authentication is required for this port.
Network Control Port2 (Port:9715)Configures command control port 2 (Port:9715).
Port open Click the [Enable] check box to use port 9715.
AuthenticationClick the [Enable] check box when authentication is required for this port.
PJLinkTM Port (Port:4352)Configures the PJLinkTM port (Port:4352).
Port open Click the [Enable] check box to use port 4352.
AuthenticationClick the [Enable] check box when authentication is required for this port.
My Image Port (Port:9716)Configures the My Image Port (Port:9716).
Port open Click the [Enable] check box to use port 9716.
AuthenticationClick the [Enable] check box when authentication is required for this port.
Messenger Port (Port:9719)Configures the Messenger Port (Port:9719).
Port open Click the [Enable] check box to use port 9719.
AuthenticationClick the [Enable] check box when authentication is required for this port.

(continued on next page)

3.1 Projector Web Control - Port Settings (continued)

Item Description
SNMP Port Configures theSNMP port.
Port open Click the [Enable] check box to use SNMP.
Trap addressConfigures the destination of the SNMP Trap in IP format.• The address allows not only IP address but also domain name if the valid DNS server is setup in the Network Settings. The maximum length of host or domain name is up to 255 characters.
Download MIB fileDownloads a MIB file from the projector.
Network Bridge PortConfigures the Bridge port number.
Port NumberInput the port number.Except for 41794, 9715, 9716, 9719, 9720, 5900, 5500, 4352 between 1024 and 65535 can be set up. It is set to 9717 as the default setting.

Click the [Apply] button to save the settings.

NOTE • The new configuration settings are activated after restarting the network connection. When the configuration settings are changed, you must restart the network connection. You can restart the network connection by clicking the [Network Restart] on the main menu(41).

3.1 Projector Web Control (continued)

3.1.5 Mail Settings

Mail Settings Mail Mail SMSF Service Address Fax-4-0 Fax 276.198.1.2m Send Mail Address Fax - 43 Fax - 43 Fax - 43 Fax - 43 Fax - 43 Send Mail Mail Send Mail Send Mail Send Mail Send Mail Send Mail Send Mail Send Mail Send Mail Send Mail Send Mail Send Mail Send Mail Send Mail Send Mail Send Mail Send Mail Send Mail Send Mail Send Mail Send Mail Send Mail Send Mail Send Mail Send Mail Send Mail Send Mail Send Mail Send Mail Send Mail Send Mail Send Mail Send Mail Send Mail SendMail

Displays and configures e-mail addressing settings.

Item Description
Send MailClick the [Enable] check box to use the e-mail function.Configure the conditions for sending e-mail under the Alert Settings.
SMTP Server AddressConfigures the address of the mail server in IP format.• The address allows not only IP address but also domain name if the valid DNS server is setup in the Network Settings. The maximum length of host or domain name is up to 255 characters.
Sender E-mail addressConfigures the sender e-mail address.The length of the sender e-mail address can be up to 255 alphanumeric characters.
Recipient E-mail addressConfigures the e-mail address of up to five recipients. You can also specify the [TO] or [CC] for each address. The length of the recipient e-mail address can be up to 255 alphanumeric characters.

Click the [Apply] button to save the settings.

NOTE • You can confirm whether the mail settings work correctly using the [Send Test Mail] button. Please enable Send mail setting before clicking the [Send Test Mail].

- If you connect the projector to an existing network, consult a network administrator before setting server addresses.

3.1 Projector Web Control (continued)

3.1.6 Alert Settings

Alert Settings / Cover Error SNMP Error Mail Text SNMP Error Mail Text Mail Text Mail Text Mail Text Mail Text Mail Text Mail Text Mail Text Mail Text Mail Text Mail Text Mail Text Mail Text Mail Text Mail Text Mail Text Mail Text Mail Text Mail Text Mail Text Mail Text Mail Text Mail Text Mail Text Mail Text Mail Text Mail Text Mail Text Mail Text Mail Text Mail Text Mail Text Mail Text Mail Text

Displays and configures failure & alert settings.

Item Description
Cover ErrorThe lamp cover has not been properly fixed.
Fan Error The cooling fan is not operating.
Lamp ErrorThe lamp does not light, and there is a possibility that interior portion has become heated.
Temp ErrorThere is a possibility that the interior portion has become heated.
Air Flow Error The internal temperature is rising.
Cold ErrorThere is a possibility that the interior portion has become overcooled.
Filter Error Filter time over.
Other ErrorOther error.If displaying this error, please contact your dealer.
Schedule Execution ErrorSchedule Execution error. (27)
Lamp Time Alarm Lamp time over Alarm Time setting.
Filter Time Alarm Filter time over Alarm Time setting.
Transition Detector AlarmTransition Detector Alarm. (SECURITY menu in the Operating Guide)
Cold StartWhen the projector is supplied with the power, it works as below.If the STANDBY MODE is set to the NORMAL:the projector's power status changes from "OFF" to "Standby state".If the STANDBY MODE is set to the SAVING:the projector's power status changes from "Standby state" to "ON (lamp is turned on)". (SETUP menu in the Operating Guide)
Authentication FailureThe SNMP access is detected from the invalid SNMP community.

Refer to Troubleshooting in the Operating Guide for further detailed explanation of Error except Other Error and Schedule Execution Error.

3.1 Projector Web Control - Alert Settings (continued)

The Alert Items are shown below.

Item Description
Alarm TimeConfigures the time to alert.(Only Lamp Time Alarm and Filter Time Alarm.)
SNMP TrapClick the [Enable] check box to enable SNMP Trap alerts.
Send MailClick the [Enable] check box to enable e-mail alerts.(Except Cold Start and Authentication Failure.)
Mail SubjectConfigures the subject line of the e-mail to be sent.The length of the subject line can be up to 100 alphanumeric characters.(Except Cold Start and Authentication Failure.)
Mail TextConfigures the text of the e-mail to be sent.The length of the text can be up to 1024 alphanumeric characters, but if you are using some of special characters below the length may be shorter.Special characters " ' : & , % \ and space(Except Cold Start and Authentication Failure.)

Click the [Apply] button to save the settings.

NOTE • The trigger of Filter Error e-mail is depending on the FILTER MESSAGE setting in the SERVICE item of the OPTION menu which defines the period until the filter message is displayed on the projector screen. An e-mail will be sent when the usage time of the filter exceeds the time limit that is set. No notification e-mail will be sent if the FILTER MESSAGE is set to TURN OFF. (OPTION menu in the Operating Guide)

  • Lamp Time Alarm is defined as a threshold for e-mail notification (reminder) of the lamp time. When the lamp hour exceeds this threshold that is configured through the Web page, the e-mail will be sent out.
  • Filter Time Alarm is defined as a threshold for e-mail notification (reminder) of the filter time. When the filter hour exceeds this threshold that is configured in the Web page, the e-mail will be sent out.

3.1 Projector Web Control (continued)

3.1.7 Schedule Settings

Schedule Settings / Daily Schedule Settings Address User Command [Information] Access Power (IUI) 12.00 Power (IUI) Load P 2.00 p.g.70.00 Input Source: Command Data My Image: Command Data Message: Command Data Substrate: Command Data Date: Command [Parameters] Address Logit Network Settings Port Settings Mail Settings Abort Settings Schedule Settings Daily Sunday Monday Tuesday Wednesday Thursday Friday Saturday Specific data No.1 Specific data No.2 Specific data No.3 Specific data No.4 Specific data No.5 Daily/Time Settings Security Settings

Displays and configures schedule settings.

Item Description
DailyConfigures the daily schedule.
SundayConfigures the Sunday schedule.
MondayConfigures the Monday schedule.
TuesdayConfigures the Tuesday schedule.
WednesdayConfigures the Wednesday schedule.
ThursdayConfigures the Thursday schedule.
FridayConfigures the Friday schedule.
SaturdayConfigures the Saturday schedule.
Specific date No.1Configures the specific date (No.1) schedule.
Specific date No.2Configures the specific date (No.2) schedule.
Specific date No.3Configures the specific date (No.3) schedule.
Specific date No.4Configures the specific date (No.4) schedule.
Specific date No.5Configures the specific date (No.5) schedule.

3.1 Projector Web Control - Schedule Settings (continued)

The schedule settings are shown below.

Item Description
Schedule Click the [Enable]check box to enable the schedule.
Date (Month/Day)Configures the month and date.This item appears only when Specific date (No. 1-5) is selected.

Click the [Apply] button to save the settings.

The current event settings are displayed on the schedule list. To add additional functions and events, set the following items.

Item Description
TimeConfigures the time to execute commands.
Command[Parameter]Configures the commands to be executed.
PowerConfigures the parameters for power control.
Input SourceConfigures the parameters for input switching.
My ImageConfigures the parameters for My Image data display. (50)
MessengerConfigures the parameters for Messenger data display. (51)
SlideshowConfigures the Start/Stop parameters for the Slideshow.

Click the [Register] button to add new commands to the schedule list.

Click the [Delete] button to delete commands from the schedule list.

Click the [Reset] button to delete all commands and reset the schedule settings from the schedule list.

3.1 Projector Web Control - Schedule Settings (continued)

NOTE • After the projector is moved, check the date and time set for the projector before configuring the schedules.
- The internal clock's time may not remain accurate. Using SNTP is recommended to maintain accurate time.
- Events “My Image” and “Messenger” will not be executed appropriately but result in “schedule execution error” status in case lamp does not light or/and display data are not stored in the projector at the scheduled event execution time.
- Events “Input Source” and “My Image” will not be executed if security feature is enabled and the projector is locked due to the feature.
- Certain error state in the projector (such as temperature error, lamp error) will prevent the projector from appropriate execution of scheduled functions/events.
- If no USB memory device is inserted to the projector or no image data for display exists at the scheduled event time, a schedule execution error occurs against the scheduled Slideshow event.
- When you start the Slideshow, input source will be automatically switched to the USB TYPE A port.
- Image files stored in the root directory of the USB memory device will be displayed for the scheduled Slideshow.
- Please refer to Troubleshooting in the Operating Guide in case scheduled functions/events are not executed appropriately as you've set.

3.1 Projector Web Control (continued)

3.1.8 Date/Time Settings

Date / Time Settings Tape Network Information Network Settings Port Settings Mail Settings Alert Settings Schulphur Settings Data / Time Settings Security Settings Projector Control Inspector Control Projector Notes Network Linker Control Time Start End GMT MUST MEXP Security Address 1.4.0.0 2.0.0.0 3.0.0.0 To apply changes to determine settings, click reply, then perform Network Request.

Displays and configures the date and time settings.

Item Description
Current DateConfigures the current date in year/month/day format.
Current TimeConfigures the current time in hour:minute:second format.
Daylight Savings TimeClick the [ON] check box to enable daylight savings time and set the following items.
StartConfigures the date and time daylight savings time begins.
Month
Week
Day
Time
hour
minute
EndConfigures the day of the week daylight savings time begins (Sun, Mon, Tue, Wed, Thu, Fri, Sat).
Time
hour
minute

(continued on next page)

3.1 Projector Web Control - Date/Time Settings (continued)

Item Description
Time differenceConfigures the time difference. Set the same time difference as the one set on your computer. If unsure, consult your IT manager.
SNTPClick the [ON] check box to retrieve Date and Time information from the SNTP server and set the following items.
SNTP Server Address
Cycle

Click the [Apply] button to save the settings.

NOTE • The new configuration settings are activated after restarting the network connection. When the configuration settings are changed, you must restart the network connection. You can restart the network connection by clicking the [Network Restart] on the main menu(41).

  • If you connect the projector to an existing network, consult a network administrator before setting server addresses.
  • Once you turn off the projector in the SAVING mode (SETUP menu in the Operating Guide) or the AC power, the current date and time setting is reset.
  • To enable the SNTP function, the time difference must be set.
  • The projector will retrieve Date and Time information from the time server and override time settings when SNTP is enabled.
  • The internal clock's time may not remain accurate. Using SNTP is recommended to maintain accurate time.

3.1 Projector Web Control (continued)

3.1.9 Security Settings

Security Settings / User Account User account Password No other Password To apply changes to security settings: click Apply, then perform "between Restart."

Displays and configures passwords and other security settings.

Item Description
User AccountConfigures the user name and password.
User name
Password
Re-enter Password
Network ControlConfigures the Authentication password for Network Control Port1 (Port: 23), Network Control Port2 (Port: 9715), PJLinkTM Port (Port: 4352), My Image Port (Port: 9716), and Messenger Port (Port: 9719) (22, 23).
Authentication Password
Re-enter Authentication Password
SNMPConfigures the community name if SNMP is used.
Community name

Click the [Apply] button to save the settings.

NOTE • The new configuration settings are activated after restarting the network connection. When the configuration settings are changed, you must restart the network connection. You can restart the network connection by clicking the [Network Restart] on the main menu(41).

- Only numbers '0-9' and alphabet 'a-z', 'A-Z' can be used.

3.1 Projector Web Control (continued)

3.1.10 Projector Control

Projector Control / MAIN Projector Control / MAIN NUMBER INPUT SCHEDULE DETAIL MODE FRAME COLOR WRITE CREATE MAGROW MAGROW POSITION MAGROW POSITION TAMILATE MF IMAGE MF IMAGE SELECT Value: 0 Value: 0 Value: 0 Value: 0 Value: 0 Value: 0 Value: 0 Value: 0 Value: 0 Value: 0 Value: 0 Value: 0 Value: 0 Value: 0 Value: 0 Value: 0 Value: 0 Value: 0 Value: 0 Value: 0 Value: 1.0 Value: 1.0 Value: 1.0 Value: 1.0 Value: 1.0 Value: 1.0 Value: 1.0 Value: 1.0 Value: 1.0 Value: 1.0 Value: 1.0 Value: 1.0 Value: 1.0 Value: 1.0 Value: 1.0

The items shown in the table below can be performed using the Projector Control menu.

Select an item with the mouse.

Most of the items have a submenu. Refer to the table below for details.

Controls the projector.

NOTE • The setting value may not match with the actual value if the user changes the value manually. In that case, please refresh the page by clicking the [Refresh] button.

Item Description
MAIN
POWER Turns the power on/off.
INPUT SOURCE Selects the input source.
PICTURE MODE Selects the picture mode setting.
BLANK ON/OFF Turns Blank on/off.
MUTE Turns Mute on/off.
FREEZE Turns Freeze on/off.
MAGNIFYControls the magnify setting.In some input signal sources, it might stop “Magnify” even though it does not reach to maximum setting value.
MAGNIFY POSITION VAdjusts the vertical magnify position.
MAGNIFY POSITION HAdjusts the horizontal magnify position.
TEMPLATE Turns template on/off.
MY IMAGE Selects MY IMAGE data.
MY IMAGE DELETE Deletes MY IMAGE data.

(continued on next page)

3.1 Projector Web Control - Projector Control (continued)

Item Description
PICTURE
BRIGHTNESS Adjusts the brightness setting.
CONTRAST Adjusts the contrast setting.
GAMMA Selects the gamma setting.
COLOR TEMP Selects the color temperature setting.
COLOR Adjusts the color setting.
TINT Adjusts the tint setting.
SHARPNESS Adjusts the sharpness setting.
MYMEMORY SAVE Saves the MyMemory data.
MYMEMORY RECALL Recalls the MyMemory data.
IMAGE
ASPECT Selects the aspect setting.
OVER SCAN Adjusts the over scan setting.
V POSITION Adjusts the vertical position.
H POSITION Adjusts the horizontal position.
H PHASEAdjusts the horizontal phase.
H SIZEAdjusts the horizontal size.
AUTO ADJUST EXECUTEPerforms the automatic adjustment.
INPUT
PROGRESSIVESelects the progressive setting.
VIDEO NRSelects the video noise reduction setting.
COLOR SPACESelects the color space.
VIDEO FORMAT - S-VIDEOSelects the s-video format setting.
VIDEO FORMAT - VIDEOSelects the video format setting.
HDMI FORMATSelects the HDMI^TM format setting.
HDMI RANGESelects the HDMI^TM range setting.
COMPUTER IN - COMPUTER IN1Selects the COMPUTER IN1 input signal type.
COMPUTER IN - COMPUTER IN2Selects the COMPUTER IN2 input signal type.
FRAME LOCK - COMPUTER IN1Turns the FRAME LOCK-COMPUTER IN1 function on/off.
FRAME LOCK - COMPUTER IN2Turns the FRAME LOCK-COMPUTER IN2 function on/off.
FRAME LOCK - HDMITurns the FRAME LOCK-HDMI function on/off.
Item Description
SETUP
AUTO KEYSTONE EXECUTEPerforms the automatic keystone distortion setting.
KEYSTONE V Adjusts the vertical keystone distortion setting.
AUTO ECO MODE Turns on/off the automatic eco mode function.
ECO MODE Selects the eco mode.
INSTALLATION Selects the installation status.
STANDBY MODE Selects the standby mode.
MONITOR OUT - COMPUTER IN1Assigns the MONITOR OUT when the COMPUTER IN1 input port is selected.
MONITOR OUT - COMPUTER IN2Assigns the MONITOR OUT when the COMPUTER IN2 input port is selected.
MONITOR OUT - LANAssigns the MONITOR OUT when the LAN input port is selected.
MONITOR OUT - USB TYPE AAssigns the MONITOR OUT when the USB TYPE A input port is selected.
MONITOR OUT - USB TYPE BAssigns the MONITOR OUT when the USB TYPE B input port is selected.
MONITOR OUT - HDMIAssigns the MONITOR OUT when the HDMI input port is selected.
MONITOR OUT - S-VIDEOAssigns the MONITOR OUT when the S-VIDEO input port is selected.
MONITOR OUT - VIDEOAssigns the MONITOR OUT when the VIDEO input port is selected.
MONITOR OUT - STANDBYAssigns the MONITOR OUT in the standby mode.
Item Description
AUDIO
VOLUME Adjusts the volume setting.
SPEAKER Turns the built-in speaker on/off.
AUDIO SOURCE - COMPUTER IN1 Assigns the AUDIO SOURCE - COMPUTER IN1 input port.
AUDIO SOURCE - COMPUTER IN2 Assigns the AUDIO SOURCE - COMPUTER IN2 input port.
AUDIO SOURCE - LAN Assigns the AUDIO SOURCE - LAN input port.
AUDIO SOURCE - USB TYPE A Assigns the AUDIO SOURCE - USB TYPE A input port.
AUDIO SOURCE - USB TYPE B Assigns the AUDIO SOURCE - USB TYPE B input port.
AUDIO SOURCE - HDMI Assigns the AUDIO SOURCE - HDMI input port.
AUDIO SOURCE - S-VIDEO Assigns the AUDIO SOURCE - S-VIDEO input port.
AUDIO SOURCE - VIDEO Assigns the AUDIO SOURCE - VIDEO input port.
AUDIO SOURCE - AUDIO OUT STANDBY Assigns the AUDIO SOURCE in the standby mode.
HDMI AUDIO Selects the HDMI TM audio setting.
SCREEN
LANGUAGE Selects the language for the OSD.
MENU POSITION V Adjusts the vertical Menu position.
MENU POSITION H Adjusts the horizontal Menu position.
BLANK Selects the Blank mode.
START UP Selects the start up screen mode.
MyScreen Lock Turns MyScreen lock function on/off.
MESSAGE Turns the message function on/off.
TEMPLATE Selects the template setting.
C.C. - DISPLAY Selects Closed Caption DISPLAY setting.
C.C. - MODE Selects Closed Caption MODE setting.
C.C. - CHANNEL Selects Closed Caption CHANNEL setting.

(continued on next page)

3.1 Projector Web Control - Projector Control (continued)

Item Description
OPTION
AUTO SEARCH Turns the automatic signal search function on/off.
AUTO KEYSTONETurns the automatic keystone distortion correction function on/off.
DIRECT POWER ONTurns the direct power on function on/off.
AUTO POWER OFFConfigures the timer to shut off the projector when no signal is detected.
USB TYPE B Selects the USB TYPE B setting.
MY BUTTON-1Assigns the functions for the MY BUTTON-1 button on the included remote control.
MY BUTTON-2Assigns the functions for the MY BUTTON-2 button on the included remote control.
ECO(CONTROL PANEL)Assigns the same operation as the ECO button on the control panel.
MY SOURCE Selects the My Source setting.

(continued on next page)

3. Web Control

3.1 Projector Web Control - Projector Control (continued)

Projector Control / SERVICE Projector Control / Service Confirm! Click the instructions to control Projector Mode. Start Projector Mode.

The items shown in the table below can be performed using the Projector Control menu. Click the [Quit Presenter Mode].

Item Description
SERVICE
Quit Presenter ModeQuit compulsorily from the Presenter mode.

3.1 Projector Web Control (continued)

3.1.11 Remote Control

Remote Control Tops: Network Information Network Settings Port Settings Mail Settings Alert Settings Schedule Settings Name/Name Settings Security Settings Projector Control Remote Control Projector Status Network System control COMPUTER HOME CLASS PROJECT NEXT NEXT input off Input Group INFORMATION

You can use your Web browser to control the projector. The functions on the bundled remote control are assigned to the Web Remote Control screen.

- Do not attempt to control the projector with the projector's remote control and via your Web browser at the same time. It may cause some operational errors in the projector.

Item Description
POWERAssigned the same operation as STANDBY/ON button.
COMPUTER Assigned the same operation as COMPUTER button.
VIDEO Assigned the same operation as VIDEO button.
BLANK Assigned the same operation as BLANK button.
FREEZE Assigned the same operation as FREEZE button.
MUTE Assigned the same operation as MUTE button.
MENU Assigned the same operation as MENU button.
▲ Assigned the same operation as ▲ button.
▼ Assigned the same operation as ▼ button.
◀ Assigned the same operation as ◀ button.
▶ Assigned the same operation as ▶ button.
ENTER Assigned the same operation as ENTER button.
RESET Assigned the same operation as RESET button.
PAGE UP Assigned the same operation as PAGE UP button.
PAGE DOWNAssigned the same operation as PAGE DOWN button.
SLIDESHOWStarts the Slideshow.

NOTE • The Web Remote Control does not support repeat function that performs an action while holding a button clicked down.

  • Since the repeat function is not available, click the button repeatedly as many times as you require.
  • Even if you hold the button clicked down for a while, the Web Remote Control sends your request command one time only. Release the button, then click it again.
  • When the [POWER] button is pushed, a message window comes up to confirm the operation. To control the power, push [OK], otherwise push [Cancel].
  • The [PAGE DOWN] and [PAGE UP] buttons on the Web Remote Control cannot be used as mouse emulation function of the projector.

3. Web Control

3.1 Projector Web Control (continued)

3.1.12 Projector Status

Projector Status - Projector Status Topic Network Information Network Settings Port Settings Mail Settings Alert Settings Sensible Settings State/State Settings Security Settings Projector Control Remote Control Evalancer Status Network Event Projector Status NORMAL Low Time 30 h Filter Time 10 h Power Station 4M State Status COMPOSITE ON Work Date/UST 03:07 Main 07Y Freehold NORMAL Network

Displays the settings and status of the projector.

Item Description
Error Status Displays the current error status
Lamp Time Displays the usage time for the current lamp.
Filter TimeDisplays the usage time for the current filter.
Power Status Displays the current power status.
Input Status Displays the current input signal source.
Blank On/Off Displays the current Blank on/off status.
Mute Displays the current Mute on/off status.
Freeze Displays the current Freeze status.

3.1 Projector Web Control (continued)

3.1.13 Network Restart

Project Data - Project Data Continue Tops: Network Information Network Settings Port Settings Real Settings Abort Settings Sub-bable Settings State/State Settings Security Settings Projector Control Remote Control Projector Status Network Subset! Network Restart Confirm! Restarting request via us log it or order to further control as config the projector is a web license. (Amounts)

Restarts the projector's network connection.

Item Description
RestartRestarts the projector's network connection in order to activate new configuration settings.

NOTE • Restarting requires you to re-log on in order to further control or configure the projector via a web browser. Wait 30 seconds or more after clicking the [Restart] button to log on again.

3.2 Crestron e-Control®

HITACHI Power Vol - Mate Vol + Sources List Computer in 1 Computer in 2 LAN USB Type A USB Type B Menu Enter Reset Freeze Contrast Brightness Color Tab CRESTRON Expansion Options

The Main window as shown above is displayed at first. However, if you have enabled User Password on the Tools window (46), a dialog prompting you to enter the password as shown on the right will be displayed, and no operation is enabled until you have entered the password. After entering the preset password, the dialog disappears and the Main window will be displayed. As shown below, you can open a window by clicking the corresponding tab at the top right of the window.

HITACHI User Login Enter Password Send

User Password dialog

Tab Description
Log OutLogs out from e-Control®.This tab appears only when User Password of the Tools window is enabled.
Tools Opens Tools window(45).
Info Opens Info window(47).
Contact IT Help Opens Help Desk window(48).

NOTE • If Crestron e-Control in the Network Settings (21) is set to Disable, Crestron e-Control® cannot be used to operate the projector. Enable Crestron e-Control and close the web browser. Next, restart the web browser, followed by entering the projector's IP address. • Only English is supported on Crestron e-Control®. • If the connection is terminated, the "Loading..." screen will appear. Check the connection between the projector and the computer, then return or refresh the Web page.

3.2 Crestron e-Control ^® (continued)

3.2.1 Main window

HITACHI Power Vol - Mate Vol + Sources List Computer In 1 Computer In Z LAN USB Type A USB Type B Menu Enter Reset Freeze Contrast Brightness Color CREDITRON

You can operate the basic controls of the projector on this screen.

NOTE • If the projector is in the standby mode, only the Power button can be operated.

1 Click a button and operate as follows.

Button Description
Power Turns the power on/off.
Vol -/ Vol + Adjusts the volume setting.
Mute Turns Mute on/off.

2 Sources List

You can click a button to switch the input channel. The cursor will move according to the currently selected input port.

Button Description
Computer in1 Selectsinput from COMPUTER IN1 port.
Computer in2 Selectsinput from COMPUTER IN2 port.
LAN Selects input from LAN port.
USB Type A Selects input from USB TYPE A port.
USB Type B Selects input from USB TYPE B port.
HDMI Selects input from HDMI port.
S-VideoSelects input from S-VIDEO port.
Video Selects input from VIDEO port.

3.2 Crestron e-Control ^® - Main window (continued)

3 Click a button and operate as follows. To show the hidden buttons, click the ◀ / ▶ icons at the left and right ends.

Button Description
Freeze Turns Freeze on/off.
Contrast Adjusts the contrast setting.
Brightness Adjusts the brightness setting.
Color Adjusts the color setting.
Sharpness Adjusts the sharpness setting.
MagnifyControls the magnification setting using the [+] / [-] buttons.Use the [▲] [▼] [◀] [▶] buttons to move to the area you want to magnify.
Auto Performs the automatic adjustment.
Blank Turns Blank on/off.

4 Click the button and operate in the same way as the bundled remote control.

Button Description
Menu Assigned the same operation as MENU button.
Enter Assigned the same operation as ENTER button.
Reset Assigned the same operation as RESET button.
▲ Assigned the same operation as ▲ button.
▼ Assigned the same operation as ▼ button.
◀ Assigned the same operation as ◀ button.
▶ Assigned the same operation as ▶ button.

3.2 Crestron e-Control ^® (continued)

3.2.2 Tools window

HITACHI 2 1 3 4 5 User Password ■ Enabled New Password Confirm Send Send AdminPassword ■ Enabled New Password Confirm Send Exit

Configures the settings between the projector and Crestron® control system. Click the [Exit] button to return to the Main window.

NOTE • If two-byte characters are used, the input text or numbers cannot be set correctly.
- All items on this window cannot be left blank.

1 Crestron Control

Configures the settings of Crestron ^® control system devices.

Item Description
IP AddressConfigures the IP address of the control system.
IP IDConfigures the IP ID of the control system.
PortSpecifies the port number used for communication by the control system.

To apply the settings, click the [Send] button.

2 Projector

Configures the network settings of the projector.

Item Description
Projector NameConfigures the name of the projector. The length of the Projector Name can be up to 64 alphanumeric characters.
LocationConfigures the location name of the projector. You can specify a Location name up to 32 alphanumeric characters.
Assigned To:Configures the user name for the projector. You can specify a user name up to 32 alphanumeric characters.

The usable symbols are space and the following:!"#\$%&'()*+,-./;;<=>?@[^_^_{}\~To apply the settings, click the [Send] button.

3.2 Crestron e-Control ^® - Tools window (continued)

3 Projector (continued)

Configures the network settings of the projector.

Item Description
DHCP Enables DHCP.
IP AddressConfigures the IP address when DHCP is disabled.
Subnet MaskConfigures the subnet mask when DHCP is disabled.
Default GatewayConfigures the default gateway when DHCP is disabled.
DNS ServerConfigures the DNS server address.

To apply the settings, click the [Send] button.

4 User Password

Configures the User Password. To prompt the entry of User Password before starting e-Control ^® , select the checkbox.

Item Description
New PasswordConfigures the password.You can specify a password up to 26 alphanumeric characters.The usable symbols are space and the following:!"#$%&'()*+,-./;<=>?@[^\]^_`{|}~
ConfirmReenter the above password for verification. If the password is incorrect, an error message is displayed.

To apply the settings, click the [Send] button.

5 Admin Password

Configures the Admin Password. To prompt the entry of Admin Password before displaying the Tools window, select the checkbox.

Item Description
New PasswordConfigures the password.You can specify a password up to 26 alphanumeric characters.The usable symbols are space and the following:!"#$%&'()*+,-./:;<=>?@[^]^_`{|}~
ConfirmReenter the above password for verification. If the password is incorrect, an error message is displayed.

To apply the settings, click the [Send] button.

3.2 Crestron e-Control ^® (continued)

3.2.3 Info window

HITACHI Projector Information Projector Name PRI_00000000000 Location Room MAC Andrews 85.00.00 GB/50.00 Resolution 1024 x 788 69Hz Lamp Hours 123 Assigned To Name Projector Status Power Status On Input Source Computer in 1 Picture Mode Normal Installation Front/Desktop Eco Mode Normal Error Status Normal Exit CRESSTRON Expansion Options

Displays the settings and status of the projector.

Click the [Exit] button to return to the Main window.

1 Projector Information

Item Description
Projector Name Displays the projector name settings.
Location Displays the location name of the projector.
MAC Address Displays the wired LAN MAC address of the projector.
ResolutionDisplays the resolution and vertical frequency of the signal input selected on the projector.
Lamp Hours Displays the usage time for the current lamp.
Assigned To: Displays the user name for the projector.

2 Projector Status

Item Description
Power Status Displaysthe current power status.
Input Source Displaysthe current input signal source.
Picture Mode Displaysthe current picture mode setting.
Installation Displays the current installation setting.
Eco Mode Displays the current eco mode setting.
Error Status Displays the current error status.

NOTE • Projector Name, Location and the user name for Assigned To: may appear truncated if they are too long.

3. Web Control

3.2 Crestron e-Control ^® (continued)

3.2.4 Help Desk window

HITACHI Power Vol Mute Vol + Sources List Computer In 1 Computer In 2 UAR USB Type A USB Type B Menu Enter Reset Front Contrast Brightness Color CREDITRON Enerven Options

Sends/receives messages to/from the administrator for Crestron RoomView® Express.

Button Description
Send Sends a message.
Check the received message.

3.2 Crestron e-Control ^® (continued)

3.2.5 Emergency Alert

HITACHI Power Vol - Mate Vol + Fire Alert [11.13.15 AM] A fire emergency is in effect. Please follow fire evacuation procedures. To report emergency please type the message here and please "Send" button below Send

When the administrator for Crestron RoomView® Express sends out an alert message, it will be displayed on the screen.

You can reply to the alert message via a chat format. Input a message in the box below the alert message, and click the [Send] button.

NOTE • For details of Emergency Alert, refer to the manual of Crestron RoomView® Express.
- The alert message from Crestron RoomView® is displayed on the screen of the projector in a way similar to the real-time text of the Messenger function (51). If another real-time text is currently being displayed, it will be overwritten by the alert message. However, if the priority of the real-time text is set to high, it will not be overwritten by the alert message, and the latter will not appear on the screen of the projector. For details, refer to the manual for the application of the Messenger.

4. My Image Function

The projector can display still images that are transferred via the network.

HITACHI CPX10WN - My Image Function - 1

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Computer"] --> B["Transfer image data"]
    B --> C["Protractor"]
    C --> D["Display image data (ex. 1)"]
    subgraph Display Data
        E["1: Image 1, 2: Image 2, 3: Image 3, 4: Image 4"]
    end
    subgraph Display Data
        F["2: Image 1, 2: Image 2, 3: Image 3, 4: Image 4"]
    end
    G["3: Image 1, 2: Image 2, 3: Image 3, 4: Image 4"]
    H["4: Image 1, 2: Image 2, 3: Image 3, 4: Image 4"]

MY IMAGE transmission requires an exclusive application for your computer. Use the application to transfer the image data.

It can be downloaded from the Hitachi web site (http://www.hitachi-america.us/digitalmedia or http://www.hitachidigitalmedia.com).

For information on the necessary settings and operations for the computer and projector, refer to the manual for the application.

To display the transferred image, select the MY IMAGE item in the NETWORK menu. For more information, please see the description of the MY IMAGE item of the NETWORK menu. (NETWORK menu in the Operating Guide)

NOTE • It is possible to allocate the image file up to 4 in the maximum.

- Using MY BUTTON that registered MY IMAGE can display transferred image. (OPTION menu in the Operating Guide)

- The image file also can be displayed by using schedule function from the web browser. Refer to item 7.3 Event Scheduling (59) in detail.

- If you display MY IMAGE data on screen while you are using the USB Display function, the application for the USB Display will be closed. To restart the application, exit the MY IMAGE function, and then the software in the projector, LiveViewerLiteUSB.exe, will run again. (USB Display in the Operating Guide)

- If data is transferred via wireless and wired LAN at the same time, the projector may not be able to process the data correctly.

5. Messenger Function

The projector can display text data transferred via the network on the screen and play back audio data inside the projector.

The text data can be displayed on the screen in two ways that displays the text transferred from the computer on real time, and the other chooses and displays the text data from the ones once stored in the projector.

Transfer Today's Topics The chemical class is canceled. The PE is performed at gym because today due to bad weather. Display text o

Transfer text data

Today's Topics The chemical topic is in your eyes. Today's Topics the chemical topic is the TV is performed at open, introduced, having been in your eyes. Today's Topics the chemical topic is in your eyes. 1 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz 2 ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ 3 0123456789 4 Today's Topics The chemical ... : 12 WARNING! FIRE ALERT!

Display text data (ex. 4)

Messenger function requires an exclusive application for your computer. To edit, transfer and display the text data, use the application. You can download it from the Hitachi web site (http://www.hitachi-america.us/digitalmedia or http://www.hitachidigitalmedia.com). For information on the necessary settings and operations for the computer and projector, refer to the manual for the application.

NOTE • It is possible to store the text data up to 12 in the maximum.

  • Using MY BUTTON that registered MESSENGER can turn the displaying messenger text on/off. (OPTION menu in the Operating Guide)
  • The text file also can be displayed by using schedule function via the web browser. Refer to item 7.3 Event Scheduling (59) for the detail.
  • If data is transferred via wireless and wired LAN at the same time, the projector may not be able to process the data correctly.

6. Network Bridge Function

This projector is equipped with the NETWORK BRIDGE function to perform mutual conversion of a network protocol and a serial interface.

By making use of the NETWORK BRIDGE function, a computer that is connected to the projector via wireless or wired LAN is able to control an external device via RS-232C communication using the projector as a network terminal.

HITACHI CPX10WN - Network Bridge Function - 1

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Computer"] -->|TCP/IP data Serial change| B["External device"]
    B -->|RS-232C cable| C["USB TYPE A port"]
    C -->|Wireless LAN LAN cable| D["Computer"]
    C -->|Wireless LAN LAN port| E["External device"]
    C -->|CONTROL port| F["External device"]
    style A fill:#f9f,stroke:#333
    style B fill:#ccf,stroke:#333
    style C fill:#cfc,stroke:#333
    style D fill:#fcc,stroke:#333
    style E fill:#cff,stroke:#333
    style F fill:#ffc,stroke:#333

6.1 Connecting devices

1) Connect the projector's LAN port to the computer's LAN port with a LAN cable, or insert the USB wireless adapter into the USB TYPE A port.
2) Connect the projector's CONTROL port and the device's RS-232C port with an RS-232C cable, for RS-232C communication.

NOTE • Before connecting the devices, read the manuals for the devices to ensure the connection. For RS-232C connection, check the specifications of each port and use the suitable cable. (Connection to the ports in the Operating Guide - Technical)

6.2 Communication setup

To configure the setup of the communication using NETWORK BRIDGE for the projector, use items in the COMMUNICATION menu. Open the menu of the projector and select the OPTION - SERVICE - COMMUNICATION menu.

(OPTION menu > SERVICE > COMMUNICATION in the Operating Guide)

1) In the COMMUNICATION TYPE menu, select NETWORK BRIDGE (WIRELESS or WIRED depending on the type of connection you use) for the CONTROL port.
2) Using the SERIAL SETTINGS menu, select the proper baud rate and parity for the CONTROL port, according to the specification of the RS-232C port of the connected device.

Item Condition
BAUD RATE 4800bps/9600bps/19200bps/38400bps
PARITY NONE/ODD/EVEN
Data length 8 bit (fixed)
Start bit 1 bit (fixed)
Stop bit 1 bit (fixed)

3) Using the TRANSMISSION METHOD menu, set up the proper method for the CONTROL port according to your use.

NOTE • The OFF is selected for the COMMUNICATION TYPE as the default setting.
- Using the COMMUNICATION menu, set up the communication. Remember that an unsuitable setup could cause malfunction of communication.
- When either one of the NETWORK BRIDGE settings is selected in the COMMUNICATION TYPE menu, RS-232C commands cannot be received from the CONTROL port.

6.3 Communication port

For the NETWORK BRIDGE function, send the data from the computer to the projector with using the Network Bridge Port that is configured in the Port Settings of web browser. (23)

NOTE • Except for 41794, 9715, 9716, 9719, 9720, 5900, 5500, 4352 between 1024 and 65535 can be set up as the Network Bridge Port number. It is set to 9717 as the default setting.

6.4 Transmission method

The transmission method can be selected from the menus, only when the NETWORK BRIDGE is selected for the COMMUNICATION TYPE.

(OPTION menu > SERVICE > COMMUNICATION in the Operating Guide)

HALF-DUPLEX FULL-DUPLEX

6.4.1 HALF-DUPLEX

This method lets the projector make two way communication, but only one direction, either transmitting or receiving data, is allowed at a time.

The method does not allow the projector to receive the data from the computer while waiting for response data from an external device. After the projector receives the response data from an external device or the response limit time is past, the projector can receive the data from the computer.

That means that the projector controls transmitting and receiving the data to synchronize the communication.

To use the HALF-DUPLEX method, set up the RESPONSE LIMIT TIME following the instructions below.

HITACHI CPX10WN - HALF-DUPLEX - 1

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Computer"] -->|TCP/IP data| B["Wired LAN"]
    B -->|LAN cable| C["Wireless LAN"]
    C --> D["External device"]
    D -->|RS-232C cable| B
    B -->|Response limit time| E["Transmitting data"]
    E --> F["External device"]
    F -->|Transmitting data| G["External device"]
    G -->|Discarding data| H["External device"]
    H --> I["External device"]
    I -->|Response data| J["External device"]
    J --> K["External device"]
    K -->|Response data| L["External device"]
    L --> M["External device"]
    M --> N["External device"]
    N --> O["External device"]
    O --> P["External device"]
    P --> Q["External device"]
    Q --> R["External device"]
    R --> S["External device"]
    S --> T["External device"]
    T --> U["External device"]
    U --> V["External device"]
    V --> W["External device"]
    W --> X["External device"]
    X --> Y["External device"]
    Y --> Z["External device"]
    Z --> AA["External device"]
    AA --> AB["External device"]
    AB --> AC["External device"]
    AC --> AD["External device"]
    AD --> AE["External device"]
    AE --> AF["External device"]
    AF --> AG["External device"]
    AG --> AH["External device"]
    AH --> AI["External device"]
    AI --> AJ["External device"]
    AJ --> AK["External device"]
    AK --> AL["External device"]
    AL --> AM["External device"]
    AM --> AN["External device"]
    AN --> AO["External device"]
    AO --> AP["External device"]
    AP --> AQ["External device"]
    AQ --> AR["External device"]
    AR --> AS["External device"]
    AS --> AT["External device"]
    AT --> AU["External device"]
    AU --> AV["External device"]
    AV --> AW["External device"]
    AW --> AX["External device"]
    AX --> AY["External device"]

Using the RESPONSE LIMIT TIME menu, set the waiting time for response data from an external device. (OPTION menu > SERVICE > COMMUNICATION in the Operating Guide)

$$ O F F \leftrightarrow 1 s \leftrightarrow 2 s \leftrightarrow 3 s (\leftrightarrow O F F) $$

6.4 Transmission method (continued)

NOTE • With using the HALF-DUPLEX method, the projector can send out 254 byte data as maximum at once.
- If it is not required to monitor the response data from an external device and the RESPONSE LIMIT TIME is set to OFF, the projector can receive the data from the computer and send it out to an external device continuously.
The OFF is selected as the default setting.

6.4.2 FULL-DUPLEX

This method lets the projector make two way communication, transmitting and receiving data at the same time, without monitoring response data from an external device.

With using this method, the computer and an external device will send the data out of synchronization. If it is required to synchronize them, set the computer to make the synchronization.

NOTE • In case that the computer controls to synchronize transmitting and receiving the data, it may not be able to control an external device well depending on the processing status of the projector.

7. Other Functions

7. Other Functions

7.1 E-mail Alerts

The projector can automatically send an alert message to the specified e-mail addresses when the projector detects a certain condition that is requiring maintenance or detected an error.

NOTE • Up to five e-mail addresses can be specified.

- The projector may be not able to send e-mail if the projector suddenly loses power.

Mail Settings (24)

To use the projector's e-mail alert function, please configure the following items through a web browser.

Example: If the IP address of the projector is set to 192.168.1.10:

1) Enter "http://192.168.1.10/" into the address bar of the web browser, and select Projector Web Control from the selection window.
2) Enter your user name and password, and then click the [OK].
3) Click the [Mail Settings] and configure each item. Refer to item 3.1.5 Mail Settings (24) for further information.
4) Click the [Apply] button to save the settings.

NOTE • Click the [Send Test Mail] button in the [Mail Settings] to confirm that the e-mail settings are correct. The following mail will be delivered to the specified addresses.

Subject line :Test Mail

Text :Send Test Mail
Date <Testing date>
Time <Testing time>
IP Address <Projector IP address>
MAC Address <Projector MAC address> 

7.1 E-mail Alerts (continued)

5) Click the [Alert Settings] on the main menu to configure the E-mail Alerts settings.
6) Select and configure each alert item. Refer to item 3.1.6 Alert Settings (31) for further information.
7) Click the [Apply] button to save the settings.

Failure/Warning e-mails are formatted as follows:

Subject line :

Text :

Date

Time

IP Address

MAC Address

7.2 Projector Management using SNMP

The SNMP (Simple Network Management Protocol) enables to manage the projector information, which is a failure or warning status, from the computer on the network. The SNMP management software will be required on the computer to use this function.

NOTE • It is recommended that SNMP functions be carried out by a network administrator.

- SNMP management software must be installed on the computer to monitor the projector via SNMP.

SNMP Settings (23)

Configure the following items via a web browser to use SNMP.

Example: If the IP address of the projector is set to 192.168.1.10:

1) Enter "http://192.168.1.10/" into the address bar of the web browser, and select Projector Web Control from the selection window.
2) Enter your user name and password, and then click the [OK].
3) Click the [Port Settings] on the main menu.
4) Click the [Download MIB file] to download a MIB file.

NOTE • To use the downloaded MIB file, specify the file by your SNMP manager.

5) Click the [Enable] check box to open the SNMP Port. Set the IP address to send the SNMP trap to when a Failure/Warning occurs.

NOTE • A Network Restart is required after the SNMP Port configuration settings have been changed. Click the [Network Restart] and configure the following items.

6) Click the [Security Settings] on the main menu.
7) Click the [SNMP] and set the community name on the screen that is displayed.

NOTE • A Network Restart is required after the Community name has been changed. Click the [Network Restart] and configure the following items.

8) Configure the settings for Trap transmission of Failures/Warnings. Click the [Alert Settings] on the main menu and select the Failure/Warning item to be configured.
9) Click the [Enable] check box to send out the SNMP trap for Failures/Warnings. Clear the [Enable] check box when SNMP trap transmission is not required.
10) Click the [Apply] button to save the settings.

7.3 Event Scheduling

The scheduling function enables to setup scheduled events including power on / power off. It enables to be “self-management” projector.

Schedule Settings / Daily Schedule Enable Show [Command (Parameter)] 60.00 Power (OK) 17.00 Power (OPT) - Present Input Output Source Current Data My Image Current Data Message Text Data Telephone Current (Parameter) Show [Command (Parameter)] Next Top: Network Information Network Settings Port Settings Mid Settings Alert Settings Schedule Settings Daily - Sunday - Monday - Tuesday - Wednesday - Thursday - Friday - Saturday - Specific data No.1 - Specific data No.2 - Specific data No.3 - Specific data No.4 - Specific data No.5 Date/Time Settings Security Settings

NOTE • You can schedule the following control events: Power, Input Source, My Image, Messenger, Slideshow. (28)

- The power on / off event has the lowest priority among the all events that are defined at the same time.

- There are 3 types of Scheduling, 1) daily 2) weekly 3) specific date. (27)

- The priority for scheduled events is as follows 1) specific date 2) weekly 3) daily.

- Up to five specific dates are available for scheduled events. Priority is given to those with the lower numbers when more than one event has been scheduled for the same date and time (e.g., 'Specific date No. 1' has priority over 'Specific date No. 2' and so on.

- Be sure to set the date and time before enabling scheduled events. (30) Once you turn off the projector in the SAVING mode (SETUP menu in the Operating Guide) or the AC power, the current date and time setting is reset.

7.3 Event Scheduling(continued)

Schedule Settings (27)

Schedule settings can be configured from a web browser.

Example: If the IP address of the projector is set to 192.168.1.10:

1) Enter "http://192.168.1.10/" into the address bar of the web browser, and select Projector Web Control from the selection window.
2) Enter your user name and password, and then click the [OK].
3) Click the [Schedule Settings] on the main menu and select the required schedule item. For example, if you want to perform the command every Sunday, please select the [Sunday].
4) Click the [Enable] check box to enable scheduling.
5) Enter the date (month/day) for specific date scheduling.
6) Click the [Apply] button to save the settings.
7) After configure the time, command and parameters, click the [Register] to add the new event.
8) Click the [Delete] button when you want to delete a schedule.

There are three types of scheduling.

1) Daily: Perform the specified operation at a specified time every day.
2) Sunday \~ Saturday: Perform the specified operation at the specified time on a specified day of the week.
3) Specific date: Perform the specified operation on the specified date and time.

NOTE • In standby mode, the POWER indicator will flash green for approx. 3 seconds when at least 1 “Power ON” schedule is saved.

- When the schedule function is used, the power cord must be connected to the projector and the outlet. The schedule function does not work when the breaker in a room is tripped. The power indicator will lights orange or green when the projector is receiving AC power.

7.3 Event Scheduling(continued)

Date/Time Settings (30)

The Date/Time setting can be adjusted via a web browser.

Example: If the IP address of the projector is set to 192.168.1.10:

1) Enter "http://192.168.1.10/" into the address bar of the web browser, and select Projector Web Control from the selection window.
2) Enter your user name and password, and then click the [OK].
3) Click the [Date/Time Settings] on the main menu and configure each item. Refer to item 3.1.8 Date/Time Settings (☐30) for further information.
4) Click the [Apply] button to save the settings.

Date/ Time Settings Control Date Control Time Default Settings Start End Current Time difference OK17: NETP Summary Address Cylph To apply changes to datatime settings, click apply, then perform Network Request. To apply changes to datatime settings, click apply, then perform Network Request.

NOTE • The internal clock's time may not remain accurate. Using SNTP is recommended to maintain accurate time (31).
- Once you turn off the projector in the SAVING mode (SETUP menu in the Operating Guide) or the AC power, the current date and time setting is reset.

7. Other Functions

7.4 Command Control via the Network

You can configure and control the projector via the network using RS-232C commands.

Communication Port

The following two ports are assigned for the command control.

TCP #23 (Network Control Port1 (Port: 23)) TCP #9715 (Network Control Port2 (Port: 9715))

NOTE • Command control is available only via the specified port above.

Command Control Settings (22)

Configure the following items from a web browser when command control is used.

Example: If the IP address of the projector is set to 192.168.1.10:

1) Enter "http://192.168.1.10/" into the address bar of the web browser, and select Projector Web Control from the selection window.
2) Enter your user name and password, and then click the [OK].
3) Click the [Port Settings] on the main menu.

Port Settings Network Control Port1 (Port:23) Port Settings Network Control Port2 (Port:9715) Port Settings Network Control Port2 (Port:9715) Port Settings PULink Port (Port:4352) Port Settings My Image Port (Port:9718) Port Settings Messenger Port (Port:9718) Port Settings Copyright Port (Port:9718)

4) Click the [Enable] check box to open Network Control Port1 (Port: 23) to use TCP #23. Click the [Enable] check box for the [Authentication] setting when authentication is required, otherwise clear the check box.
5) Click the [Enable] check box to open Network Control Port2 (Port: 9715) to use TCP #9715. Click the [Enable] check box for the [Authentication] setting when authentication is required, otherwise clear the check box.
6) Click the [Apply] button to save the settings.

7.4 Command Control via the Network (continued)

When the authentication setting is enabled, the following settings are required. (32)

7) Click the [Security Settings] on the main menu.
8) Click the [Network Control] and enter the desired authentication password. * See NOTE.
9) Click the [Apply] button to save the settings.

NOTE • The Authentication Password will be the same for Network Control Port1 (Port: 23), Network Control Port2 (Port: 9715), PJLink™ Port (Port: 4352), My Image Port (Port: 9716) and Messenger Port (Port: 9719).

- The new configuration settings are activated after restarting the network connection. When the configuration settings are changed, you must restart the network connection. You can restart the network connection by clicking the [Network Restart] on the main menu(41).

7.4 Command Control via the Network (continued)

Command Format

Command formats differ among the different communication ports.

- TCP #23

You can use the RS-232C commands without any changes. The reply data format is the same as the RS-232C commands. (RS-232C Communication in the Operating Guide - Technical)

However, the following reply will be sent back in the event of authentication failure when authentication is enabled.

Reply Error code
0x1F 0x04 0x00

- TCP #9715

Send Data format

The following formatting is added to the header (0 x 02), Data length (0 x 0D), Checksum (1 byte) and Connection ID (1 byte) of the RS-232C commands.

Header Data length R$-232Ccommand Check SumConnection ID
0x02 0x0D 13 bytes 1 byte 1 byte

Header → 0x02, Fixed

Data length → RS-232C commands byte length (0x0D, Fixed)

RS-232C command → RS-232C commands that start with 0xBE 0xEF (13 bytes)

Check Sum → This is the value to make zero on the addition of the lower 8 bits from the header to the checksum.

Connection ID → Random value from 0 to 255 (This value is attached to the reply data)

7.4 Command Control via the Network (continued)

Reply Data format

The connection ID (the data is same as the connection ID data on the sending data format) is attached to the RS-232C commands reply data.

ReplyConnection ID
0x06 1 byte

ReplyConnection ID
0x15 1 byte

Reply Error codeConnection ID
0x1C 2 bytes 1 byte

Reply DataConnection ID
0x1D 2 bytes 1 byte

Reply Status codeConnection ID
0x1F 2 bytes 1 byte

ReplyAuthentication Error codeConnection ID
0x1F 0x04 0x00 1 byte

7. Other Functions

7.4 Command Control via the Network (continued)

Automatic Connection Break

The TCP connection will be automatically disconnected after there is no communication for 30 seconds after being established.

Authentication

The projector does not accept commands without authentication success when authentication is enabled. The projector uses a challenge response type authentication with an MD5 (Message Digest 5) algorithm.

When the projector is using a LAN, a random 8 bytes will be returned if authentication is enabled. Bind this received 8 bytes and the Authentication Password and digest this data with the MD5 algorithm and add this in front of the commands to send.

Following is a sample if the Authentication Password is set to “password” and the random 8 bytes are “a572f60c”.

1) Connect the projector.
2) Receive the random 8 bytes "a572f60c" from the projector.
3) Bind the random 8 bytes "a572f60c" and the Authentication Password "password" and it becomes "a572f60cpassword".
4) Digest this bind "a572f60cpassword" with MD5 algorithm. It will be "e3d97429adffa11bce1f7275813d4bde".
5) Add this "e3d97429adffa11bce1f7275813d4bde" in front of the commands and send the data. Send "e3d97429adffa11bce1f7275813d4bde"+command.
6) When the sending data is correct, the command will be performed and the reply data will be returned. Otherwise, an authentication error will be returned.

NOTE • As for the transmission of the second or subsequent commands, the authentication data can be omitted when the same connection.

7.5 Crestron RoomView®

Crestron RoomView ^® is a multi-user resource management program provided by Crestron Electronics, Inc. It is an application for managing and controlling the projector and other AV devices collectively.

For details of Crestron RoomView®, refer to the Crestron® website.

URL: http://www.crestron.com

The following communication interfaces can be used to manage the entire facility.

1) Crestron RoomView® Express / Crestron RoomView® Server Edition RoomViewTM Express and RoomViewTM Server Edition are software provided by Crestron Electronics, Inc. They are used for managing all the AV devices, and are also able to communicate with the help desk as well as send out alert messages.

For details of the software, refer to the following website.

URL: http://www.crestron.com/getroomview

2) Crestron e-Control®

Crestron e-Control ^® is a system controller that can be operated via a web browser (42).

8. Troubleshooting

  1. Troubleshooting
Problem LikelyCause Things to CheckReference Page Number
Can't communicateWeak radio signal• Bring the computer and projector closer together.• Radio waves won't go through concrete and metal (steel doors, etc.)-
Cannot communicate due to configure wireless / encryption settings.If there is a wireless configuration utility loaded on your computer, check its settings.Please refer the manual of your configuration utility.-
The computer and/or projector's network settings are not configured correctly.Check the network configurations of the computer and projector.-
The same network address is set for both wireless and wired LAN.Change the network address setting for wireless or wired LAN.20, 21
The USB wireless adapter is not inserted into the projector.Insert the optional USB wireless adapter.-
There is closely another projector or other that has the same wireless setting.Try changing of SSID and IP Address.20
Others- Information from the projector to computer is not correct or completed- The projector does not respondCommunication between the projector and computer is not working well.NETWORK Functions of the projector is not working well.Try “NETWORK RESTART” in SERVICE menu under the NETWORK menu.In the Operating Guide
  1. Specifications
Item Specifications
Control software Dedicated computer application and Web browser
Corresponding protocolTCP/IP, DHCP client and HTTP server
NetworkWireless LAN (IEEE802.11b/g/n)(Ad-Hoc and Infrastructure modes)Wired LAN(100Base-TX/10Base-T)
SecurityWEP (64/128bit), WPA-PSK (TKIP/AES),WPA2-PSK (TKIP/AES), SSID
Computerapplication's systemrequirementsOS: Windows® XP HomeWindows® XP ProfessionalWindows Vista® Home BasicWindows Vista® Home PremiumWindows Vista® BusinessWindows Vista® UltimateWindows Vista® EnterpriseWindows® 7 StarterWindows® 7 Home BasicWindows® 7 Home PremiumWindows® 7 ProfessionalWindows® 7 UltimateWindows® 7 EnterpriseCPU: Pentium 4 (2.8 GHz or higher)Graphic card: 16 bit, XGA or higherMemory: 512 MB or higherHard disk space: 100 MB or higherWeb browser: Internet Explorer® 6.0 or higherCD-ROM drive
USB wireless adapter Gemtek USB-Link11n

10. Warranty and after-sales service

10. Warranty and after-sales service

If a problem occurs with the equipment, please read 8. Troubleshooting (68) section first and review all suggested check points. After that, please contact your dealer or service company, if you still have the problem. They will tell you what warranty condition is applied.

Projector

CPX10WN/CPX11WN/CPWX12WN

User's Manual (detailed)

Operating Guide – Technical

Example of PC signal

Resolution (H x V)H. frequency (kHz)V. frequency (Hz)Rating Signal mode
720 x 40037.9 85.0 VESA TEXT
640 x 480 31.559.9 VESA VGA (60Hz)
640 x 480 37.972.8 VESA VGA (72Hz)
640 x 480 37.575.0 VESA VGA (75Hz)
640 x 480 43.385.0 VESA VGA (85Hz)
800 x 600 35.256.3 VESA SVGA (56Hz)
800 x 600 37.960.3 VESA SVGA (60Hz)
800 x 600 48.172.2 VESA SVGA (72Hz)
800 x 600 46.975.0 VESA SVGA (75Hz)
800 x 600 53.785.1 VESA SVGA (85Hz)
832 x 624 49.774.5 Mac 16" mode
1024 x 768 48.460.0 VESA XGA (60Hz)
1024 x 768 56.570.1 VESA XGA (70Hz)
1024 x 768 60.075.0 VESA XGA (75Hz)
1024 x 768 68.785.0 VESA XGA (85Hz)
1152 x 864 67.575.0 VESA1152 x 864 (75Hz)
1280 x 768 47.760.0 VESA W-XGA (60Hz)
1280 x 800 49.760.0 VESA1280 x 800 (60Hz)
1280 x 960 60.060.0 VESA1280 x 960 (60Hz)
1280 x 102464.0 60.0 VESA SXGA (60Hz)
1280 x 102480.0 75.0 VESA SXGA (75Hz)
*1 1280 x 102491.1 85.0 VESA SXGA (85Hz)
*2 1400 x 105065.2 60.0 VESA SXGA+ (60Hz)
1440 x 90055.9 59.9 VESA WXGA+ (60Hz)
*3 1680 x 105065.360.0VESAWSXGA+ (60Hz)
*1 1600 x 120075.060.0VESAUXGA (60Hz)

*1) Supported except for HDMI input. *2) Only for CPX10WN and CPX11WN.

NOTE • Be sure to check jack type, signal level, timing and resolution before connecting this projector to a PC.

  • Some PCs may have multiple display screen modes. Use of some of these modes will not be possible with this projector.
  • Depending on the input signal, full-size display may not be possible in some cases. Refer to the number of display pixels above.
  • Although the projector can display signals with resolution up to UXGA (1600x1200), the signal will be converted to the projector's panel resolution before being displayed. The best display performance will be achieved if the resolutions of the input signal and projector panel are identical.
    • Automatic adjustment may not function correctly with some input signals.
  • The image may not be displayed correctly when the input sync signal is a composite sync or a sync on G.

Initial set signals

The following signals are used for the initial settings. The signal timing of some PC models may be different. In such case, adjust the items V POSITION and H POSITION in the IMAGE menu.

Back porch (B) Front porch (D) Active video (C) Data H. Sync. Sync (A)

Back porch (b) Front porch (d) Data Active video (c) V. Sync. Sync (a)

Resolution (H x V)Horizontal signal timing (μs)Vertical signal timing (lines)Signal mode
(A) (B) (C) (D) (a) (b) (c) (d)
720 x 4002.03.020.31.03.42 4001 TEXT
640 x 480 3.81.925.40.62 3348010 VGA (60Hz)
640 x 480 1.34.120.30.83 284809 VGA (72Hz)
640 x 480 2.03.820.30.53 164801 VGA (75Hz)
640 x 480 1.62.217.81.63 254801 VGA (85Hz)
800 x 600 2.03.622.20.72 226001 SVGA (56Hz)
800 x 600 3.22.220.01.04 236001 SVGA (60Hz)
800 x 600 2.41.316.01.16 2360037 SVGA (72Hz)
800 x 600 1.63.216.20.33 216001 SVGA (75Hz)
800 x 600 1.12.714.20.63 276001 SVGA (85Hz)
832 x 624 1.13.914.50.63 396241 Mac 16" mode
1024 x 768 2.12.515.80.46 297683 XGA (60Hz)
1024 x 768 1.81.913.70.36 297683 XGA (70Hz)
1024 x 768 1.22.213.00.23 287681 XGA (75Hz)
1024 x 768 1.02.210.80.53 367681 XGA (85Hz)
1152 x 864 1.22.410.70.63 328641 1152 x 864 (75Hz)
1280 x 768 1.72.516.00.83 237681 W-XGA (60Hz)
1280 x 800 1.62.415.30.83 248001 W-XGA (60Hz)
1280 x 960 1.02.911.90.93369601 W-XGA (60Hz)
1280 x 10241.02.311.90.433810241SXGA (60Hz)
1280 x 10241.11.89.50.13 3810241 SXGA (75Hz)
1280 x 10241.01.48.10.43 4410241 SXGA (85Hz)
1400 x 10501.22.011.40.733310501 SXGA+ (60Hz)
1440 x 900 1.42.213.50.86 259003 W XGA+ (60Hz)
1680 x 10501.21.911.50.763010503WSXGA+ (60Hz)
1600 x 12001.21.99.90.43 4612001 UXGA (60Hz)

Connection to the ports

NOTICE ▶ Use the cables with straight plugs, not L-shaped ones, as the input ports of the projector are recessed.

LAN AC IN HDMI USB TYPE A DC5V 0.5A USB TYPE B C A B COMPUTER IN1 COMPUTER IN2 S-VIDEO VIDEO AUDIO IN1 AUDIO IN2 CONTROLMONITOR OUTAUDIO OUT

ⒶCOMPUTER IN1, ⒷCOMPUTER IN2, ⒸMONITOR OUT

• Video signal: RGB separate, Analog, 0.7Vp-p, 75Ω terminated (positive)

• H/V. sync. signal: TTL level (positive/negative)

- Composite sync. signal: TTL level

- Video signal:

①⑬⑭⑮⑯ ⑥①⑤ ①④③②①③④⑤⑥⑦⑧⑨⑪⑫⑬⑭⑮⑯⑰⑱⑲⑳⑴⑵⑶⑷⑩⑪⑫⑬⑭⑮⑯⑰⑱⑲⑳⑴⑵⑶⑷⑩⑪⑫⑬⑭⑮⑯⑰⑱⑲⑳⑴⑵⑶⑷⑩⑪⑫⑬⑭⑮⑯⑰⑱⑲⑳⑴⑵⑶⑷⑩⑪⑫⑬⑭⑯⑰⑱⑲⑳⑴⑵⑥⑦⑧ 432

987

-Y, Analog, 1.0±0.1Vp-p with composite sync, 75Ω terminated

-Cb/Pb, Analog, 0.7±0.1Vp-p, 75Ω terminated

-Cr/Pr, Analog, 0.7±0.1Vp-p 75Ω terminated

System: 480i@60, 480p@60, 576i@50, 576p@50, 720p@50/60, 1080i@50/60, 1080p@50/60

PinSignal Pin Signal
1Video Red, Cr/Pr9(No connection)
2Video Green, Y10Ground
3Video Blue, Cb/Pb11(No connection)
4(No connection)12A: SDA (DDC data), (No connection)B, C: (No connection)
5Ground
6Ground Red, Ground Cr/Pr13H. sync / Composite sync., (No connection)
7Ground Green, Ground Y14V. sync., (No connection)
8Ground Blue, Ground Cb/Pb15A: SCL (DDC clock), (No connection)B, C: (No connection)

F HDMI USB TYPE A DC5V 0.5A USB TYPE B D COMPUTER IN1 COMPUTER IN2 S-VIDEO AUDIO IN1 VIDEO AUDIO IN2 LAN AC IN E CONTROLMONITOR OUTAUDIO OUT

DS-VIDEO

Mini DIN 4pin jack

HITACHI CPX10WN - DS-VIDEO - 1

• System: NTSC, PAL, SECAM, PAL-M, PAL-N, NTSC4.43, PAL (60Hz)

Pin Signal
1Color signal 0.286Vp-p (NTSC, burst), 75Ω terminatorColor signal 0.300Vp-p (PAL/SECAM, burst) 75Ω terminator
2Brightness signal, 1.0Vp-p, 75Ω terminator
3 Ground
4 Ground

©VIDEO

RCA jack

• System: NTSC, PAL, SECAM, PAL-M, PAL-N, NTSC4.43, PAL (60Hz)
• 1.0±0.1Vp-p, 75Ω terminator

F HDMI

  • Type :HDMI ^TM connector
  • Audio signal : Linear PCM (Sampling rate; 32/44.1/48 kHz)

18 16 14 12 10 8 6 4 2 19 17 15 13 11 9 7 5 3 1

PinSignal Pin Signal Pin Signal
1T.M.D.S. Data2 +8T.M.D.S. Data0 Shield15SCL
2T.M.D.S. Data2 Shield9T.M.D.S. Data0 -16SDA
3T.M.D.S. Data2 -10T.M.D.S. Clock +17DDC/CEC Ground
4T.M.D.S. Data1 +11T.M.D.S. Clock Shield18+5V Power
5T.M.D.S. Data1 Shield12T.M.D.S. Clock -19Hot Plug Detect
6T.M.D.S. Data1 -13CEC
7T.M.D.S. Data0 +14Reserved(N.C. on device)

LAN AC IN HDMI USB TYPE A DC5V USB TYPE B G I H COMPUTER IN1 COMPUTER IN2 S-VIDEO AUDIO IN1 VIDEO AUDIO IN2 CONTROLMONITOR OUTAUDIO OUT

©AUDIO IN1, ⒽAUDIO IN2

- About the details of RS-232C communication, please refer to the next chapter.

⑨⑧⑦⑥ ⑤④③②①

Pin Signal Pin Signal Pin Signal
1 (No connection) 4 (No connection) 7RTS
2 RD 5 Ground 8 CTS
3TD6(No connection)9(No connection)

KUSB TYPE A

USB A type jack

PinSignal
1+5V
2- Data
3+ Data
4Ground

HITACHI CPX10WN - KUSB TYPE A - 1

LUSB TYPE B

USB B type jack

Pin Signal
1+5V
2- Data
3+ Data
4Ground

HITACHI CPX10WN - LUSB TYPE B - 1

©MLAN

RJ-45 jack

PinSignalPinSignalPinSignal
1TX+4-7-
2TX-5-8-
3RX+6RX-

① ② ③ ④ ⑤ ⑥ ⑦ ⑧

To input component video signal to COMPUTER IN ports

ex.

D-sub plug HDMI USB TYPE A DC5V 0.5A USB TYPE B COMPUTER IN1 COMPUTER IN2 S-VIDEO AUDIO IN1 VIDEO AUDIO IN2 CONTROLMONITOR OUTAUDIO OUT RCA plugs Y Cr/Ps Cr/PR COMPONENT VIDEO OUT RCA connectors VCR/DVD/Blu-ray Disc player

To input component video signal to the COMPUTER IN1 or COMPUTER IN2 port of the projector, use a RCA to D-sub cable or adapter.

For about the pin description of the required cable or adapter, refer to the descriptions about COMPUTER IN1 or COMPUTER IN2 port (3).

RS-232C Communication

When the projector connects to the computer by RS-232C communication, the projector can be controlled with RS-232C commands from the computer. For details of RS-232C commands, refer to RS-232C Communication / Network command table (17).

Connection

  1. Turn off the projector and the computer.
  2. Connect the projector's CONTROL port and the computer's RS-232C port with a RS-232C cable (cross). Use the cable that fulfills the specification shown in figure.
  3. Turn the computer on, and after the computer has started up turn the projector on.
  4. Set the COMMUNICATION TYPE to OFF. OPTION menu - SERVICE - COMMUNICATION in the Operating Guide)

HITACHI CPX10WN - Connection - 1

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Computer"] --> B["RS-232C Device"]
    B --> C["RS-232C Cable (cross)"]
    C --> D["Control Unit"]

RS-232C port of the computer
③ ⑧ ⑦ ⑥ ⑤ ① ③ ② ①

CONTROL port of the projector
⑨ 8 7 6 ⑤ 4 3 2 1

HITACHI CPX10WN - Connection - 4

flowchart
graph TD
    CD["CD (1)"] --> RD2["RD(2)"]
    RD2 --> TD2["TD (3)"]
    TD2 --> DTR["DTR (4)"]
    DTR --> GND["GND (5)"]
    GND --> DSR["DSR (6)"]
    DSR --> RTS["RTS (7)"]
    RTS --> DTS["DTS (8)"]
    DTS --> RI["RI (9)"]

    RD2 --> TD2
    TD2 --> GND

    RD2 --> TD3["TD (3)"]
    TD3 --> DTR

    TD3 --> RTS
    RTS --> RI

    TD3 --> RI

    TD1["RD"] --> TD2
    TD2 --> TD3
    TD3 --> TD1

    TD1 --> TD4["TD"]
    TD4 --> GND
    GND --> DSR
    DSR --> RTS
    RTS --> RI

    TD4 --> TD5["TD"]
    TD5 --> GND
    GND --> DSR
    DSR --> RTS
    RTS --> RI

    TD5 --> TD6["TD"]
    TD6 --> GND
    GND --> DSR
    DSR --> RTS
    RTS --> RI

    TD6 --> TD7["TD"]
    TD7 --> GND
    GND --> DSR
    DSR --> RTS
    RTS --> RI

    TD7 --> TD8["TD"]
    TD8 --> GND
    GND --> DSR
    DSR --> RTS
    RTS --> RI

    TD8 --> TD9["TD"]
    TD9 --> GND
    GND --> DSR
    DSR --> RTS
    RTS --> RI

    TD9 --> TD10["TD"]
    TD10 --> GND
    GND --> DSR
    DSR --> RTS
    RTS --> RI

    TD10 --> TD11["TD"]
    TD11 --> GND
    GND --> DSR
    DSR --> RTS
    RTS --> RI

    TD11["TD"] --> TD12["TD"]
    TD12 --> GND
    GND --> DSR
    DSR --> RTS
    RTS --> RI

    TD12 --> TD13["TD"]
    TD13 --> GND
    GND --> DSR
    DSR --> RTS
    RTS --> RI

    TD13 --> TD14["TD"]
    TD14 --> GND
    GND --> DSR
    DSR --> RTS
    RTS --> RI

    TD14 --> TD15["TD"]
    TD15 --> GND
    GND --> DSR
    DSR --> RTS
    RTS --> RI

    TD15 --> TD16["TD"]
    TD16 --> GND
    GND --> DSR
    DSR --> RTS
    RTS --> RI

    TD16 --> TD17["TD"]
    TD17 --> GND
    GND --> DSR
    DSR --> RTS
    RTS --> RI

    TD17 --> TD18["TD"]
    TD18 --> GND
    GND --> DSR
    DSR --> RTS
    RTS --> RI

    TD18 --> TD19["TD"]
    TD19 --> GND
    GND --> DSR
    DSR --> RTS
    RTS --> RI

    TD19 --> TD20["TD"]
    TD20 --> GND
    GND --> DSR
    DSR --> RTS
    RTS --> RI

    TD20 --> TD21["TD"]
    TD21 --> GND
    GND --> DSR
    DSR --> RTS
    RTS --> RI

    TD21 --> TD22["TD"]
    TD22 --> GND
    GND --> DSR
    DSR --> RTS
    RTS --> RI

    TD22 --> TD23["TD"]
    TD23 --> GND
    GND --> DSR
    DSR --> RTS
    RTS --> RI

    TD23 --> TD24["TD"]
    TD24 --> GND
    GND --> DSR
    DSR --> RTS
    RTS --> RI

    TD24 --> TD25["TD"]
    TD25 --> GND
    GND --> DSR
    DSR --> RTS
    RTS --> RI

    TD25 --> TD26["TD"]
    TD26 --> GND
    GND --> DSR
    DSR --> RTS
    RTS --> RI

    TD26 --> TD27["TD"]
    TD27 --> GND
    GND --> DSR
    DSR --> RTS
    RTS --> RI

    TD27 --> TD28["TD"]
    TD28 --> GND
    GND --> DSR
    DSR --> RTS
    RTS --> RI

    TD28 --> TD29["TD"]
    TD29 --> GND
    GND --> DSR
    DSR --> RTS
    RTS --> RI

    TD29 --> TD30["TD"]
    TD30 --> GND
    GND --> DSR
    DSR --> RTS
    RTS --> RI

    TD30["TD"] --> TD31["TD"]
    TD31 --> GND

Communication settings

1. Protocol

19200bps,8N1

  1. Command format ("h" shows hexadecimal)
Byte Number01234569101
CommandActionHeader Data
Header codePacketData sizeCRC flagAction TypeSetting code
LHLHLHLHLHLH
BEhEFh03h06h00h(aL)(aH)01h00h(bL)(bH)(cL)(cH)
(aL)(aH)02h00h(bL)(bH)00h00h
(aL)(aH)04h00h(bL)(bH)00h00h
(aL)(aH)05h00h(bL)(bH)00h00h
(aL)(aH)06h00h(bL)(bH)00h00h

[Header code], [Packet], [Data size]

Set [BEh, EFh, 03h, 06h, 00h] to byte number 0 \~ 4.

[CRC flag]

For byte number 5, 6, refer to RS-232C Communication / Network command table (17).

[Action]

Set functional code to byte number 7, 8.

$$ < \text {SET} > = [ 0 1 \mathrm{h}, 0 0 \mathrm{h} ], < \text {GET} > = [ 0 2 \mathrm{h}, 0 0 \mathrm{h} ], < \text {INCREMENT} > = [ 0 4 \mathrm{h}, 0 0 \mathrm{h} ] $$

$$ < \text { DECREMENT } > = [ 0 5 h, 0 0 h ], < \text { EXECUTE } > = [ 0 6 h, 0 0 h ] $$

Refer to the command table above.

[Type], [Setting code]

For byte number 9\~12, refer to RS-232C Communication / Network command table (17).

3. Response code / Error code ("h" shows hexadecimal)

(1) ACK reply : 06h

When the projector receives the Set, Increment, Decrement or Execute command correctly, the projector changes the setting data for the specified item by [Type], and it returns the code.

(2) NAK reply : 15h

When the projector cannot understand the received command, the projector returns the error code.

In such a case, check the sending code and send the same command again.

(3) Error reply : 1Ch + 0000h

When the projector cannot execute the received command for any reasons, the projector returns the error code.

In such a case, check the sending code and the setting status of the projector.

(4) Data reply : 1Dh + xxxxh

When the projector receives the GET command correctly, the projector returns the response code and 2 bytes of data.

NOTE • For connecting the projector to your devices, please read the manual for each devices, and connect them correctly with suitable cables.

  • Operation cannot be guaranteed when the projector receives an undefined command or data.
  • Provide an interval of at least 40ms between the response code and any other code.
  • The projector outputs test data when the power supply is switched ON, and when the lamp is lit. Ignore this data.
  • Commands are not accepted during warm-up.
  • When the data length is greater than indicated by the data length code, the projector ignore the excess data code. Conversely when the data length is shorter than indicated by the data length code, the projector returns the error code to the computer.

Command Control via the Network

When the projector connects network, the projector can be controlled with RS-232C commands from the computer with web browser.

For details of RS-232C commands, refer to RS-232C Communication / Network command table (17).

NOTE • If data is transferred via wireless and wired LAN at the same time, the projector may not be able to process the data correctly.

Connection

  1. Turn off the projector and the computer.
  2. If you use wired LAN, connect the projector's LAN port to the computer's LAN port with a LAN cable. Use the cable that fulfills the specification shown in figure. If you use wireless LAN, insert the USB wireless adapter into the projector's USB TYPE A port.
  3. Turn the computer on, and after the computer has started up turn the projector on.

HITACHI CPX10WN - Connection - 1

flowchart
graph TD
    A["LAN"] --> B["LAN cable (CAT-5 or greater)"]
    C["Computer"] --> D["Device"]
    E["Router"] --> F["Device"]

Communication Port

The following two ports are assigned for the command control.

TCP #23

TCP #9715

Configure the following items form a web browser when command control is used.

Port Settings
Network Control Port1 (Port: 23)Port openClick the [Enable] check box to open [Network Control Port1 (Port: 23)] to use TCP #23. Default setting is “Enable”.
AuthenticationClick the [Enable] check box for the [Authentication] setting when authentication is required. Default setting is “Disable”.
Network Control Port2 (Port: 9715)Port openClick the [Enable] check box to open [Network Control Port2 (Port: 9715)] to use TCP #9715. Default setting is “Enable”.
AuthenticationClick the [Enable] check box for the [Authentication] setting when authentication is required. Default setting is “Enable”.

When the authentication setting is enabled, the following settings are required.

Security Settings
Network ControlAuthentication PasswordEnter the desired authentication password. ConfirmThis setting will be the same for [Network Control Port1 (Port: 23)] and [Network Control Port2 (Port: 9715)]. Default setting is blank.
Re-enter Authentication Password

Command control settings

[TCP #23]

1. Command format

Same as RS-232C communication, refer to RS-232C Communicaton command format.

2. Response code / Error code ("h" shows hexadecimal)

Four of the response / error code used for TCP#23 are the same as RS-232C

Communication (1)\~(4). One authentication error reply (5) is added.

(1) ACK reply : 06h

Refer to RS-232C communication (10).

(2) NAK reply : 15h

Refer to RS-232C communication (10).

(3) Error reply : 1Ch + 0000h

Refer to RS-232C communication (10).

(4) Data reply : 1Dh + xxxxh

Refer to RS-232C communication (10).

(5) Authentication error reply : 1Fh + 0400h

When authentication error occurred, the projector returns the error code.

[TCP #9715]

1. Command format

The commands some datum are added to the head and the end of the ones of TCP#9715 are used.

Header Data length RS-232C command Check sum Connection ID
0×02 0×0D13 bytes 1 byte1 byte

02, Fixed

[Data Length]

RS-232C commands byte length (0×0D, Fixed)

[RS-232C commands]

Refer to RS-232C Communication command format (9).

[Check Sum]

This is the value to make zero on the addition of the lower 8 bits from the header to the checksum.

[Connection ID]

Random value from 0 to 255 (This value is attached to the reply data).

NOTE • Operation cannot be guaranteed when the projector receives an undefined command or data.

- Provide an interval of at least 40ms between the response code and any other code.

- Commands are not accepted during warm-up.

2. Response code / Error code ("h" shows hexadecimal)

The connection ID is attached for the TCP#23's response / error codes are used. The connection ID is same as the sending command format.

(1) ACK reply : 06h + xxh (xxh : connection ID)
(2) NAK reoly : 15h + xxh
(3) Error reply : 1Ch + 0000h + xxh
(4) Data reply : 1Dh + xxxxh + xxh
(5) Authentication error reply : 1Fh + 0400h + xxh
(6) Projector busy reply: 1Fh + xxxxh + xxh

When the projector is too busy to receive the command, the projector returns the error code.

In such a case, check the sending code and send the same command again.

Automatic Connection Break

The TCP connection will be automatically disconnected after there is no communication for 30 seconds after being established.

Authentication

The projector does not accept commands without authentication success when authentication is enabled. The projector uses a challenge response type authentication with an MD5 (Message Digest 5) algorithm. When the projector is using a LAN, a random 8 bytes will be returned if authentication is enabled. Bind this received 8 bytes and the authentication password and digest this data with the MD5 algorithm and add this in front of the commands to send.

Following is a sample if the authentication password is set to “password” and the random 8 bytes are “a572f60c”.

1) Select the projector.
2) Receive the random 8 bytes "a572f60c" from the projector.
3) Bind the random 8 bytes "a572f60c" and the authentication password "password" and it becomes "a572f60cpassword".
4) Digest this bind "a572f60cpassword" with MD5 algorithm.
It will be "e3d97429adffa11bce1f7275813d4bde".
5) Add this "e3d97429adffa11bce1f7275813d4bde" in front of the commands and send the data.
Send “e3d97429adffa11bce1f7275813d4bde”+command.
6) When the sending data is correct, the command will be performed and the reply data will be returned. Otherwise, an authentication error will be returned.

NOTE • As for the transmission of the second or subsequent commands, the authentication data can be omitted when the same connection.

Network Bridge Communication

This projector is equipped with NETWORK BRIDGE function.

When the projector connects to the computer by wired or wireless LAN communication, an external device that is connected with this projector by RS-232C communication can be controlled from the computer as a network terminal. For details, see the 6. Network Bridge function in the Network Guide.

NOTE • If data is transferred via wireless and wired LAN at the same time, the projector may not be able to process the data correctly.

Connection

  1. If you use wired LAN, connect the computer's LAN port and the projector's LAN port with a LAN cable. Use the cable that fulfills the specification shown in figure. If you use wireless LAN, insert the USB wireless adapter into the projector's LAN port.
  2. Connect the projector's CONTROL port and the RS-232C port of the devices that you want to control with a RS-232C cable.
  3. Turn the computer on, and after the computer has started up turn the projector on.
  4. Set the COMMUNICATION TYPE to NETWORK BRIDGE. (OPTION menu - SERVICE - COMMUNICATION in the Operating Guide)

HITACHI CPX10WN - Connection - 1

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Computer"] --> B["LAN"]
    B --> C["LAN cable (CAT-5 or greater)"]
    C --> D["LAN"]
    D --> E["CONTROL"]
    E --> F["RS-232C"]

Communication settings

For communication setting, use the OPTION - SERVICE - COMMUNICATION menu. (OPTION menu - SERVICE - COMMUNICATION in the Operating Guide)

Item Condition
BAUD RATE 4800bps / 9600bps / 19200bps / 38400bps
Data length 8 bit (fixed)
PARITY NONE/ODD/EVEN
Start bit 1 bit (fixed)
Stop bit 1 bit (fixed)
Transmission method HALF-DUPLEX/FULL-DUPLEX

NOTE • For connecting the projector to your devices, please read the manual for each devices, and connect them correctly with suitable cables.

- Turn off (the power of) both the projector and other devices and unplug, before connecting them.

- For details of Transmission method, refer to 6.4 Transmission method in the Network Guide.

RS-232C Communication / Network command table

Names Operation Type HeaderCommand Data
CRC Action Type Setting Code
PowerSetTurn off BE EF03 06 00 2AD3 0100 00 60 00 00
Turn on BE EF03 06 00 BAD2 0100 00 60 01 00
GetBE EF 0306 0019 D3 02 00 00 60 0000
[Example return]00 00 01 00 02 00[Off] [On] [Cool down]
Input SourceSetCOMPUTER IN1 BEEF 03 06 00FE D201 00 0020 00 00
COMPUTER IN2 BEEF 03 06 003E D001 00 0020 04 00
HDMI BE EF 0306 00 0ED2 0100 00 20 0300
S-VIDEOBE EF 0306 009E D3 01 00 00 20 0200
VIDEOBE EF 0306 006E D3 01 00 00 20 0100
LANBE EF0306 00CE D501 0000 200B 00
USB TYPE ABE EF0306 005E D101 0000 2006 00
USB TYPE BBE EF0306 00FE D701 0000 200C 00
GetBE EF0306 00CD D202 0000 2000 00
Error StatusGetBE EF 0306 00D9 D8 02 00 20 60 0000
[Example return]00 00 01 00 02 00 03 00[Normal] [Cover error] [Fan error] [Lamp error]04 00 05 00 07 00 08 00[Temp error] [Air flow error] [Cold error] [Filter error]
MAGNIFYGetBE EF 0306 007C D2 02 00 07 30 0000
IncrementBE EF 0306 001A D2 04 00 07 30 0000
DecrementBE EF 0306 00CB D3 05 00 07 30 0000
FREEZESetNORMALBE EF 0306 00B3 D2 01 00 02 30 0000
FREEZEBE EF 0306 0013 D3 01 00 02 30 0100
GetBE EF 0306 00B0 D2 02 00 02 30 0000
PICTURE MODESetNORMALBE EF0306 0023 F601 00BA 3000 00
CINEMABE EF 0306 00B3 F7 01 00 BA 3001 00
DYNAMICBE EF 0306 00E3 F4 01 00 BA 3004 00
BOARD(BLACK) BEEF 03 06 00E3 EF 01 00BA 3020 00
BOARD(GREEN)BE EF0306 0073 EE01 00BA 3021 00
WHITEBOARDBE EF 0306 00B3 EE 01 00 BA 3022 00
DAYTIMEBE EF0306 00E3 C701 00BA 3040 00
GetBE EF0306 0010 F602 00BA 3000 00
[Example return]00 00 01 00 04 00 10 00[Normal] [Cinema] [Dynamic] [Custom]20 00 21 00 22 00 40 00[BOARD(BLACK)] [BOARD(GREEN)] [WHITEBOARD] [DAY TIME]
BRIGHTNESSGetBE EF 0306 0089 D2 02 00 03 20 0000
IncrementBE EF 0306 00EF D2 04 00 03 20 0000
DecrementBE EF 0306 003E D3 05 00 03 20 0000
BRIGHTNESS ResetExecuteBE EF0306 0058 D306 0000 7000 00
CONTRASTGetBE EF 0306 00FD D3 02 00 04 20 0000
IncrementBE EF 0306 009B D3 04 00 04 20 0000
DecrementBE EF 0306 004A D2 05 00 04 20 0000
CONTRAST ResetExecuteBE EF0306 00A4 D206 0001 7000 00

(continued on next page)

RS-232C Communication / Network command table (continued)

Names Operation Type HeaderCommand Data
CRC Action Type Setting Code
GAMMASetDEFAULT-1BEEF 03060007E9 0100A1 30 2000
CUSTOM-1BEEF 03060007FD 0100A1 30 1000
DEFAULT-2BEEF 03060097E8 0100A1 30 2100
CUSTOM-2BEEF 03060097FC 0100A1 30 1100
DEFAULT-3BEEF 03060067E8 0100A1 30 2200
CUSTOM-3BEEF 03060067FC 0100A1 30 1200
DEFAULT-4BEEF 030600F7E9 0100A1 30 2300
CUSTOM-4BEEF 030600F7FD 0100A1 30 1300
DEFAULT-5BEEF 030600C7EB 0100A1 30 2400
CUSTOM-5BEEF 030600C7FF 0100A1 30 1400
DEFAULT-6BEEF 03060057EA 0100A1 30 2500
CUSTOM-6BEEF 03060057FE 0100A1 30 1500
GetBEEF 030600F4F0 0200A1 30 0000
User Gamma PatternSetOffBEEF 030600FBFA 010080 30 0000
9 steps gray scaleBEEF 0306006BFB 010080 30 0100
15 steps gray scaleBEEF 0306009BFB 010080 30 0200
RampBEEF 0306000BFA 010080 30 0300
GetBEEF 030600C8FA 020080 30 0000
User Gamma Point 1GetBEEF 03060008FE 020090 30 0000
IncrementBEEF 0306006EFE 040090 30 0000
DecrementBEEF 030600BFFF 050090 30 0000
User Gamma Point 1 ResetExecuteBEEF 03060058C2 060050 70 0000
User Gamma Point 2GetBEEF 030600F4FF 020091 30 0000
IncrementBEEF 03060092FF 040091 30 0000
DecrementBEEF 03060043FE 050091 30 0000
User Gamma Point 2 ResetExecuteBEEF 030600A4C3 060051 70 0000
User Gamma Point 3GetBEEF 030600B0FF 020092 30 0000
IncrementBEEF 030600D6FF 040092 30 0000
DecrementBEEF 03060007FE 050092 30 0000
User Gamma Point 3 ResetExecuteBEEF 030600E0C3 060052 70 0000
User Gamma Point 4GetBEEF 0306004CFE 020093 30 0000
IncrementBEEF 0306002AFE 040093 30 0000
DecrementBEEF 030600FBFF 050093 30 0000
User Gamma Point 4 ResetExecuteBEEF 0306001CC2 060053 70 0000
User Gamma Point 5GetBEEF 03060038FF 020094 30 0000
IncrementBEEF 0306005EFF 040094 30 0000
DecrementBEEF 0306008FFE 050094 30 0000
User Gamma Point 5 ResetExecuteBEEF 03060068C3 060054 70 0000
User Gamma Point 6GetBEEF 030600C4FE 020095 30 0000
IncrementBEEF 030600A2FE 040095 30 0000
DecrementBEEF 03060073FF 050095 30 0000
User Gamma Point 6 ResetExecuteBEEF 03060094C2 060055 70 0000
User Gamma Point 7GetBEEF 03060080FE 020096 30 0000
IncrementBEEF 030600E6FE 040096 30 0000
DecrementBEEF 03060037FF 050096 30 0000
User Gamma Point 7 ResetExecuteBEEF 030600D0C2 060056 70 0000

(continued on next page)

RS-232C Communication / Network command table (continued)

Names Operation Type HeaderCommand Data
CRC Action Type Setting Code
User Gamma Point 8Get BE EF 03 06 00 7C FF 02 00 97 30 00 00
Increment BE EF 03 06 00 1A FF 04 00 97 30 00 00
Decrement BE EF 03 06 00 CB FE 05 00 97 30 00 00
User Gamma Point 8 ResetExecute BE EF 03 06 00 2C 03 06 00 57 70 00 00
COLOR TEMPSet1 HIGH BE EF 03 06 00 0B F5 01 00 B0 30 03 00
1 CUSTOMBE EF 03 06 00 CB F8 01 00 B0 30 13 00
2 MIDBE EF 03 06 00 9B F4 01 00 B0 30 02 00
2 CUSTOMBE EF 03 06 00 5B F9 01 00 B0 30 12 00
3 LOWBE EF 03 06 00 6B F4 01 00 B0 30 01 00
3 CUSTOMBE EF 03 06 00 AB F9 01 00 B0 30 11 00
4 Hi-BRIGHT-1BE EF 03 06 00 3B F2 01 00 B0 30 08 00
4 CUSTOMBE EF 03 06 00 FB FF 01 00 B0 30 18 00
5 Hi-BRIGHT-2BE EF 03 06 00 AB F3 01 00 B0 30 09 00
5 CUSTOMBE EF 03 06 00 6B FE 01 00 B0 30 19 00
6 Hi-BRIGHT-3BE EF 03 06 00 5B F3 01 00 B0 30 0A 00
6 CUSTOMBE EF 03 06 00 9B FE 01 00 B0 30 1A 00
Get BE EF 03 06 00 C8 F5 02 00 B0 30 00 00
COLOR TEMP GAIN RGet BE EF 03 06 00 34 F4 02 00 B1 30 00 00
Increment BE EF 03 06 00 52 F4 04 00 B1 30 00 00
Decrement BE EF 03 06 00 83 F5 05 00 B1 30 00 00
COLOR TEMP GAIN R ResetExecute BE EF 03 06 00 10 C6 06 00 46 70 00 00
COLOR TEMP GAIN GGet BE EF 03 06 00 70 F4 02 00 B2 30 00 00
Increment BE EF 03 06 00 16 F4 04 00 B2 30 00 00
Decrement BE EF 03 06 00 C7 F5 05 00 B2 30 00 00
COLOR TEMP GAIN G ResetExecute BE EF 03 06 00 EC C7 06 00 47 70 00 00
COLOR TEMP GAIN BGet BE EF 03 06 00 8C F5 02 00 B3 30 00 00
Increment BE EF 03 06 00 EA F5 04 00 B3 30 00 00
Decrement BE EF 03 06 00 3B F4 05 00 B3 30 00 00
COLOR TEMP GAIN B ResetExecute BE EF 03 06 00 F8 C4 06 00 48 70 00 00
COLOR TEMP OFFSET RGet BE EF 03 06 00 04 F5 02 00 B5 30 00 00
Increment BE EF 03 06 00 62 F5 04 00 B5 30 00 00
Decrement BE EF 03 06 00 B3 F4 05 00 B5 30 00 00
COLOR TEMP OFFSET R ResetExecute BE EF 03 06 00 40 C5 06 00 4A 70 00 00
COLOR TEMP OFFSET GGet BE EF 03 06 00 40 F5 02 00 B6 30 00 00
Increment BE EF 03 06 00 26 F5 04 00 B6 30 00 00
Decrement BE EF 03 06 00 F7 F4 05 00 B6 30 00 00
COLOR TEMP OFFSET G ResetExecute BE EF 03 06 00 BC C4 06 00 4B 70 00 00
COLOR TEMP OFFSET BGet BE EF 03 06 00 BC F4 02 00 B7 30 00 00
Increment BE EF 03 06 00 DA F4 04 00 B7 30 00 00
Decrement BE EF 03 06 00 0B F5 05 00 B7 30 00 00
COLOR TEMP OFFSET B ResetExecute BE EF 03 06 00 C8 C5 06 00 4C 70 00 00

(continued on next page)

RS-232C Communication / Network command table (continued)

Names Operation Type HeaderCommand Data
CRC Action Type Setting Code
COLORGet BE EF 03 0600 B5 7202 00 0222 00 00
Increment BE EF 0306 00 D372 04 0002 22 0000
Decrement BE EF 0306 00 0273 05 0002 22 0000
COLOR Reset ExecuteGet BE EF 03 06 00 80 D0 0600 0A 7000 00
TINTGet BE EF 03 0600 49 7302 00 0322 00 00
Increment BE EF 0306 00 2F73 04 0003 22 0000
Decrement BE EF 0306 00 FE72 05 0003 22 0000
TINT Reset ExecuteGet BE EF 03 06 00 7C D1 0600 0B 70 0000
SHARPNESSGet BE EF 03 0600 F1 7202 00 0122 00 00
Increment BE EF 0306 00 9772 04 0001 22 0000
Decrement BE EF 0306 00 4673 05 0001 22 0000
SHARPNESS Reset ExecuteExecute BE EF 03 06 00 C4 D006 00 0970 00 00
MY MEMORY LoadSet1BE EF 0306 00OE D7 0100 14 20 0000
2BE EF 0306 009E D6 0100 14 20 0100
3BE EF 0306 006E D6 0100 14 20 0200
4BE EF 0306 00FE D701 00 14 2000 03 00
MY MEMORY SaveSet1BE EF 0306 00F2 D6 0100 15 20 0000
2BE EF 0306 0062 D7 0100 15 20 0100
3BE EF 0306 0092 D7 0100 15 20 0200
4BE EF 0306 0002 D6 0100 15 20 0300
ASPECTSet4:3BE EF 0306 009E D0 0100 08 20 0000
16:9BE EF 0306 00OE D1 0100 08 20 0100
14:9BE EF0306 00CE D601 0008 2009 00
16:10BE EF 0306 003E D6 0100 08 20 0A00
(*) NATIVEBE EF 0306 005E D7 0100 08 20 0800
NORMALBE EF0306 005E DD01 0008 2010 00
Get BE EF 03 0600 ADD002 00 0820 00 00
OVER SCANGet BE EF 03 0600 91 7002 00 0922 00 00
Increment BE EF 0306 00 F770 04 0009 22 0000
Decrement BE EF 0306 00 2671 05 0009 22 0000
OVER SCAN Reset ExecuteBE EF 0306 00EC D906 0027 70 00 00
V POSITIONGet BE EF 03 0600 0D 8302 00 0021 00 00
Increment BE EF 0306 00 6B83 04 0000 21 0000
Decrement BE EF 0306 00 BA82 05 0000 21 0000
V POSITION ResetExecuteBE EF 0306 00E0 D2 0600 02 70 0000
H POSITIONGet BE EF 03 0600 F1 8202 00 0121 00 00
Increment BE EF 0306 00 9782 04 0001 21 0000
Decrement BE EF 0306 00 4683 05 0001 21 0000
H POSITION ResetExecuteBE EF 0306 001C D306 00 0370 00 00
H PHASEGetBE EF 0306 0049 83 0200 03 21 0000
IncrementBE EF 0306 002F 83 0400 03 21 0000
DecrementBE EF 0306 00FE 82 0500 03 21 0000

(*) only for CPWX12WN
(continued on next page)

RS-232C Communication / Network command table (continued)

Names Operation Type HeaderCommand Data
CRC Action Type Setting Code
H SIZEGetBE EF 03 06 00B5 82 02 00 02 21 0000
IncrementBE EF 03 06 00D3 82 04 00 02 21 0000
DecrementBE EF 03 06 0002 83 05 00 02 21 0000
H SIZE Reset ExecuteBE EF 03 06 0068 D2 06 00 04 70 0000
AUTO ADJUST EXECUTEExecute BE EF 03 06 00 91 D0 06 000A 20 00 00
PROGRESSIVESetOFFBE EF 03 06 004A 72 01 00 07 22 0000
TVBE EF 03 06 00DA 73 01 00 07 22 0100
FILMBE EF 03 06 002A 73 01 00 07 22 0200
GetBE EF 03 06 0079 72 02 00 07 22 0000
VIDEO NRSetLOWBE EF 03 06 0026 72 01 00 06 22 0100
MIDBE EF 03 06 00D6 72 01 00 06 22 0200
HIGHBE EF 03 06 0046 73 01 00 06 22 0300
GetBE EF 03 06 0085 73 02 00 06 22 0000
COLOR SPACESetAUTOBE EF 03 06 000E 72 01 00 04 22 0000
RGBBE EF 03 06 009E 73 01 00 04 22 0100
SMPTE240BE EF 03 06 006E 73 01 00 04 22 0200
REC709BE EF 03 06 00FE 72 01 00 04 22 0300
REC601BE EF 03 06 00CE 70 01 00 04 22 0400
GetBE EF 03 06 003D 72 02 00 04 22 0000
S-VIDEO FORMATSetAUTOBE EF 03 06 00E6 70 01 00 12 22 0A00
NTSCBE EF 03 06 0086 74 01 00 12 22 0400
PALBE EF 03 06 0016 75 01 00 12 22 0500
SECAMBE EF 03 06 0016 70 01 00 12 22 0900
NTSC4.43BE EF 03 06 0026 77 01 00 12 22 0200
M-PALBE EF 03 06 0086 71 01 00 12 22 0800
N-PALBE EF 03 06 0076 74 01 00 12 22 0700
GetBE EF 03 06 0075 76 02 00 12 22 0000
C-VIDEO FORMATSetAUTOBE EF 03 06 00A2 70 01 00 11 22 0A00
NTSCBE EF 03 06 00C2 74 01 00 11 22 0400
PALBE EF 03 06 0052 75 01 00 11 22 0500
SECAMBE EF 03 06 0052 70 01 00 11 22 0900
NTSC4.43BE EF 03 06 0062 77 01 00 11 22 0200
M-PALBE EF 03 06 00C2 71 01 00 11 22 0800
N-PALBE EF 03 06 0032 74 01 00 11 22 0700
GetBE EF 03 06 0031 76 02 00 11 22 0000
HDMI FORMATSetAUTOBE EF 03 06 00BA 77 01 00 13 22 0000
VIDEOBE EF 03 06 002A 76 01 00 13 22 0100
COMPUTERBE EF 03 06 00DA 76 01 00 13 22 0200
GetBE EF 03 06 0089 77 02 00 13 22 0000
HDMI RANGESetAUTOBE EF 03 06 0086 D8 01 00 22 20 0000
NORMALBE EF 03 06 0016 D9 01 00 22 20 0100
ENHANCEDBE EF 03 06 00E6 D9 01 00 22 20 0200
GetBE EF 03 06 00B5 D8 02 00 22 20 0000
COMPUTER IN1SetAUTOBE EF 03 06 00CE D6 01 00 10 20 0300
SYNC ON G OFFBE EF 03 06 005E D7 01 00 10 20 0200
GetBE EF 03 06 00OD D6 02 00 10 20 0000
COMPUTER IN2SetAUTO BE EF 03060032D7010011 20 0300
SYNC ON G OFF BEEF030600A2D601 00 1120 02 00
Get BE EF 03 0600F1D70200120 00 00
FRAME LOCK - COMPUTER IN1SetOFFBEEF0306003BC2 0100 50 30 0000
ONBEEF030600ABC3 0100 50 30 0100
GetBEEF03060008C2 0200 50 30 0000
FRAME LOCK - COMPUTER IN2SetOFF BE EF 0306000BC3010054 30 0000
ON BE EF 0306009BC2010054 30 0100
Get BE EF 03 060038C302005430 00 00
FRAME LOCK - HDMISetOFFBEEF0306007FC2 0100 53 30 0000
ONBEEF030600EFC3 0100 53 30 0100
GetBEEF0306004CC2 0200 53 30 0000
AUTO KEYSTONE EXECUTEExecute BE EF 030600E5D106000D 2000 00
KEYSTONE VGetBEEF030600B9D3 0200 07 20 0000
IncrementBEEF030600DFD3 0400 07 20 0000
DecrementBEEF030600OED2 0500 07 20 0000
KEYSTONE V ResetExecuteBEEF03060008D0 0600 0C 7000 00
AUTO ECO MODESetOFFBEEF030600FB27 0100 10 33 0000
ONBEEF0306006B26 0100 10 33 0100
GetBEEF030600C827 0200 10 33 0000
ECO MODESetNORMALBEEF0306003B23 0100 00 33 0000
ECOBEEF030600AB22 0100 00 33 0100
INTELLIGENT ECOBEEF030600FB2E 0100 00 33 1000
GetBEEF0306000823 0200 00 33 0000
INSTALLATIONSetFRONT / DESKTOPBEEF030600C7D2 0100 01 30 0000
REAR / DESKTOPBEEF03060057D3 0100 01 30 0100
REAR / CEILINGBEEF030600A7D3 0100 01 30 0200
FRONT / CEILINGBEEF03060037D2 0100 01 30 0300
GetBEEF030600F4D2 0200 01 30 0000
STANDBY MODESetNORMALBEEF030600D6D2 0100 01 60 0000
SAVINGBEEF03060046D3 0100 01 60 0100
GetBEEF030600E5D2 0200 01 60 0000
MONITOR OUT - COMPUTER IN1SetCOMPUTER IN1BEEF0306003EF4 0100 B0 2000 00
OFFBEEF030600CEB5 0100 B0 20FF 00
GetBEEF030600ODF4 0200 B0 20 0000
MONITOR OUT - COMPUTER IN2SetCOMPUTER IN2BEEF030600CEF7 0100 B4 20 0400
OFF BE EF 030600FEB4 0100B4 20FF 00
Get BE EF 03 06003DF5D200B4 20 00 00
MONITOR OUT - S-VIDEOSetCOMPUTER IN1BEEF03060086F5 0100 B2 2000 00
COMPUTER IN2BEEF03060046F7 0100 B2 2004 00
OFFBEEF03060076B4 0100 B2 20FF 00
GetBEEF030600B5F5 0200 B2 2000 00
MONITOR OUT - VIDEOSetCOMPUTER IN1BEEF030600C2F5 0100 B1 20 0000
COMPUTER IN2BEEF03060002F7 0100 B1 2004 00
OFFBEEF03060032B4 0100 B1 20FF 00
GetBEEF030600F1F502 00 B1 20 00 00
MONITOR OUT - HDMISetCOMPUTER IN1BE EF 03 06 007A F4 01 00 B3 20 0000
COMPUTER IN2 BEEF 03 06 00 BA F601 00 B3 20 04 00
OFFBE EF 03 06 008A B5 01 00 B3 20 FF00
GetBE EF 03 06 0049 F4 02 00 B3 20 0000
MONITOR OUT - LANSetCOMPUTER IN1 BEEF 03 06 00 1A F601 00 BB 20 00 00
COMPUTER IN2 BEEF 03 06 00 DA F401 00 BB 20 04 00
OFF BE EF 03 06 00 EA B7 01 00 BB 20 FF00
Get BE EF 03 06 00 29 F6 02 00 BB 20 00 00
MONITOR OUT - USB TYPE ASetCOMPUTER IN1 BEEF 03 06 00 B6 F401 00 B6 20 00 00
COMPUTER IN2 BEEF 03 06 00 76 F601 00 B6 20 04 00
OFF BE EF 03 06 00 46 B5 01 00 B6 20 FF00
Get BE EF 03 06 00 85 F4 02 00 B6 20 00 00
MONITOR OUT - USB TYPE BSetCOMPUTER IN1 BEEF 03 06 00 6E F701 00 BC 20 00 00
COMPUTER IN2 BEEF 03 06 00 AE F501 00 BC 20 04 00
OFF BE EF 03 06 00 9E B6 01 00 BC 20 FF00
Get BE EF 03 06 00 5D F7 02 00 BC 20 00 00
MONITOR OUT - STANDBYSetCOMPUTER IN1BE EF 03 06 002A F7 01 00 BF 20 0000
COMPUTER IN2 BEEF 03 06 00 EA F501 00 BF 20 04 00
OFFBE EF 03 06 00DA B6 01 00 BF 20 FF00
GetBE EF 03 06 0019 F7 02 00 BF 20 0000
VOLUME - COMPUTER IN1GetBE EF 03 06 00CD CC 02 00 60 2000 00
IncrementBE EF 03 06 00AB CC 04 0060 20 00 00
DecrementBE EF 03 06 007A CD 05 00 60 20 0000
VOLUME - COMPUTER IN2Get BE EF 03 06 00 FD CD02 00 64 20 00 00
Increment BE EF 03 06 00 9B CD 04 00 64 2000 00
DecrementBE EF 03 06 004A CC 05 00 64 20 0000
VOLUME - S-VIDEOGetBE EF 03 06 0075 CD 02 00 62 20 0000
IncrementBE EF 03 06 0013 CD 04 00 62 20 0000
DecrementBE EF 03 06 00C2 CC 05 00 62 20 00 00
VOLUME - VIDEOGetBE EF 03 06 0031 CD 02 00 61 20 0000
IncrementBE EF 03 06 0057 CD 04 00 61 20 0000
DecrementBE EF 03 06 0086 CC 05 00 61 20 0000
VOLUME - HDMIGetBE EF 03 06 0089 CC 02 00 63 20 0000
IncrementBE EF 03 06 00EF CC 04 00 63 20 00 00
DecrementBE EF 03 06 003E CD 05 00 63 20 00 00
VOLUME - LANGet BE EF 03 06 00 E9 CE 02 00 6B 20 00 00
Increment BE EF 03 06 00 8F CE 04 00 6B 20 0000
DecrementBE EF 03 06 005E CF 05 00 6B 20 0000
VOLUME - USB TYPE AGet BE EF 03 06 00 45 CC 02 00 66 20 00 00
Increment BE EF 03 06 00 23 CC 04 00 66 2000 00
DecrementBE EF 03 06 00F2 CD 05 00 66 20 0000
VOLUME - USB TYPE BGet BE EF 03 06 00 9D CF 02 00 6C 20 00 00
Increment BE EF 03 06 00 FB CF 04 00 6C 20 0000
DecrementBE EF 03 06 002A CE 05 00 6C 20 0000
VOLUME - AUDIO OUT STANDBYGetBE EF 03 06 00D9 CF 02 00 6F 20 0000
IncrementBE EF 03 06 00BF CF 04 00 6F 20 0000
DecrementBE EF 03 06 006E CE 05 00 6F 20 0000
MUTESetOFF BE EF 03 06 00 46 D3 01 00 02 20 00 00
ON BE EF 03 06 00 D6 D2 01 00 02 20 01 00
Get BE EF 03 06 00 75 D3 D2 00 02 20 00 00
SPEAKERSetON BE EF 03 06 00 FE D4 01 00 1C 20 01 00
OFF BE EF 03 06 00 6E D5 01 00 1C 20 00 00
Get BE EF 03 06 00 5D D5 02 00 1C 20 00 00
AUDIO SOURCE - COMPUTER IN1SetAUDIO IN1 BE EF 03 06 00 6E DC 01 00 30 20 01 00
AUDIO IN2 BE EF 03 06 00 9E DC 01 00 30 20 02 00
OFF BE EF 03 06 00 FE DD 01 00 30 20 00 00
Get BE EF 03 06 00 CD DD 02 00 30 20 00 00
AUDIO SOURCE - COMPUTER IN2SetAUDIO IN1 BE EF 03 06 00 5E DD 01 00 34 20 01 00
AUDIO IN2 BE EF 03 06 00 AE DD 01 00 34 20 02 00
OFF BE EF 03 06 00 CE DC 01 00 34 20 00 00
Get BE EF 03 06 00 FD DC 02 00 34 20 00 00
AUDIO SOURCE - HDMISetOFF BE EF 03 06 00 BA DD 01 00 33 20 00 00
AUDIO IN1 BE EF 03 06 00 2A DC 01 00 33 20 01 00
AUDIO IN2 BE EF 03 06 00 DA DC 01 00 33 20 02 00
AUDIO_HDMI BE EF 03 06 00 7A C4 01 00 33 20 20 00
Get BE EF 03 06 00 89 DD 02 00 33 20 00 00
AUDIO SOURCE - S-VIDEOSetAUDIO IN1 BE EF 03 06 00 D6 DD 01 00 32 20 01 00
AUDIO IN2 BE EF 03 06 00 26 DD 01 00 32 20 02 00
OFF BE EF 03 06 00 46 DC 01 00 32 20 00 00
Get BE EF 03 06 00 75 DC 02 00 32 20 00 00
AUDIO SOURCE - VIDEOSetAUDIO IN1 BE EF 03 06 00 92 DD 01 00 31 20 01 00
AUDIO IN2 BE EF 03 06 00 62 DD 01 00 31 20 02 00
OFF BE EF 03 06 00 02 DC 01 00 31 20 00 00
Get BE EF 03 06 00 31 DC 02 00 31 20 00 00
AUDIO SOURCE - LANSetOFF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BEEF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EF BE EFEFBEEFBEEFBEEFBEEFBEEFBEEFBEEFBEEFBEEFBEEFBEEFBEEFBEEFBEEFBEEFBEEFBEEFBEEFBEEFBEEFBEEFBEEFBEEFBEEFBEEFBEEFBEEFBEEFBEEFBEEFBEEFBEEFBEEFBEEFBEEFBEEFBEEFBEEFBEEFBEEFBEEFBEEFBEEFBEEFBEEFBEEFBEEFBEEFBEEFBEEFBEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEBFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFEFLFEFLFEFLFEFLFEFLFEFLFEFLFEFLFEFLFEFLFEFLFEFLFEFLFEFLFEFLFEFLFEFLFEFLFEFLFEFLFEFLFEFLFEFLFEFLFEFLFEFLFEFLFEFLFEFLFEFLFEFLFEFLFEFLFEFLFEFLFEFLFEFLFEFLFEFLFEFLFEFLFEFLFEFLFEFLFEFLFEFLFEFLFEFLFEFLFEFLFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELLFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEENFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEERFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEESFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEETFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEENTFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFELEFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELEFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELEFEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEEFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELLFEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEELFEEPFLFEEPFLFEEPFLFEEPFLFEEPFLFEEPFLFEEPFLFEEPFLFEEPFLFEEPFLFEEPFLFEEPFLFEEPFLFEEPFLFEEPFLFEEPFLFEEPFLFEEPFLFEEPFLFEEPFLFEEPFLFEEPFLFEEPFLFEEPFLFEEPFLFEEPFLFEEPFLFEEPFLFEEPFLFEEPFLFEEPFLFEEPFLFEEPFLFEEPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFP FLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFL GFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGPPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPPLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLGFPFLTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEEL TGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELL TGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGELLTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELL TTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTGELLTTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGELLTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTTGEELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGGELTGCFFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCF CFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCEFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFGFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFC FCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFC FCGFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFSBCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFCFTCEALNANNANNANNANNANNANNANNANNANNANNANNANNANNANNANNANNANNANNANNANNANNANNANNANNANNANNANNANNANNANNANNANNANNANNANNANNANNANNANNANNANNANNANNANNANNANNANNANNANNANNANNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNN

(continued on next page)

RS-232C Communication / Network command table (continued)

Names Operation Type HeaderCommand Data
CRC Action Type Setting Code
USB TYPE B SOUND ENABLESetDisable BE EF 03 06 00 32F0 01 00A5 20 00 00
Enable BE EF 03 06 00 A2F1 01 00A5 20 01 00
Get BE EF 03 06 00 01 F0 02 00 A5 20 00 00
HDMI AUDIOSet1BE EF0306 00AE C601 0040 2001 00
2 BE EF 03 06 00 5E C601 0040 2002 00
GetBE EF0306 000D C702 0040 2000 00
LANGUAGE *SetENGLISHBE EF0306 00F7 D301 0005 3000 00
FRANÇAISBE EF0306 0067 D201 0005 3001 00
DEUTSCHBE EF0306 0097 D201 0005 3002 00
ESPAÑOLBE EF0306 0007 D301 0005 3003 00
ITALIANOBE EF0306 0037 D101 0005 3004 00
NORSKBE EF0306 00A7 D001 0005 3005 00
NEDERLANDSBE EF0306 0057 D001 0005 3006 00
PORTUGUÉSBE EF0306 00C7 D101 0005 3007 00
日本語BE EF0306 0037 D401 0005 3008 00
简体中文BE EF 03 06 00A7 D5 01 0005 3009 00
繁體中文BE EF 03 06 0037 DE 01 0005 3010 00
한글BE EF0306 0057 D501 0005 300A 00
SVENSKABE EF0306 00C7 D401 0005 300B 00
PYCCKINÍBE EF0306 00F7 D601 0005 300C 00
SUOMIBE EF0306 0067 D701 0005 300D 00
POLSKIBE EF0306 0097 D701 0005 300E 00
TÜRKÇEBE EF0306 0007 D601 0005 300F 00
DANSKBE EF0306 00A7 DF01 0005 3011 00
ČESKYBE EF0306 0057 DF01 0005 3012 00
MAGYARBE EF0306 00C7 DE01 0005 3013 00
ROMÁNÁBE EF0306 00F7 DC01 0005 3014 00
SLOVENSKIBE EF0306 0067 DD01 0005 3015 00
HRVATSKIBE EF0306 0097 DD01 0005 3016 00
EÀAHNIKABE EF0306 0007 DC01 0005 3017 00
LIETUVIUBE EF0306 00F7 D901 0005 3018 00
EESTIBE EF0306 0067 D801 0005 3019 00
LATVIEŠUBE EF0306 0097 D801 0005 301A 00
ITIYIBE EF0306 0007 D901 0005 301B 00
کیب رعلا قغلاBE EF 03 06 0037 DB 01 0005 301Q 00
کسیفBE EF0306 00A7 DA01 0005 301D 00
PORTUGUÉS BRA BE EF 03 0600 57DA 01 0005 301E 00
BAHASA INDBE EF0306 00 C7 DB 01 00 05 30 1F 00
TIENG VIETBE EF0306 0037 CA01 0005 3020 00
GetBE EF0306 00C4 D302 0005 3000 00
MENU POSITION HGetBE EF0306 0004 D702 0015 3000 00
IncrementBE EF0306 0062 D704 0015 3000 00
DecrementBE EF0306 00B3 D605 0015 3000 00
MENU POSITION H ResetExecuteBE EF0306 00DC C606 0043 7000 00

* Not all of the languages in the table are supported. (continued on next page)

RS-232C Communication / Network command table (continued)

Names Operation Type HeaderCommand Data
CRC Action Type Setting Code
MENU POSITION VGet BE EF 03 0600 40 D7D2 001630 0000
Increment BE EF 0306 00 26D7 04001630 0000
Decrement BE EF 0306 00 F7D6 05001630 0000
MENU POSITION V ResetExecute BE EF 0306 00 A8C7 06004470 0000
BLANKSetMyScreen BE EF03 06 00FBCA0100 003020 00
ORIGINALBE EF 0306 00FBE2 01000030 4000
BLUEBE EF 0306 00CBD3 01000030 0300
WHITEBE EF 0306 006BD0 01000030 0500
BLACKBE EF 0306 009BD0 01000030 0600
Get BE EF 03 0600 08 D3D2 000030 0000
BLANK On/OffSetOFFBE EF 0306 00FBD8 01002030 0000
ONBE EF 0306 006BD9 01002030 0100
Get BE EF 03 0600 C8 D8D2 002030 0000
START UPSetMyScreen BE EF03 06 00CBCB0100 043020 00
ORIGINALBE EF 0306 000BD2 01000430 0000
OFFBE EF 0306 009BD3 01000430 0100
Get BE EF 03 0600 38 D2D2 000430 0000
MyScreen LockSetOFFBE EF 0306 003BEF 0100C03000 00
ONBE EF030600AB EE01 00C0 3001 00
Get BE EF 03 0600 08 EFD2 00C03000 00
MESSAGESetOFFBE EF 0306 008FD6 01001730 0000
ONBE EF 0306 001FD7 01001730 0100
Get BE EF 03 0600 BC D6D2 00173000 00
TEMPLATESetTEST PATTERNBE EF 0306 0043D9 01002230 0000
DOT-LINE1BE EF 0306 00D3D8 01002230 0100
DOT-LINE2BE EF 0306 0023D8 01002230 0200
DOT-LINE3BE EF 0306 00B3D9 01002230 0300
DOT-LINE4BE EF 0306 00B3DB 01002230 0400
CIRCLE 1BE EF 0306 0013DA 01002230 0500
CIRCLE 2BE EF 0306 00E3DA 01002230 0600
MAP 1BE EF03060083 D401 0022 3010 00
MAP 2BE EF03060013 D501 0022 3011 00
Get BE EF 03 0600 70 D9D2 002230 0000
TEMPLATE On/OffSetOFFBE EF 0306 00BFD8 01002330 0000
ONBE EF 0306 002FD9 01002330 0100
Get BE EF 03 0600 8C D8D2 002330 0000
C. C. - DISPLAYSetOFFBE EF030600FA 6201 0000 3700 00
ONBE EF0306006A 6301 0000 3701 00
AUTOBE EF0306009A 6301 0000 3702 00
Get BE EF 03 0600 C9 62D2 000037 0000
C. C. - MODESetCAPTIONSBE EF 0306 000663 01000137 0000
TEXTBE EF 0306 009662D1 000137 0100
Get BE EF 03 0600 3563 02000137 0000
C. C. - CHANNELSet1BE EF 0306 00D262 01000237 0100
2BE EF 0306 002262D1 000237 0200
3BE EF 0306 00B263D1 000237 0300
4BE EF 0306 008261D1 000237 0400
GetBE EF 0306 007163D2 000237 0000

(continued on next page)

RS-232C Communication / Network command table (continued)

Names Operation Type HeaderCommand Data
CRC Action Type Setting Code
AUTO SEARCHSetOFF BE EF 0306 00 B6D6 0100 16 20 0000
ON BE EF 0306 00 26D7 0100 16 20 0100
Get BE EF 03 0600 85 D602 0016 20 00 00
AUTO KEYSTONESetOFF BE EF 0306 00 EAD1 0100 0F 20 0000
ON BE EF 0306 00 7AD0 0100 0F 20 0100
Get BE EF 03 0600 D9 D102 000F 20 00 00
DIRECT POWER ONSetOFF BE EF 0306 00 3BB9 0100 20 31 0000
ON BE EF 0306 00 ABB8 0100 20 31 0100
Get BE EF 03 0600 08 8902 0020 31 00 00
AUTO POWER OFFGet BE EF 03 0600 08 8602 0010 31 00 00
Increment BE EF 0306 00 6EB6 0400 10 31 0000
Decrement BE EF 0306 00 BFB7 0500 10 31 0000
USB TYPE BSetMOUSEBE EF0306 00FF 2301 0050 2600 00
USB DISPLAYBE EF0306 006F 2201 0050 2601 00
GetBE EF0306 00CC 2302 0050 2600 00
LAMP TIMEGet BE EF 03 0600 C2 FF02 0090 10 00 00
LAMP TIME ResetExecuteBE EF0306 0058 DC06 0030 7000 00
FILTER TIMEGet BE EF 03 0600 C2 F002 00A0 10 00 00
FILTER TIME ResetExecuteBE EF0306 0098 C606 0040 7000 00
MY BUTTON-1SetCOMPUTER IN1 BEEF 03 0600 3A38 01 00 00B6 00 00
COMPUTER IN2BE EF0306 00FA 3101 0000 3604 00
HDMIBE EF 0306 00CA 33 0100 00 36 0300
S-VIDEOBE EF 0306 005A 32 0100 00 36 0200
VIDEOBE EF 0306 00AA 32 0100 00 36 0100
LAN BE EF 0306 00 0A 3401 00 00 360B 00
USB TYPE ABE EF0306 009A 3001 0000 3606 00
USB TYPE BBE EF0306 003A 3601 0000 360C 00
INFORMATIONBE EF 0306 00FA 3E 0100 00 36 1000
AUTO KEYSTONE BEEF 03 0600 6A3F 01 00 003611 00
MY MEMORYBE EF 0306 009A 3F 0100 00 36 1200
PICTURE MODEBE EF 0306 000A 3E 0100 00 36 1300
FILTER RESETBE EF 0306 003A 3C 0100 00 36 1400
AV MUTEBE EF 0306 00AA 38 0100 00 36 1900
TEMPLATEBE EF 0306 00CA 39 0100 00 36 1B00
RESOLUTIONBE EF 0306 009A 3A 0100 00 36 1E00
ECO MODEBE EF 0306 000A 25 0100 00 36 3700
MY IMAGEBE EF0306 005A 3D01 0000 3616 00
SLIDESHOWBE EF0306 009A 2B01 0000 3622 00
MESSENGERBE EF0306 00AA 2901 0000 3625 00
Get BE EF 03 0600 09 3302 00 0036 00 00
MY BUTTON-2SetCOMPUTER IN1 BEEF 03 06 00C6 3201 00 0136 00 00
COMPUTER IN2 BEEF 03 06 0006 3001 00 01 3604 00
HDMI BE EF 03 06 00 3632 0100 01 36 0300
S-VIDEO BE EF03 06 00 A633 0100 01 36 0200
VIDEO BE EF03 06 00 5633 0100 01 36 0100
LANBE EF0306 00F6 3501 0001 360B 00
USB TYPE ABE EF 0306 0066 31 01 0001 36 06 00
USB TYPE BBE EF0306 00C6 3701 0001 360C 00
INFORMATIONBE EF0306 0006 3F01 0001 3610 00
AUTO KEYSTONE BEEF 03 060096 3E 0100 01 3611 00
MY MEMORYBE EF0306 0066 3E01 0001 3612 00
PICTURE MODEBE EF0306 00F6 3F01 0001 3613 00
FILTER RESETBE EF 0306 00C6 3D 0100 01 36 1400
AV MUTEBE EF 0306 0056 39 0100 01 36 19 00
TEMPLATEBE EF 0306 0036 38 0100 01 36 1B 00
RESOLUTIONBE EF0306 0066 3B01 0001 361E 00
ECO MODE BE EF03 06 00F624 0100 01 36 3700
MY IMAGEBE EF0306 00A6 3C01 0001 3616 00
SLIDESHOWBE EF0306 0066 2A01 0001 3622 00
MESSENGERBE EF0306 0056 2801 0001 3625 00
GetBE EF0306 00F5 3202 0001 3600 00
MY BUTTON-ECOSetCOMPUTER IN1BE EF0306 005A 3101 0008 3600 00
COMPUTER IN2 BEEF 0306 009A 3301 00 08 36 0400
HDMI BE EF 0306 00 AA31 0100 0836 03 00
S-VIDEOBE EF0306 003A 3001 0008 3602 00
VIDEO BE EF03 06 00 CA30 0100 0836 01 00
LANBE EF0306 006A 3601 0008 360B 00
USB TYPE ABE EF0306 00FA 3201 0008 3606 00
USB TYPE BBE EF0306 005A 3401 0008 360C 00
INFORMATIONBE EF 0306 009A 3C 0100 0836 10 00
AUTO KEYSTONE BEEF 03 0600 0A8D 01 00 083611 00
MY MEMORYBE EF 0306 00FA 3D 0100 0836 12 00
PICTURE MODEBE EF0306 006A 3C01 0008 3613 00
FILTER RESETBE EF 0306 005A 3E 0100 08 36 1400
AV MUTEBE EF 0306 00CA 3A 0100 0836 19 00
TEMPLATEBE EF0306 00AA 3B01 0008 361B 00
RESOLUTIONBE EF0306 00FA 3801 0008 361E 00
ECO MODE BE EF03 06 006A27 01 00 0B36 37 00
MY IMAGEBE EF 0306 00 3A 3F01 00 08 3616 00
SLIDESHOWBE EF0306 00FA 2901 0008 3622 00
MESSENGERBE EF0306 00CA 2B01 0008 3625 00
BLANKBE EF0306 009A 0001 0008 3640 00
FREEZEBE EF0306 000A 0101 0008 3641 00
VOLUMEBE EF0306 00FA 0101 0008 3642 00
AUTOBE EF0306 006A 0001 0008 3643 00
GetBE EF 0306 0069 31 02 0D08 36 00 00

(continued on next page)

RS-232C Communication / Network command table (continued)

Names Operation Type HeaderCommand Data
CRC Action Type Setting Code
MY SOURCESetCOMPUTER IN1 BEEF 03 06 00FA 3801 00 2036 00 00
COMPUTER IN2 BEEF 03 06 003A 3A01 00 20 3604 00
HDMI BE EF 0306 00 0A38 0100 20 36 0300
S-VIDEO BE EF03 06 00 9A39 0100 20 36 0200
VIDEOBE EF 0306 006A 39 01 0020 36 0100
LANBE EF 0306 00CA 3F 01 0020 360B 00
USB TYPE ABE EF 0306 005A 3B 01 0020 36 06 00
USB TYPE BBE EF 0306 00FA 3D 01 0020 360C 00
GetBE EF 0306 00C9 3802 00 20 3600 00
Magnify Position HGetBE EF 0306 00C8 D7 0200 10 30 0000
IncrementBE EF 0306 00AE D7 0400 10 30 0000
DecrementBE EF0306 007F D605 0010 3000 00
Magnify Position VGetBE EF 0306 0034 D602 00 11 3000 00
IncrementBE EF0306 0052 D604 0011 3000 00
DecrementBE EF 0306 0083 D705 00 11 3000 00
MY IMAGESetOFFBE EF 0306 003A C3 01 0000 35 00 00
IMAGE-1BE EF 0306 00AA C201 00 00 3501 00
IMAGE-2BE EF 0306 005A C2 01 0000 35 02 00
IMAGE-3BE EF0306 00CA C301 0000 3503 00
IMAGE-4BE EF 0306 00FA C101 00 00 3504 00
GetBE EF 0306 0009 C3 02 0000 35 00 00
MY IMAGE IMAGE-1 DeleteExecuteBE EF 0306 0071 C3 06 0001 35 00 00
MY IMAGE IMAGE-2 DeleteExecuteBE EF 0306 0035 C3 06 0002 35 00 00
MY IMAGE IMAGE-3 DeleteExecuteBE EF0306 00C9 C206 0003 3500 00
MY IMAGE IMAGE-4 DeleteExecuteBE EF0306 00BD C306 0004 3500 00
VOLUME - ALLGetBE EF 0306 00CD C302 00 50 2000 00
IncrementBE EF0306 00AB C304 0050 2000 00
DecrementBE EF 0306 007A C205 00 50 2000 00

PJLink command

CommandsControl Description Parameter or Response
POWR Power ControlPower Control0 = Standby
1 = Power On
POWR ? Power Status inquiryPower Status inquiry0 = Standby
1 = Power On
2 = Cool Down
INPT Input Source selectionSource selection11 = COMPUTER IN 1
12 = COMPUTER IN 2
22 = S-VIDEO
23 = VIDEO
31 = HDMI
41 = USB TYPE A
51 = LAN
52 = USB TYPE B
INPT ? Input Source inquirySource inquiry11 = COMPUTER IN 1
12 = COMPUTER IN 2
22 = S-VIDEO
23 = VIDEO
31 = HDMI
41 = USB TYPE A
51 = LAN
52 = USB TYPE B
AVMT AVMute10 = BLANK off
11 = BLANK on
20 = Mute off
21 = Mute on
30 = AV Mute off
31 = AV Mute on
AVMT ? AVMute inquiry10 = BLANK off
11 = BLANK on
20 = Mute off
21 = Mute on
30 = AV Mute off
31 = AV Mute on

(continued on next page)

CommandsControl Description Parameter or Response
ERST ? Error Status inquiry1st byte: Refers to Fan error; one of 0 to 2
2nd byte: Refers to Lamp error; one of 0 to 2
3rd byte: Refers to Temptrature error; one of 0 to 2
4th byte: Refers to Cover error; one of 0 to 2
5th byte: Refers to Filter error; one of 0 to 2
6th byte: Refers to Other error; one of 0 to 2
The meaning of 0 to 2 is as given below
0 = Error is not detected; 1 = Warning; 2 = Error
LAMP ? Lamp Status inquiry1st number (digits 1 to 5): Lamp Time
2nd number : 0 = Lamp off, 1 = Lamp on
INST ? Input Source List inquiry 11 1222 23 31 41 51 52
NAME ? Projector Name inquiryResponds with the name set in "PROJECTOR NAME" of "NETWORK"
INF1 ?Manufacturer's Name inquiryHITACHI
INF2 ? Model Name inquiryYour model name, "CPX10WN", "CPX11WN" or "CPWX12WN".
INFO ? Other Information inquiryResponds with the factory information and so on
CLSS ? Class Information inquiry 1

NOTE • The password used in PJLink™ is the same as the password set in the Web Brouwser Comtrol. To use PJLink™ without authentication, do not set any password in Web Browser Control.

- For specifications of PJLink™, see the web site of the Japan Business Machine and Information System Industries Association.

User's Manual (concise)

Thank you for purchasing this projector.

Please read through this manual before using this product, in order to use safely and utilize well the product.

⚠ WARNING ▶ Before using this product, be sure to read all manuals for this product. After reading them, store them in a safe place for future reference.

▶Heed all the warnings and cautions in the manuals or on the product.
▶ Follow all the instructions in the manuals or on the product.

NOTE • In this manual, unless any comments are accompanied, “the manuals” means all the documents provided with this product, and “the product” means this projector and all the accessories came with the projector.

Contents

[Non-Text]

First of all.... 2

Entries and graphical symbols explanation .....2

Important safety instruction ....2

Regulatory notices.... 3

About Electro-Magnetic Interference ....3

About Waste Electrical and Electronic Equipment...4

Contents of package.... 4

Preparing for the remote control...... 5

Arrangement.... 6

Connecting with your devices...... 7

Fastening the adapter cover...... 8

[Non-Text]

Connecting power supply 8

Turning on the power.... 9

Adjusting the projector's elevator ..... 10

Displaying the picture 11

Turning off the power.... 12

Replacing the lamp.... 13

Cleaning and replacing the air filter .. 15

Using the CD manual 16

Specifications 17

Troubleshooting

- Warranty and after-service ..... 18

First of all

Entries and graphical symbols explanation

The following entries and graphical symbols are used for the manuals and the product as follows, for safety purpose. Please know their meanings beforehand, and heed them.

⚠ WARNING This entry warns of a risk of serious personal injury or even death.

⚠️CAUTION This entry warns of a risk of personal injury or physical damage.

NOTICE This entry notices of fear of causing trouble.

Important safety instruction

The followings are important instructions for safely using the product. Be sure to follow them always when handling the product. The manufacturer assumes no responsibility for any damage caused by mishandling that is beyond normal usage defined in these manuals of this projector.

⚠ WARNING ▶ Never use the product in or after an abnormality (ex. giving off smoke, smelling strange, took a liquid or an object inside, broken, etc.) If an abnormality should occur, unplug the projector urgently.

▶ Situate the product away from children and pets.

▶ Keep small parts away from children and pets. If swallowed, consult a physician immediately for emergency treatment.

▶ Do not use the product when there is fear of a thunderbolt.

▶ Unplug the projector from the power outlet if the projector is not used for the time being.

▶ Do not open or remove any portion of the product, unless the manuals direct it. For internal maintenance, leave it to your dealer or their service personnel.

▶ Use only the accessories specified or recommended by the manufacturer.

▶ Do not modify the projector or accessories.

▶ Do not let any things or any liquids enter to the inside of the product.

▶ Do not wet the product.

▶ Do not place the projector where any oils, such as cooking or machine oil, are used. Oil may harm the product, resulting in malfunction, or falling from the mounted position.

▶ Do not apply a shock or pressure to this product.

- Do not place the product on an unstable place such as the uneven surface or the leaned table.

- Do not place the product unstably. Place the projector so that it does not protrude from the surface where the projector is placed on.

- Remove all the attachments including the power cord and cables, from the projector when carrying the projector.

▶ Do not look into the lens and the openings on the projector, while the lamp is on.

▶ Do not approach the lamp cover and the exhaust vents, while the projection lamp is on. Also after the lamp goes out, do not approach them for a while, since too hot.

Regulatory notices

About Electro-Magnetic Interference

In CANADA

This Class B digital apparatus complies with Canadian ICES-003.

In the US, and other places where the FCC regulations are applicable

Declaration of Conformity

Trade name HITACHI

Model Number CPX10WN, CPX11WN, CPWX12WN

Responsible Party Hitachi America, Ltd.

Address 900 Hitachi way, Chula Vista, CA 91914-3556 U.S.A.

Telephone Number +1 -800-225-1741

This device complies with part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation. This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device, pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules.

These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference in a residential installation. This equipment generates, uses, and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instructions, may cause harmful interference to radio communications. However, there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular installation. If this equipment does cause harmful interference to radio or television reception, which can be determined by turning the equipment off and on, the user is encouraged to try to correct the interference by one or more of the following measures:

  • Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.
  • Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver.
  • Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different from that to which the receiver is connected.
  • Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/TV technician for help.

INSTRUCTIONS TO USERS: This equipment complies with the requirements of FCC (Federal Communication Commission) equipment provided that the following conditions are met. Some cables have to be used with the core set. Use the accessory cable or a designated-type cable for the connection. For cables that have a core only at one end, connect the core to the projector.

CAUTION: Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user's authority to operate the equipment.

Regulatory notices (continued)

About Waste Electrical and Electronic Equipment

HITACHI CPX10WN - About Waste Electrical and Electronic Equipment - 1

The mark is in compliance with the Waste Electrical and Electronic Equipment Directive 2002/96/EC (WEEE).

The mark indicates the requirement NOT to dispose the equipment including any spent or discarded batteries or accumulators as unsorted municipal waste, but use the return and collection systems available. If the batteries or accumulators included with this equipment, display the chemical symbol Hg, Cd, or Pb, then it means that the battery has a heavy metal content of more than 0.0005% Mercury or more than, 0.002% Cadmium, or more than 0.004% Lead.

Contents of package

Your projector should come with the items shown below. Check that all the items are included. Require of your dealer immediately if any items are missing.

(1) Remote control with two AA batteries
(2) Power cord
(3) Computer cable
(4) Adapter cover
(5) Lens cover
(6) User's manuals (Book x1, CD x1)
(7) Security label
(8) Application CD
(9) Soft case

HITACHI CPX10WN - Contents of package - 1

natural_image Illustration of a remote control with scroll roll (no text or symbols)

HITACHI CPX10WN - Contents of package - 2

HITACHI CPX10WN - Contents of package - 3

HITACHI CPX10WN - Contents of package - 4

HITACHI CPX10WN - Contents of package - 5

HITACHI CPX10WN - Contents of package - 6

HITACHI CPX10WN - Contents of package - 7

HITACHI CPX10WN - Contents of package - 8

HITACHI CPX10WN - Contents of package - 9

⚠ WARNING ▶ Keep small parts away from children and pets. Take care not to put in the mouth. If swallowed, consult a physician immediately for emergency treatment.

NOTE • Keep the original packing materials for future reshipment. Be sure to use the original packing materials when moving the projector. Use special caution for the lens. • The projector may make a rattling sound when tilted, moved or shaken, since a flap to control the air flow inside of the projector has moved. Be aware that this is not a failure or malfunction.

Preparing for the remote control

Please insert the batteries into the remote control before using it. If the remote control starts to malfunction, try to replace the batteries. If you will not use the remote control for long period, remove the batteries from the remote control and store them in a safe place.

  1. Holding the hook part of the battery cover, remove it.
  2. Align and insert the two AA batteries (HITACHI MAXELL or HITACHI MAXELL ENERGY, Part No.LR6 or R6P) according to their plus and minus terminals as indicated in the remote control.
  3. Replace the battery cover in the direction of the arrow and snap it back into place.

HITACHI CPX10WN - Preparing for the remote control - 1

natural_image Line drawing of a hand holding a device with an arrow indicating direction (no text or symbols)

1

HITACHI CPX10WN - Preparing for the remote control - 2

natural_image Illustration of a hand holding a tool with a pen and ruler, labeled with number 2 (no text or symbols on the diagram itself)

HITACHI CPX10WN - Preparing for the remote control - 3

natural_image Hand holding a small object with a downward arrow indicating compression or disassembly (no text or symbols)

3

⚠ WARNING ▶ Always handle the batteries with care and use them only as directed. Improper use may result in battery explosion, cracking or leakage, which could result in fire, injury and/or pollution of the surrounding environment.

  • When replacing the batteries, replace both of the batteries with new batteries of the same type. Do not use a new battery with a used battery.
  • Be sure to use only the batteries specified. Do not use batteries of different types at the same time. Do not mix a new battery with used one.
  • Make sure the plus and minus terminals are correctly aligned when loading a battery.
  • Keep a battery away from children and pets.
  • Do not recharge, short circuit, solder or disassemble a battery.
  • Do not place a battery in a fire or water. Keep batteries in a dark, cool and dry place.
  • If you observe battery leakage, wipe out the leakage and then replace a battery. If the leakage adheres to your body or clothes, rinse well with water immediately.
  • Obey the local laws on disposing the battery.

Arrangement

Refer to table T-1 or T-2 and figures F-1 and F-2 at the end of this manual to determine the screen size and projection distance (from the projector's end). The values shown in the table are calculated for a full size screen.

(a) Screen size (diagonal)

(b) Projection distance ( ±10% , from the projector's end)

c1, c2 Screen height (±10%)

- If the projector is used at an altitude of about 1600 m (5250 feet) or higher, set ALTITUDE of the SERVICE item in the OPTION menu to HIGH. Otherwise, set it to NORMAL. If the projector is used with a wrong setting, it may cause damage to the projector itself or the parts inside.

⚠ WARNING ▶ Install the projector where you can access the power outlet easily.

▶ Install the projector in a stable horizontal position.
- Do not use any mounting accessories except the accessories specified by the manufacturer. Read and keep the manuals of the accessories used.
- For special installation such as ceiling mounting, be sure to consult your dealer beforehand. Specific mounting accessories and services may be required.
- Do not put the projector on its side, front or rear position.
- Do not attach nor place anything on the projector unless otherwise specified in the manual.
▶ Do not install the projector near thermally conductive or flammable things.
▶ Do not place the projector where any oils, such as cooking or machine oil, are used.
▶ Do not place the projector in a place where it may get wet.

⚠️CAUTION ▶Place the projector in a cool place with sufficient ventilation.

- Keep a space of 30 cm or more between a side of the projector and other objects such as walls.

- Do not stop up, block nor cover the projector's vent holes.

- Do not place the projector at places that are exposed to magnetic fields, doing so can cause the cooling fans inside the projector to malfunction.

▶ Avoid placing the projector in smoky, humid or dusty place.

- Do not place the projector near humidifiers.

NOTICE ▶ Position the projector to prevent light from directly hitting the projector's remote sensor.

▶ Do not place the product in a place where radio interference may be caused.

▶ Check and correct the setting for ALTITUDE of SERVICE in the OPTION menu according to the usage environment. For details, see User's Manual - Operating Guide.

Connecting with your devices

Before connecting the projector to a device, consult the manual of the device to confirm that the device is suitable for connecting with this projector and prepare the required accessories, such as a cable in accord with the signal of the device. Consult your dealer when the required accessory did not come with the product or the accessory is damaged.

After making sure that the projector and the devices are turned off, perform the connection, according to the following instructions. Refer to figures F-3 to F-6 at the end of this manual.

For details, see User's Manual - Operating Guide. Before connecting the projector to a network system, be sure to read User's Manual - Network Guide too.

⚠ WARNING ▶ Use only the appropriate accessories. Otherwise it could cause a fire or damage the projector and devices.

  • Use only the accessories specified or recommended by the projector's manufacturer. It may be regulated under some standard.
  • Neither disassemble nor modify the projector and the accessories.
  • Do not use the damaged accessory. Be careful not to damage the accessories. Route a cable so that it is neither stepped on nor pinched out.

⚠️CAUTION ▶For a cable with a core at only one end, connect the end with the core to the projector. That may be required by EMI regulations.

▶ Before connecting the projector to a network system be sure to obtain the consent of the administrator of the network.
▶ Do not connect the LAN port to any network that might have the excessive voltage.
▶The designated USB wireless adapter that is sold as an option is required to use the wireless network function of this projector.
Before removing the USB storage device from the port of the projector, be sure to use the REMOVE USB function on the thumbnail screen to secure your data. Before you insert or pull out the USB wireless adapter from the projector, turn off the power of the projector and pull out the power cord's plug from the outlet. Do not touch the USB wireless adapter while the projector is receiving AC power.

NOTE • Do not turn on or off the projector while connected to a device in operation, unless that is directed in the manual of the device.

  • Some input ports are selectable in the use. For details, see User's Manual - Operating Guide.
  • Be careful not to mistakenly connect a connector to a wrong port.
  • If an oversized USB storage device blocks the LAN port, use a USB extension cable to connect the USB storage device.

Fastening the adapter cover

Use the supplied adapter cover to prevent the USB wireless adapter from coming off easily.

  1. Loosen the screw (marked with triangle) on the bottom right of the USB TYPE A port.

  2. Insert the tab of the cover into the hole at the upper left of the USB TYPE A port in the direction of the arrow.

  3. Align the screw holes on the projector and the cover. Then insert the screw removed from the projector into the hole and tighten the screw.

1 2 Tab 3

⚠ WARNING ▶ Keep small parts away from children and pets. Take care not to put in the mouth.

Connecting power supply

  1. Put the connector of the power cord into the AC IN (AC inlet) of the projector.
  2. Firmly plug the power cord's plug into the outlet. In a couple of seconds after the power supply connection, the POWER indicator will light up in steady orange.

Please remember that when the DIRECT POWER ON function activated, the connection of the power supply make the projector turn on.

AC IN Power cord

⚠ WARNING ▶ Please use extra caution when connecting the power cord, as incorrect or faulty connections may result in fire and/or electrical shock.

  • Do not touch the power cord with a wet hand.
  • Only use the power cord that came with the projector. If it is damaged, consult your dealer to get a new one. Never modify the power cord.
  • Only plug the power cord into an outlet whose voltage is matched to the power cord. The power outlet should be close to the projector and easily accessible. Remove the power cord for complete separation.
  • Do not distribute the power supply to multiple devices. Doing so may overload the outlet and connectors, loosen the connection, or result in fire, electric shock or other accidents.
  • Connect the ground terminal for the AC inlet of this unit to the ground terminal of the building using an appropriate power cord (bundled).

NOTICE ▶This product is also designed for IT power systems with a phase-to-phase voltage of 220 to 240 V.

Turning on the power

  1. Make sure that the power cord is firmly and correctly connected to the projector and the outlet.
  2. Make sure that the POWER indicator is steady orange. Then remove the lens cover.
  3. Press the STANDBY/ON button on the projector or the remote control.

The projection lamp will light up and the POWER indicator will begin blinking in green. When the power is completely on, the indicator will stop blinking and light in steady green.

STANDBY/ON button POWER indicator STANDBY/ON INPUT MENU LAMP TEMP POWER

⚠ WARNING ▶ A strong light is emitted when the projector's power is on. Do not look into the lens of the projector or look inside of the projector through any of the projector's openings.

NOTE • Please power on the projector prior to the connected devices. • The projector has the DIRECT POWER ON function, which can make the projector automatically turn on. For more information, please see User's Manual - Operating Guide.

Adjusting the projector's elevator

When the place to put the projector is slightly uneven to the left or right, use the elevator feet to place the projector horizontally.

HITACHI CPX10WN - Adjusting the projector's elevator - 1

natural_image Technical line drawing of a portable air conditioner unit with 12° angle annotation (no text or symbols on the device itself)

Using the feet can also tilt the projector in order to project at a suitable angle to the screen, elevating the front side of the projector within 12 degrees.

This projector has 2 elevator feet and 2 elevator knobs. An elevator foot is adjustable while pulling up the elevator knob on the same side as it.

  1. Holding the projector, pull the elevator knobs up to loose the elevator feet.
    2 Position the front side of the projector to the desired height.
    3 Release the elevator knobs in order to lock the elevator feet.
  2. After making sure that the elevator feet are locked, put the projector down gently.
  3. If necessary, the elevator feet can be manually twisted to make more precise adjustments. Hold the projector when twisting the feet.

HITACHI CPX10WN - Adjusting the projector's elevator - 2

natural_image Illustration of a projector with base and wheels, showing mechanical components and a hand holding the lid (no text or symbols)

To loose an elevator foot, pull up the elevator knob on the same side as it.

5 adjust, twist the foot.

Tofinely adjust, twist the foot.

⚠️CAUTION ▶ Do not handle the elevator buttons without holding the projector, since the projector may drop down.

▶ Do not tilt the projector other than elevating its front within 12 degrees using the adjuster feet. A tilt of the projector exceeding the restriction could cause malfunction or shortening the lifetime of consumables, or the projector itself.

Displaying the picture

  1. Activate your signal source. Turn the signal source on, and make it send the signal to the projector.
  2. Press the INPUT button on the projector. Each time you press the button, the projector switches its input port in turn. You can also use the remote control to select an input signal. Press the VIDEO button for selecting an input signal from the HDMI, S-VIDEO or VIDEO port, or the COMPUTER button for selecting an input signal from the COMPUTER IN1, COMPUTER IN2, LAN, USB TYPE A or USB TYPE B port.
  3. Use the VOLUME + / VOLUME - buttons to adjust the volume. To have the projector silent, press the MUTE button on the remote control.
  4. Press the ASPECT button on the remote control. Each time you press the button, the projector switches the mode for aspect ratio in turn.
  5. Use the ZOOM ring to adjust the screen size.
  6. Use the FOCUS ring to focus the picture.

VOLUME+ button VOLUME- button MUTE button

HITACHI CPX10WN - Displaying the picture - 2
ENGLISH

INPUT button

VIDEO button COMPUTER button ASPECT button ZOOM ring FOCUS ring

HITACHI CPX10WN - Displaying the picture - 5

natural_image Line drawing of a projector with an inset showing its internal components (no text or symbols)

△CAUTION ▶ If you wish to have a blank screen while the projector's lamp is on, use the BLANK function. (see User's Manual - Operating Guide) Taking any other action may cause the damage on the projector.

NOTE • The ASPECT button does not work when no proper signal is inputted. • For the details of how to adjust the picture, please see User's Manual - Operating Guide.

Turning off the power

  1. Press the STANDBY/ON button on the projector or the remote control. The message "Power off?" will appear on the screen for about 5 seconds.

  2. Press the STANDBY/ON button again while the message appears.

The projector lamp will go off, and the POWER indicator will begin blinking in orange. Then the POWER indicator will stop blinking and light in steady orange when the lamp cooling is complete.

  1. Attach the lens cover, after the POWER indicator turns in steady orange.

STANDBY/ON button POWER indicator STANDBY/ON INPUT MENU LAMP TEMP POWER

Do not turn the projector on for about 10 minutes or more after turning it off. Also, do not turn the projector off shortly after turning it on. Such operations might cause the lamp to malfunction or shorten the lifetime of some parts including the lamp.

HITACHI CPX10WN - Turning off the power - 2

natural_image Diagram of a device with a circular component and an upward arrow indicating motion (no text or symbols)

HITACHI CPX10WN - Turning off the power - 3

natural_image Diagram of a device with a circular component and an X-shaped symbol above it, no text or labels present.

⚠ WARNING ▶ Do not touch around the lamp cover and the exhaust vents during use or just after use, since it is too hot.
▶ Remove the power cord for complete separation. The power outlet should be close to the projector and easily accessible.

NOTE • Please power off the projector after any connected devices are powered off.
- This projector has the AUTO POWER OFF function that can make the projector turn off automatically. For more information, please see User's Manual - Operating Guide.
- When you attach or remove the lens cover, move it vertically up and down while keeping the knob to the right as illustrated in the figure.

Replacing the lamp

A lamp has finite product life. Using the lamp for long periods of time could cause the pictures darker or the color tone poor. Note that each lamp has a different lifetime, and some may burst or burn out soon after you start using them.

Preparation of a new lamp and early replacement are recommended. To prepare a new lamp, make contact with your dealer and tell the lamp type number.

Type number : DT01191

  1. Turn the projector off, and unplug the power cord. Allow the projector to cool for at least 45 minutes.
  2. Prepare a new lamp. If the projector is mounted on a ceiling, or if the lamp has broken, also ask the dealer to replace the lamp.

In case of replacement by yourself, follow the following procedure.

  1. Loosen the screw (marked by arrow) of the lamp cover and then slide and lift the lamp cover to the side to remove it.

  2. Loosen the 2 screws (marked by arrow) of the lamp, and slowly pick up the lamp by the handle. Never loosen any other screws.

  3. Insert the new lamp, and retighten firmly the 2 screws of the lamp that are loosened in the previous process to lock it in place.

  4. While putting the interlocking parts of the lamp cover and the projector together, slide the lamp cover back in place. Then firmly fasten the screw of the lamp cover.

  5. Turn the projector on and reset the lamp time using the LAMP TIME item in the OPTION menu.

(1) Press the MENU button to display a menu. (2) Point at the ADVANCED MENU in the menu using the ▼/▲ button, then press the ▶ button.

(3) Point at the OPTION in the left column of the menu using the ▼/▲button, then press the ▶ button.

(4) Point at the LAMP TIME using the ▼/▲ button, then press the ▶ button. A dialog will appear.

(5) Press the ▶ button to select "OK" on the dialog. It performs resetting the lamp time.

⚠️CAUTION ▶ Do not touch any inner space of the projector, while the lamp is taken out.

NOTE • Please reset the lamp time only when you have replaced the lamp, for a suitable indication about the lamp.

Lamp cover

3 5 4 Handle

HITACHI CPX10WN - In case of replacement by yourself, follow the following procedure. - 3

natural_image Diagram of a printer or scanner device with a control panel and paper tray (no text or symbols visible)

Replacing the lamp (continued)

HITACHI CPX10WN - Replacing the lamp (continued) - 1

HIGH VOLTAGE

HITACHI CPX10WN - HIGH VOLTAGE - 1

HIGH TEMPERATURE HIGH PRESSURE

⚠ WARNING ▶ The projector uses a high-pressure mercury glass lamp. The lamp can break with a loud bang, or burn out, if jolted or scratched, handled while hot, or worn over time. Note that each lamp has a different lifetime, and some may burst or burn out soon after you start using them. In addition, if the bulb bursts, it is possible for shards of glass to fly into the lamp housing, and for gas containing mercury and dust containing fine particles of glass to escape from the projector's vent holes.

▶ About disposal of a lamp: This product contains a mercury lamp; do not put it in a trash. Dispose of it in accordance with environmental laws.

  • For lamp recycling, go to www.lamprecycle.org (in the US).
  • For product disposal, consult your local government agency or www.eiae.org (in the US) or www.epsc.ca (in Canada).

For more information, ask your dealer.

HITACHI CPX10WN - HIGH TEMPERATURE HIGH PRESSURE - 1

Disconnect the plug from the power outlet

  • If the lamp should break (it will make a loud bang when it does), unplug the power cord from the outlet, and make sure to request a replacement lamp from your local dealer. Note that shards of glass could damage the projector's internals, or cause injury during handling, so please do not try to clean the projector or replace the lamp yourself.
  • If the lamp should break (it will make a loud bang when it does), ventilate the room well, and make sure not to inhale the gas or fine particles that come out from the projector's vent holes, and not to get them into your eyes or mouth.
  • Before replacing the lamp, turn the projector off and unplug the power cord, then wait at least 45 minutes for the lamp to cool sufficiently. Handling the lamp while hot can cause burns, as well as damaging the lamp.

HITACHI CPX10WN - HIGH TEMPERATURE HIGH PRESSURE - 2

- Never unscrew except the appointed (marked by an arrow) screws.

- Do not open the lamp cover while the projector is suspended from a ceiling. This is dangerous, since if the lamp's bulb has broken, the shards will fall out when the cover is opened. In addition, working in high places is dangerous, so ask your local dealer to have the lamp replaced even if the bulb is not broken.

- Do not use the projector with the lamp cover removed. At the lamp replacing, make sure that the screws are screwed in firmly. Loose screws could result in damage or injury.

HITACHI CPX10WN - HIGH TEMPERATURE HIGH PRESSURE - 3

- Use only the lamp of the specified type. Use of a lamp that does not meet the lamp specifications for this model could cause a fire, damage or shorten the life of this product.

- If the lamp breaks soon after the first time it is used, it is possible that there are electrical problems elsewhere besides the lamp. If this happens, consult your local dealer or a service representative.

- Handle with care: jolting or scratching could cause the lamp bulb to burst during use.

- Using the lamp for long periods of time, could cause it dark, not to light up or to burst. When the pictures appear dark, or when the color tone is poor, please replace the lamp as soon as possible. Do not use old (used) lamps; this is a cause of breakage.

Cleaning and replacing the air filter

Please check and clean the air filter periodically. When the indicators or a message prompts you to clean the air filter, comply with it as soon as possible. The air filter has two kinds of filters inside. Replace the filters when they are damaged or too soiled. To prepare the new filters, make contact with your dealer and tell the following type number.

Type number : UX36761 (Filter set)

When you replace the lamp, please replace the air filter. An air filter of specified type will come together with a replacement lamp for this projector.

  1. Turn the projector off, and unplug the power cord. Allow the projector to sufficiently cool down.
    2 Use a vacuum cleaner on and around the filter cover.
  2. Pick and pull up the filter cover knobs to take it off.
  3. Use a vacuum cleaner for the filter vent of the projector.
  4. Take the fine meshed filter out while holding the filtercover. It is recommended to leave the coarse meshedfilter in the filter cover as it is.
  5. Use a vacuum cleaner on both sides of the fine meshed filter while holding it so it will not be sucked in. Use a vacuum cleaner for the inside of the filter cover to clean up the coarse meshed filter. If the filters are damaged or heavily soiled, replace them with new ones.
  6. Put the fine meshed filter on the coarse meshed one, turning its stitched side up.
  7. Put the filter unit back into the projector.
  8. Turn the projector on and reset the filter time using the FILTER TIME item in the EASY MENU.
    (1) Press the MENU button to display a menu.
    (2) Point at the FILTER TIME using the ▼/▲ button, then press the ▶ button. A dialog will appear.
    (3) Press the ▶ button to select "OK" on the dialog. It performs resetting the filter time.

2 Filter cover

HITACHI CPX10WN - Type number : UX36761 (Filter set) - 2

natural_image Diagram of a solar panel array with grid layout and side panel (no text or symbols)

Filter cover knobs

HITACHI CPX10WN - Type number : UX36761 (Filter set) - 3

natural_image Technical line drawing of a car air vent or airflow system (no text or symbols)

Intake vent

HITACHI CPX10WN - Type number : UX36761 (Filter set) - 4

natural_image Two rectangular objects with grid patterns, one open and one filled with patterned surfaces (no text or symbols)

Filter (coarse meshed)

Filter (fine meshed)
Stitched side

⚠ WARNING ▶ Before taking care of the air filter, make sure the power cable is not plugged in, then allow the projector to cool sufficiently.

▶ Use only the air filter of the specified type. Do not use the projector without the air filter or the filter cover. It could result in a fire or malfunction to the projector.
▶ Clean the air filter periodically. If the air filter becomes clogged by dust or the like, internal temperatures rise and could cause a fire, a burn or malfunction to the projector.

NOTE • Please reset the filter time only when you have cleaned or replaced the air filter, for a suitable indication about the air filter.

- The projector may display the message such as "CHECK THE AIR FLOW" or turn off the projector, to prevent the internal heat level rising.

Using the CD manual

The other manuals for this product are written into the included CD-ROM titled "User's Manual (detailed)". Before using the CD-ROM, please read the following to ensure the proper use.

■ System requirements

The system for using the CD-ROM requires the following.

Windows®: OS:Microsoft Windows® XP, Windows Vista®, Windows®7 or later

Macintosh®: OS:Mac OS 10.2 or later

CD-ROM/DVD-ROM drive:

Applications: Microsoft ^® Internet Explorer ^® 6.0 or later

Adobe® Acrobat® Reader® 8.0 or later

How to use the CD

  1. Insert CD into computer's CD-ROM/DVD-ROM drive.

Windows®: In a while, Web browser automatically starts. Start up window comes up.

Macintosh®: (1) Double-click on the "Projectors" icon appeared on the desktop screen.

(2) When “main.html” file is clicked, Web browser will start and Initial window will appear.

  1. Click the model name of your projector first, and then click language you want from the displayed list. The User's manual (detailed) will open.

⚠️CAUTION ▶ Only use the CD-ROM in a computer CD/DVD drive. The CD-ROM is designed for computer use only. NEVER INSERT THE CD-ROM INTO A NON-COMPUTER CD/DVD PLAYER! Inserting the CD-ROM into an incompatible CD/DVD drive may produce a loud noise, which in turn MAY RESULT IN EAR AND SPEAKER DAMAGE!

- After using CD-ROM, please put it into CD case and keep it. Please keep the CD neither in direct sunlight nor in a high temperature and high humidity environment.

NOTE • The information in the CD-ROM is subject to change without notice. Please check our website where you may find the latest information for this projector. (18)

- No responsibility is taken for any obstacle and defect to hardware and software of your computer as a result of the use of the CD-ROM.

- All or Any part of the information in the CD-ROM must not be copied, reproduced or republished without notice to our company.

Specifications

Item Specification
Product name Liquid crystal projector
Liquid Crystal PanelCPX10WN, CPX11WN:786,432 pixels (1024 horizontal x 768 vertical)CPWX12WN:1,024,000 pixels (1280 horizontal x 800 vertical)
Lamp 215 W UHP
Speaker1 W
Power supply/Rated currentAC 100-120 V: 3.3 A, AC 220-240 V: 1.6 A
Power consumptionAC 100-120 V: 320 W, AC 220-240 V: 310 W
Temperature range5 ~ 35 °C (Operating)
Size306 (W) x 77 (H) x 221 (D) mm* Not including protruding parts.Refer to figure F-7 at the back of this manual.
Weight (mass) approx. 2.3 kg
PortsCOMPUTER IN1 ...... D-sub 15 pin mini jack x1COMPUTER IN2 ...... D-sub 15 pin mini jack x1HDMI ...... HDMI connector x1MONITOR OUT ...... D-sub 15 pin mini jack x1S-VIDEO ...... Mini DIN 4 pin jack x1VIDEO ...... RCA jack x1AUDIO IN1 ...... 3.5 mm (stereo) mini jack x1AUDIO IN2 ...... 3.5 mm (stereo) mini jack x1AUDIO OUT ...... 3.5 mm (stereo) mini jack x1USB TYPE A ...... USB type A connector x1USB TYPE B ...... USB type B connector x1CONTROL ...... D-sub 9 pin plug x1LAN ...... RJ45 jack x1
Optional partsLamp: DT01191Filter set: UX36761Mounting accessory: HAS-X1 (Bracket for ceiling mount)HAS-204L (Fixing adaptor for lowceilings)HAS-304H (Fixing adaptor for highceilings)Laser remote control: RC-R008USB wireless adapter: USB-WL-11N* For more information, please consult your dealer.

Troubleshooting - Warranty and after-service

If an abnormal operation (such as smoke, strange odor or excessive sound) should occur, stop using the projector immediately.

Otherwise if a problem occurs with the projector, first refer to “Troubleshooting” of User’s Manual - Operating Guide and Network Guide, and run through the suggested checks.

If this does not resolve the problem, please consult your dealer or service company. They will tell you what warranty condition is applied.

Please check the following web address where you may find the latest information for this projector.

Product information and Manuals :http://www.hitachi-america.us/digitalmedia
Production information :http://www.hitachidigitalmedia.com
Direct link to manual download :http://www.hitachiserviceeu.com/support/guides/userguides.htm

NOTE • The information in this manual is subject to change without notice.

  • The illustrations in this manual are for illustrative purposes. They may differ slightly from your projector.
  • The manufacturer assumes no responsibility for any errors that may appear in this manual.
  • The reproduction, transfer or copy of all or any part of this document is not permitted without express written consent.

Trademark acknowledgment

  • Mac ^ , Macintosh ^ and Mac OS ^ are registered trademarks of Apple Inc.
  • Pentium ^ is a registered trademark of Intel Corp.
  • Adobe ^ and Acrobat ^ , Reader ^ are registered trademarks of Adobe Systems Incorporated.
  • Microsoft ^® , Internet Explorer ^® , Windows ^® , Windows NT ^® and Windows Vista ^® are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the U.S. and/or other countries.
  • HDMI, the HDMI logo and High-Definition Multimedia Interface are trademarks or registered trademarks of HDMI Licensing LLC in the United States and other countries.
  • Blu-ray Disc™ and Blu-ray™ are trademarks of Blu-ray Disc Association. All other trademarks are the properties of their respective owners.

End User License Agreement for the Projector Software

  • Software in the projector consists of the plural number of independent software modules and there exist our copyright or/and third party copyrights for each of such software modules.
  • Be sure to read “End User License Agreement for the Projector Software” which is separated document. (in the CD)

T-1

CPX10WN, CPX11WN

(1024 × 768) (±10%)

aScreen size (diagonal)4:3 screen 16:9 screen
bProjection distancec1Screen heightc2Screen heightbProjection distancec1Screen heightc2Screen height
min. max. min. max.
type (inch)m minch minch cminchcm inchm inchm inchcminch cminch
30 0.8 0.729 0.935 3915 73 0.832 1.038 3614 10
40 1.0 1.039 1.247 5221 93 1.143 1.352 4919 10
501.31.3491.56065261141.4541.7656124
60 1.5 1.560 1.872 7831 135 1.765 2.079 7329 21
70 1.8 1.870 2.184 9136 156 1.976 2.392 8534 21
80 2.0 2.080 2.597 1054117 7 22 872.7 10597 38 21
902.32.3902.8109118462082.5993.01191094331
1002.52.61013.1121131512292.81103.41321224831
1203.03.11213.71461576226103.41324.01591465741
1503.83.91524.61831967733134.21665.11991827242
2005.15.22036.224426110344175.62216.82662439662
2506.46.52547.830532712954217.02778.533330412073
3007.67.83059.336739215465268.533310.240036514494

ENSOLIDH

1

T-2

CPWX12WN

(1280 × 800) (±10%)

Screen size (diagonal)16 : 10 screen4 : 3 screen
aProjection distancebScreen heightcScreen heightaProjection distancebScreen heightcScreen height
min. max. min. max.
type (inch)minchminchcminchcminchminchminchcminchcminch
300.936 1.144 3815 31 1.041 1.350 4317 2
401.249 1.559 5020 42 1.456 1.767 5823 3
501.661 1.974 6325 52 1.870 2.184 7228 4
601.974 2.389 7530 62 2.184 2.610187 345 2
702.2872.71058834732.5993.01191014062
802.51003.012010039832.91133.51361154573
902.91123.413511344933.21273.91531305173
1003.21253.8150125491043.61424.31701445783
1203.81504.6181150591254.31705.220517368104
1504.81885.8227188741465.42146.525721685125
2006.42527.7303250981987.22858.7343288114166
2508.03159.63793131232499.135710.9429361142208
3009.637911.6455375148291110.942913.15154331702410

F-1

  • On a horizontal surface
    HITACHI CPX10WN - F-1 - 1

• Suspended from the ceiling
a c2 c1 b

F-3

Computer AUDIO OUT HDMI USB TYPE A RGB OUT COMPUTER IN1 COMPUTER IN2 S-VIDEO VIDEO AUDIO IN1 AUDIO IN1 HDMI USB TYPE A DC5V 0.5A USB TYPE B LAN AC IN CONTROLMONITOR OUTAUDIO OUT

F-4
HITACHI CPX10WN - F-3 - 2

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Access point"] --> B["Computer"]
    B --> C["External device"]
    D["USB wireless adapter (optional)"] --> E["USB storage device"]
    E --> F["LAN AC IN"]
    F --> G["HDMI USB TYPE A DC5V 0.5A"]
    G --> H["USB TYPE B"]
    H --> I["COMPUTER IN1 COMPUTER IN2"]
    I --> J["S-VIDEO VIDEO AUDIO IN1"]
    J --> K["CONTROLMONITOR OUTAUDIO OUT"]
    L["RS-232C"] --> M["External device"]
    N["Internet"] --> O["Computer"]
    P["Internet"] --> Q["External device"]

ENGLISH
F-5

VCR/DVD/Blu-ray Disc™ player HDMI USB TYPE A DC5V 0.5A USB TYPE B COM R IN1 COMPUTER IN2 S-VIDEO VIDEO AUDIO IN1 AUDIO IN2 CONTROL MONITOR OUTAUDIO OUT HDMI S-VIDEO OUT AUDIO OUT VIDEO OUT AUDIO OUT AUDIO OUT X Audio COMPONENT VIDEO OUT

Speakers (with an amplifier) L R Monitor RGB IN HDMI USB TYPE A DC5V 0 USB TYPE B COMPUTER IN1 COMPUTER IN2 S-VIDEO AUDIO IN1 VIDEO AUDIO IN2 LAN AC IN CONTROLMONITOR OUTAUDIO OUT

HITACHI CPX10WN - F-3 - 5
[unit: mm]

NOTE • The information in this manual is subject to change without notice. • The manufacturer assumes no responsibility for any errors that may appear in this manual. • The reproduction, transfer or copy of all or any part of this document is not permitted without express written consent.

Digital Media Division

900 Hitachi way, Chula Vista

CA 91914-3556 USA CANADA

Tel: +1 -800-225-1741

http://www.hitachi-america.us/digitalmedia

Hitachi Europe Ltd., Digital Media Group Consumer Affairs Department

Whitebrook Park, Lower Cookham Road, Maidenhead

Berkshire SL6 8YA UNITED KINGDOM

Tel: 0844 481 0297

Email: consumer.mail@hitachi-eu.com

Hitachi Europe S.A.S., Digital Media Group

Email: customerservice.italy@hitachi-eu.com

Hitachi Europe S.A.

Gran Via Carles III, 86 Planta 5 ^a

Denmark Tel: +46 8 562 711 00

http://www.hitachidigitalmedia.com

Hitachi Australia Pty Ltd.

Level 3,82 Waterloo Road

North Ryde N.S.W 2113 AUSTRALIA

Tel: +61 -2-9888-4100

http://www.hitachi.com.au

Hitachi (Hong Kong), Ltd.

18/F., Ever Gain Centre, 28 On Muk Street., Shatin, N.T. HONG KONG

Tel: +852 -2113-8883

http://www.hitachi-hk.com.hk

Hitachi Sales (Malaysia) Sdn. Bhd.

Lot 12, Jalan Kamajuan, Bangi Industrial Estate, 43650 Bandar Baru Bangi, Selangor Darul Ehsan

MALAYSIA

Tel: +60 -3-8911-2670

http://www.hitachiconsumer.com.my

Hitachi Home Electronics Asia (S) Pte. Ltd.

438A Alexandra Road #01-01/02/03

Alexandra Technopark, 119967 SINGAPORE

Tel: +65 -6536-2520

http://www.hitachiconsumer.com.sg

Hitachi Sales Corp. of Taiwan

2^nd Floor, No.65, Nanking East Road, Section 3,

Taipei 104 TAIWAN

Tel: +886-2-2516-0500

http://www.hsct.com.tw

Hitachi Sales (Thailand), Ltd.

994, 996 Soi Thonglor, Sukhumvit 55 Rd.,

Klongtonnua, Vadhana, Bangkok 10110

THAILAND

Tel: +66 -2381-8381-98

http://www.hitachi-th.com

Hitachi Consumer Electronics Co., Ltd.

292 Yoshida-cho, Totsuka-ku

Yokohama 244-0817 JAPAN

Tel: +81-45-415-2625

Table of contents Click a title to access it
Manual assistant
Powered by Anthropic
Waiting for your message
Product information

Brand : HITACHI

Model : CPX10WN

Category : Video projector